LDAP: internal rename of attr_count
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6 .
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12 .include stdflags
13 .include stdmacs
14
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19 .docbook
20
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25 . processors.
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28 .literal xml
29 <?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34 ?>
35 .literal off
36
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41 .book
42
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48 .set previousversion "4.86"
49 .include ./local_params
50
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54 .macro copyyear
55 2015
56 .endmacro
57
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60 . provided in the xfpt library.
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62
63 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
64
65 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66
67 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
69
70 .flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
71 .flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
72
73 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
76 . --- index entry.
77
78 .macro option
79 .arg 5
80 .oindex "&%$5%&"
81 .endarg
82 .arg -5
83 .oindex "&%$1%&"
84 .endarg
85 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87 .endtable
88 .endmacro
89
90 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93
94 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
95 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
96 .endmacro
97
98 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101
102 .macro irow
103 .arg 4
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105 .endarg
106 .arg -4
107 .arg 3
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
109 .endarg
110 .arg -3
111 .row "&I;$1" "$2"
112 .endarg
113 .endarg
114 .endmacro
115
116 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119 . --- ID that ties them together.
120
121 .macro cindex
122 &<indexterm role="concept">&
123 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124 .arg 2
125 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
126 .endarg
127 &</indexterm>&
128 .endmacro
129
130 .macro scindex
131 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133 .arg 3
134 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
135 .endarg
136 &</indexterm>&
137 .endmacro
138
139 .macro ecindex
140 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141 .endmacro
142
143 .macro oindex
144 &<indexterm role="option">&
145 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146 .arg 2
147 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
148 .endarg
149 &</indexterm>&
150 .endmacro
151
152 .macro vindex
153 &<indexterm role="variable">&
154 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155 .arg 2
156 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
157 .endarg
158 &</indexterm>&
159 .endmacro
160
161 .macro index
162 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163 .endmacro
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165
166
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
169 . output formats.
170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171
172 .literal xml
173 <bookinfo>
174 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
176 <date>
177 .fulldate
178 </date>
179 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181 <revhistory><revision>
182 .versiondatexml
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
185 <copyright><year>
186 .copyyear
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188 </bookinfo>
189 .literal off
190
191
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
197
198 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199 .literal xml
200
201 <indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
204 </indexterm>
205 <indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
209 </indexterm>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
213 </indexterm>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
217 </indexterm>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
221 </indexterm>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
225 </indexterm>
226 <indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
230 </indexterm>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
234 </indexterm>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
238 </indexterm>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
242 </indexterm>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
246 </indexterm>
247 <indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
251 </indexterm>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
255 </indexterm>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
259 </indexterm>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
263 </indexterm>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
267 </indexterm>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
271 </indexterm>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
275 </indexterm>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
279 </indexterm>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
283 </indexterm>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
287 </indexterm>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
291 </indexterm>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
295 </indexterm>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
299 </indexterm>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
303 </indexterm>
304 <indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
308 </indexterm>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
312 </indexterm>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
316 </indexterm>
317 <indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
320 </indexterm>
321
322 .literal off
323
324
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
328 . chapter "Introduction"
329 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
330
331 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
335
336 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
341 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
343
344 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
347
348 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
351
352 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
354 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
357
358 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
363
364 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
368 contributors.
369
370
371 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
373
374 .new
375 .cindex "documentation"
376 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379 capable of showing a change indicator.
380 .wen
381
382 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
389 very wide interest.
390
391 .cindex "books about Exim"
392 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
396
397 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
401
402 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404 Debian-specific features in the file
405 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
407 information.
408
409 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
411 .cindex "change log"
412 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
417
418 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
422
423 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
425
426 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
429 directory are:
430
431 .table2 100pt
432 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
439 .endtable
440
441 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
442 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
443 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
444
445
446
447 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
448 .cindex "web site"
449 .cindex "FTP site"
450 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
451 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
452 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
453 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
454 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
455 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
456
457 .cindex "wiki"
458 .cindex "FAQ"
459 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
460 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
461 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
462 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
463 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
464
465 .cindex Bugzilla
466 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(http://bugs.exim.org). You can use
467 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
468 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
469
470
471
472 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
473 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
474 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
475
476 .table2 140pt
477 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
478 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
479 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
480 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
481 .endtable
482
483 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
484 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
485 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
486 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
487 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
488 via this web page:
489 .display
490 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
491 .endd
492 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
493 lists.
494
495 .section "Exim training" "SECID4"
496 .cindex "training courses"
497 Training courses in Cambridge (UK) used to be run annually by the author of
498 Exim, before he retired. At the time of writing, there are no plans to run
499 further Exim courses in Cambridge. However, if that changes, relevant
500 information will be posted at &url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
501
502 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
503 .cindex "bug reports"
504 .cindex "reporting bugs"
505 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
506 via the Bugzilla (&url(http://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
507 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
508 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
509
510
511
512 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
513 .cindex "FTP site"
514 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
515 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
516 .display
517 &*ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim*&
518 .endd
519 This is mirrored by
520 .display
521 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
522 .endd
523 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
524 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
525 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
526
527 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
528 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
529 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
530 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
531 .display
532 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
533 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
534 .endd
535 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
536 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
537 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
538
539 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
540 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
541 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
542 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
543 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
544 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
545 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
546 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from Nigel Metheringham's
547 PGP key, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
548 &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
549 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
550
551 At time of last update, releases were being made by Phil Pennock and signed with
552 key &'0x403043153903637F'&, although that key is expected to be replaced in 2013.
553 A trust path from Nigel's key to Phil's can be observed at
554 &url(https://www.security.spodhuis.org/exim-trustpath).
555
556 Releases have also been authorized to be performed by Todd Lyons who signs with
557 key &'0xC4F4F94804D29EBA'&. A direct trust path exists between previous RE Phil
558 Pennock and Todd Lyons through a common associate.
559
560 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
561 .display
562 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
563 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
564 .endd
565 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
566 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
567 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
568
569 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
570 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
571 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
572 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
573 .display
574 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
575 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
578 .endd
579 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
580 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
581
582
583 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
584 .ilist
585 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
586 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
587 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
588 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
589 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
590 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
591 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
592 .next
593 .cindex "domainless addresses"
594 .cindex "address" "without domain"
595 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
596 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
597 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
598 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
599 arrival.
600 .next
601 .cindex "transport" "external"
602 .cindex "external transports"
603 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
604 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
605 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
606 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
607 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
608 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
609 .next
610 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
611 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
612 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
613 other means.
614 .next
615 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
616 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
617 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
618 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
619 a number of common scanners are provided.
620 .endlist
621
622
623 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
624 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
625 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
626 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
627 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
628 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
629
630
631 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
632 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
633 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
634 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
635 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
636 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
637 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
638 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
639 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
640 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
641 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
642 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
643
644 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
645 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
646 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
647 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
648
649
650
651 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
652 .cindex "terminology definitions"
653 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
654 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
655 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
656 below) by a blank line.
657
658 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
659 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
660 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
661 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
662 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
663 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
664 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
665 rise to further bounce messages.
666
667 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
668 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
669 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
670 otherwise.
671
672 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
673 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
674 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
675 until a later time.
676
677 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
678 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
679 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
680
681 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
682 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
683 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
684 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
685 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
686 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
687 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
688 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
689
690 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
691 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
692 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
693 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
694 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
695 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
696 line.
697
698 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
699 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
700 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
701 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
702 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
703
704 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
705 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
706 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
707 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
708 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
709 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
710
711 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
712 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
713 message's envelope.
714
715 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
716 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
717 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
718 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
719 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
720
721 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
722 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
723 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
724 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
725 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
726
727 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
728 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
729 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
730 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
731 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
732 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
733
734
735
736
737
738
739 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
740 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
741
742 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
743 .cindex "incorporated code"
744 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
745 .cindex "PCRE"
746 .cindex "OpenDMARC"
747 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
748
749 .ilist
750 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
751 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
752 &copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
753 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
754 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
755 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
756 .next
757 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
758 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
759 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
760 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
761 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
762 following statements:
763
764 .blockquote
765 Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
766
767 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
768 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
769 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
770 version.
771 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
772 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
773 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
774 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
775 restrictions applied to it).
776 .endblockquote
777 .next
778 .cindex "SPA authentication"
779 .cindex "Samba project"
780 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
781 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
782 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
783 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
784 under the Gnu GPL.
785 .next
786 .cindex "Cyrus"
787 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
788 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
789 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
790 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
791 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
792 conditions expressed therein.
793
794 .blockquote
795 Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
796
797 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
798 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
799 are met:
800
801 .olist
802 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
803 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
804 .next
805 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
806 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
807 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
808 distribution.
809 .next
810 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
811 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
812 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
813 details, please contact
814 .display
815 Office of Technology Transfer
816 Carnegie Mellon University
817 5000 Forbes Avenue
818 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
819 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
820 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
821 .endd
822 .next
823 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
824 acknowledgment:
825
826 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
827 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
828
829 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
830 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
831 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
832 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
833 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
834 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
835 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
836 .endlist
837 .endblockquote
838
839 .next
840 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
841 .cindex "X-windows"
842 .cindex "Athena"
843 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
844 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
845 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
846 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
847
848 .blockquote
849 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
850 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
851
852 All Rights Reserved
853
854 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
855 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
856 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
857 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
858 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
859 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
860 software without specific, written prior permission.
861
862 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
863 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
864 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
865 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
866 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
867 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
868 SOFTWARE.
869 .endblockquote
870
871 .next
872 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
873 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
874 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
875 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
876 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
877 source code.
878
879 .next
880 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
881 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
882 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
883 .endlist
884
885
886
887
888
889 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
890 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
891
892 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
893 "Receiving and delivering mail"
894
895
896 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
897 .cindex "design philosophy"
898 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
899 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
900 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
901 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
902 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
903 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
904
905
906 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
907 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
908 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
909 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
910 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
911 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
912 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
913
914 .ilist
915 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
916 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
917 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
918 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
919 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
920 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
921 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
922 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
923 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
924 error code.
925 .next
926 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
927 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
928 .next
929 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
930 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
931 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
932 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
933 .next
934 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
935 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
936 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
937 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
938 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
939 .next
940 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
941 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
942 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
943 .next
944 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
945 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
946 runs at the start of every delivery process.
947 .endlist
948
949
950
951 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
952 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
953 .cindex "Sieve filter"
954 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
955 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
956 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
957 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
958 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
959 of filtering are available:
960
961 .ilist
962 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
963 by RFC 3028.
964 .next
965 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
966 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
967 .endlist
968
969 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
970
971
972
973 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
974 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
975 .cindex "format" "of message id"
976 .cindex "id of message"
977 .cindex "base62"
978 .cindex "base36"
979 .cindex "Darwin"
980 .cindex "Cygwin"
981 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
982 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
983 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
984 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
985 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
986 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
987 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
988 not always case-sensitive.
989
990 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
991 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
992 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
993 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
994 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
995 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
996 somewhat eccentric:
997
998 .ilist
999 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
1000 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1001 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1002 way of representing the date and time of day).
1003 .next
1004 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1005 received the message.
1006 .next
1007 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1008 .olist
1009 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1010 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1011 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1012 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1013 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1014 .next
1015 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1016 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1017 (1/100) of a second.
1018 .endlist
1019 .endlist
1020
1021 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1022 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1023 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1024 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1025 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1026
1027
1028 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1029 .cindex "receiving mail"
1030 .cindex "message" "reception"
1031 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1032 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1033 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1034 there are several possibilities:
1035
1036 .ilist
1037 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1038 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1039 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1040 .next
1041 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1042 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1043 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1044 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1045 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1046 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1047 .next
1048 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1049 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1050 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1051 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1052 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1053 .next
1054 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1055 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1056 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1057 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1058 .endlist
1059
1060
1061 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1062 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1063 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1064 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1065 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1066 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1067 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1068 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1069 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1070 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1071 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1072 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1073 users to change sender addresses.
1074
1075 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1076 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1077 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1078 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1079 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1080 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1081 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1082
1083 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1084 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1085 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1086 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1087 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1088 message is received.
1089
1090
1091
1092
1093
1094 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1095 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1096 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1097 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1098 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1099 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1100 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1101 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1102
1103 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1104 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1105 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1106 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1107 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1108 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1109 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1110 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1111 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1112 affect file system performance.
1113
1114 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1115 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1116 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1117 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1118 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1119
1120 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1121 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1122 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1123 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1124 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1125 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1126 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1127 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1128 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1129 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1130 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1131 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1132
1133
1134
1135 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1136 .cindex "message" "life of"
1137 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1138 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1139 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1140 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1141 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1142 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1143 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1144
1145 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1146 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1147 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1148 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1149 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1150 to be sent.
1151
1152 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1153 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1154 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1155 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1156 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1157
1158 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1159 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1160 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1161 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1162 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1163 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1164 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1165 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1166 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1167 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1168 systems.
1169
1170 .cindex "journal file"
1171 .cindex "file" "journal"
1172 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1173 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1174 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1175 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1176 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1177 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1178 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1179 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1180
1181 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1182 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1183 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1184 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1185 deliveries caused by crashes.
1186
1187
1188
1189 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1190 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1191 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1192 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1193 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1194 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1195 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1196 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1197 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1198
1199 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1200 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1201 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1202 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1203 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1204 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1205 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1206 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1207 the driver's features in general.
1208
1209 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1210 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1211 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1212 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1213 to be bounced.
1214
1215 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1216 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1217 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1218 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1219 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1220 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1221
1222 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1223 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1224 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1225 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1226 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1227 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1228
1229 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1230 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1231 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1232 configuration.
1233
1234 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1235 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1236 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1237 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1238 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1239 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1240 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1241 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1242 configured to fail the address.
1243
1244 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1245 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1246 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1247 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1248 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1249 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1250
1251 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1252 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1253 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1254 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1255 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1256 the address is bounced.
1257
1258
1259
1260 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1261 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1262 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1263 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1264 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1265 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1266 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1267 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1268
1269 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1270 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1271 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1272 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1273 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1274 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1275 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1276 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1277
1278
1279
1280
1281 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1282 .cindex "router" "running details"
1283 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1284 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1285 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1286 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1287 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1288 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1289 the following:
1290
1291 .ilist
1292 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1293 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1294 original address ceases,
1295 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1296 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1297 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1298 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1299 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1300 end of routing.
1301
1302 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1303 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1304 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1305 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1306 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1307 .next
1308 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1309 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1310 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1311 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1312 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1313 .next
1314 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1315 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1316 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1317 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1318 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1319 .next
1320 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1321 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1322 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1323 .next
1324 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1325 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1326 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1327 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1328 .next
1329 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1330 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1331 .endlist
1332
1333 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1334 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1335 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1336 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1337 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1338
1339 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1340 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1341 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1342 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1343 facility for this purpose.
1344
1345
1346 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1347 .cindex "case of local parts"
1348 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1349 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1350 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1351 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1352 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1353 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1354 routed addresses are shown.
1355
1356
1357
1358 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1359 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1360 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1361 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1362 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1363 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1364
1365 .ilist
1366 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1367 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1368 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1369 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1370 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1371 of any other conditions.
1372 .next
1373 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1374 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1375 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1376 address.
1377 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1378 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1379 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1380 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1381 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1382 .next
1383 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1384 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1385 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1386 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1387 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1388 .next
1389 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1390 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1391 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1392 .next
1393 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1394 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1395 .next
1396 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1397 of domains that it defines.
1398 .next
1399 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1400 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1401 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1402 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1403 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1404 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1405 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1406 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1407 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1408 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1409 .next
1410 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1411 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1412 .vindex "&$home$&"
1413 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1414 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1415 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1416 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1417 remaining preconditions.
1418 .next
1419 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1420 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1421 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1422 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1423 could lead to confusion.
1424 .next
1425 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1426 set of addresses that it defines.
1427 .next
1428 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1429 specified files is tested.
1430 .next
1431 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1432 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1433 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1434 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1435 .endlist
1436
1437
1438 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1439 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1440 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1441 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1442 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1443 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1444 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1445
1446
1447
1448 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1449 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1450 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1451
1452 .ilist
1453 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1454 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1455 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1456 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1457 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1458 filtering'&.
1459 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1460 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1461
1462 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1463 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1464 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1465 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1466 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1467 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1468 filter.
1469 .next
1470 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1471 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1472 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1473 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1474 processed entirely independently of each other.
1475 .next
1476 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1477 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1478 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1479 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1480 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1481 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1482 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1483 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1484 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1485 .next
1486 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1487 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1488 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1489 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1490 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1491 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1492 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1493 addresses to the same domain.
1494 .next
1495 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1496 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1497 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1498 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1499 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1500 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1501 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1502 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1503 .next
1504 .cindex "queue runner"
1505 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1506 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1507 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1508 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1509 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1510 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1511 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1512 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1513 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1514 .next
1515 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1516 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1517 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1518 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1519 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1520 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1521 .next
1522 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1523 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1524 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1525 messages to other addresses.
1526 .next
1527 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1528 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1529 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1530 &'deferred'&.
1531 .next
1532 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1533 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1534 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1535 .endlist
1536
1537
1538
1539
1540 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1541 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1542 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1543 .cindex "queue runner"
1544 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1545 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1546 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1547 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1548 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1549 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1550 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1551 passed its retry time.
1552 You can run several queue runners at once.
1553
1554 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1555 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1556 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1557 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1558 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1559 as permanent.
1560
1561
1562
1563 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1564 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1565 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1566 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1567 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1568 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1569 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1570 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1571 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1572 also apply.
1573
1574 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1575 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1576 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1577 deferred,
1578 .cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1579 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1580 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1581 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1582 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1583 one connection.
1584
1585
1586
1587 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1588 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1589 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1590 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1591 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1592 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1593 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1594 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1595 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1596 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1597 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1598
1599 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1600 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1601 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1602 automatically.
1603
1604 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1605 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1606 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1607 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1608 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1609 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1610 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1611 of the list.
1612
1613
1614
1615 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1616 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1617 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1618 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1619 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1620 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1621 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1622 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1623
1624
1625
1626
1627
1628 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1629 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1630
1631 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1632 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1633
1634 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1635 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1636 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1637 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1638
1639 .table2 140pt
1640 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1641 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1642 documented"
1643 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1644 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1645 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1646 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1647 instructions"
1648 .endtable
1649
1650 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1651 following subdirectories are created:
1652
1653 .table2 140pt
1654 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1655 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1656 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1657 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1658 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1659 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1660 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1661 .endtable
1662
1663 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1664 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1665 that may be useful to some sites.
1666
1667
1668 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1669 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1670 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1671 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1672 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1673 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1674 system.
1675 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1676 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1677 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1678 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1679 overridden if necessary.
1680
1681
1682 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1683 .cindex "PCRE library"
1684 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1685 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1686 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1687 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1688 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1689 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1690 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1691 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1692 If your operating system has no
1693 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1694 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1695 More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1696
1697 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1698 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1699 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1700 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1701 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1702 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1703 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1704
1705 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1706 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1707 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1708 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1709 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1710 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1711 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1712 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1713
1714 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1715 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1716 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1717 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1718 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1719 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1720 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1721 Berkeley DB library.
1722
1723 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1724 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1725 possibilities:
1726
1727 .olist
1728 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1729 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1730 .next
1731 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1732 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1733 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1734 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1735 file name is used unmodified.
1736 .next
1737 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1738 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1739 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1740 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1741 .next
1742 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1743 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1744 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1745 .next
1746 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1747 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1748 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1749 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1750 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1751 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1752 .next
1753 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1754 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1755 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1756 operates on a single file.
1757 .endlist
1758
1759 .cindex "USE_DB"
1760 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1761 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1762 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1763 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1764 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1765 .code
1766 USE_DB=yes
1767 .endd
1768 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1769 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1770
1771 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1772 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1773 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1774 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1775 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1776 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1777
1778 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1779 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1780 in one of these lines:
1781 .code
1782 DBMLIB = -ldb
1783 DBMLIB = -ltdb
1784 .endd
1785 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1786 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1787 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1788 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1789 this example:
1790 .code
1791 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1792 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1793 .endd
1794 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1795 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1796
1797
1798
1799 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1800 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1801 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1802 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1803 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1804 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1805 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1806 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1807 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1808 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1809 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1810 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1811
1812 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1813 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1814 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1815 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1816 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1817 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1818
1819 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1820 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1821 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1822 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1823 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1824 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1825 be logged.
1826
1827 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1828 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1829 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1830 facilities, you need to set
1831 .code
1832 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1833 .endd
1834 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1835 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1836
1837
1838 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1839 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1840 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1841 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1842 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1843 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1844 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1845
1846 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1847 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1848 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1849 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1850 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1851 do this.
1852
1853
1854
1855 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1856 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1857 .cindex "RFC 2047"
1858 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1859 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1860 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1861 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1862 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1863 (default ISO-8859-1). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1864 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1865
1866 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1867 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1868 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1869 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1870 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1871 .code
1872 HAVE_ICONV=yes
1873 .endd
1874 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1875
1876
1877
1878 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1879 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1880 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1881 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1882 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1883 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1884 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1885 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1886 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1887 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1888 line option).
1889
1890 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1891 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1892 implementing SSL.
1893
1894 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1895 .code
1896 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1897 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1898 .endd
1899 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1900 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1901 .code
1902 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1903 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1904 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1905 .endd
1906 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1907 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1908 .code
1909 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1910 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1911 .endd
1912 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1913 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1914 .code
1915 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1916 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1917 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1918 .endd
1919 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1920 library and include files. For example:
1921 .code
1922 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1923 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1924 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1925 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1926 .endd
1927 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1928 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1929 .code
1930 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1931 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1932 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1933 .endd
1934
1935 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1936 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1937 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1938
1939
1940
1941
1942 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1943
1944 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1945 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1946 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1947 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1948 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1949 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1950 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1951 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1952 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1953 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1954 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1955 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1956 you might have
1957 .code
1958 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1959 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1960 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1961 .endd
1962 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1963 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1964 .code
1965 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1966 .endd
1967 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1968 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1969 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1970 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1971 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1972 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1973 further details.
1974
1975
1976 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1977 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1978 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1979 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1980 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1981 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1982 library files.
1983
1984 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1985 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1986 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1987 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1988 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
1989 Exim used to
1990 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
1991 withdrawn.
1992
1993
1994
1995 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
1996 .cindex "lookup modules"
1997 .cindex "dynamic modules"
1998 .cindex ".so building"
1999 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2000 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2001 on demand.
2002 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2003 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2004 dependencies.
2005 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2006
2007 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2008 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2009 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2010 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2011 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2012 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2013
2014 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2015 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2016 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2017 on demand:
2018 .code
2019 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
2020 LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
2021 LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
2022 .endd
2023
2024
2025 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2026 .cindex "build directory"
2027 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2028 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2029 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2030 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2031 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2032 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2033 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2034
2035 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2036 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2037 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2038 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2039 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2040 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2041 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2042 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2043
2044 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2045 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2046 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2047
2048
2049
2050 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2051 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2052 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2053 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2054 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2055 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2056 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2057 .code
2058 FULLECHO='' make -e
2059 .endd
2060 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2061 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2062 given in addition to the short output.
2063
2064
2065
2066 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2067 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2068 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2069 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2070 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2071 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2072 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2073 order:
2074 .display
2075 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2076 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2077 &_Local/Makefile_&
2078 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2079 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2080 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2081 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2082 .endd
2083 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2084 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2085 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2086 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2087 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2088 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2089 and are often not needed.
2090
2091 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2092 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2093 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2094 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2095 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2096 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2097 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2098 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2099 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2100
2101
2102 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2103 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2104 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2105 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2106 default values are.
2107
2108
2109 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2110 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2111 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2112 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2113 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2114 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2115 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2116 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2117 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2118 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2119 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2120 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2121 containing the lines
2122 .code
2123 CC=cc
2124 CFLAGS=-std1
2125 .endd
2126 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2127 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2128
2129 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2130 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2131 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2132
2133
2134 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2135 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2136 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2137 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2138 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2139 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2140 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2141 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2142 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2143 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2144 .code
2145 LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2146 LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2147 LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2148 .endd
2149 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2150 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2151 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2152 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2153 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2154 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2155 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2156 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2157 errors.
2158
2159 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2160 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2161 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2162 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2163 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2164 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2165 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2166 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2167 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2168 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2169 syntax. For instance:
2170 .code
2171 LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2172 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2173 AUTH_GSASL=yes
2174 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2175 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2176 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2177 .endd
2178
2179 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2180 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2181 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2182 .code
2183 EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2184 .endd
2185 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2186 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2187
2188 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2189 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2190 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2191 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2192 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2193 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2194 .code
2195 X11=/usr/X11R6
2196 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2197 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2198 .endd
2199 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2200 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2201 .code
2202 X11=/usr/openwin
2203 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2204 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2205 .endd
2206 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2207 definition of all three of these variables into your
2208 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2209
2210 .cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2211 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2212 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2213 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2214 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2215
2216 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2217 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2218 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2219 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2220 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2221 libraries.
2222
2223 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2224 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2225 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2226 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2227 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2228
2229
2230 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2231 .cindex "&_os.h_&"
2232 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2233 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2234 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2235 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2236 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2237 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2238
2239
2240
2241 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2242 .cindex "building Eximon"
2243 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2244 where the files that are involved are
2245 .display
2246 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2247 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2248 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2249 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2250 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2251 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2252 .endd
2253 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2254 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2255 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2256 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2257 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2258 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2259 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2260 .ecindex IIDbuex
2261
2262
2263 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2264 .cindex "installing Exim"
2265 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2266 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2267 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2268 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2269 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2270 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2271 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2272 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2273 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2274 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2275 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2276 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2277
2278 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2279 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2280 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2281 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2282 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2283 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2284 alternative files, no default is installed.
2285
2286 .cindex "system aliases file"
2287 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2288 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2289 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2290 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2291 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2292 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2293 and outputs a comment to the user.
2294
2295 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2296 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2297 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2298 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2299 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2300
2301 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2302 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2303 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2304 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2305 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2306 over SMTP.
2307
2308 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2309 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2310 command such as
2311 .code
2312 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2313 .endd
2314 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2315 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2316 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2317 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2318 but this usage is deprecated.
2319
2320 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2321 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2322 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2323 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2324 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2325 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2326
2327 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2328 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2329 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2330 for example &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2331 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2332 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2333 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2334
2335 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2336 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2337 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2338 command:
2339 .code
2340 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2341 .endd
2342 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2343 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2344 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2345 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2346 command:
2347 .code
2348 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2349 .endd
2350 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2351 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2352
2353 .ilist
2354 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2355 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2356 .next
2357 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2358 installed binary.
2359 .endlist
2360
2361 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2362 .code
2363 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2364 .endd
2365 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2366 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2367 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2368 .code
2369 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2370 .endd
2371
2372
2373
2374 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2375 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2376 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2377 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2378 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2379 &<<SECTavail>>&).
2380
2381 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2382 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2383 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2384
2385
2386
2387 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2388 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2389 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2390 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2391 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2392 necessary.
2393
2394
2395
2396
2397 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2398 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2399 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2400 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2401 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2402 .code
2403 exim -bV
2404 .endd
2405 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2406 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2407 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2408 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2409 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2410 example,
2411 .display
2412 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2413 .endd
2414 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2415 .display
2416 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2417 .endd
2418 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2419 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2420 user agent. For example:
2421 .code
2422 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2423 From: user@your.domain.example
2424 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2425 Subject: Testing Exim
2426
2427 This is a test message.
2428 ^D
2429 .endd
2430 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2431 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2432 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2433
2434 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2435 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2436 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2437 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2438 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2439 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2440 .display
2441 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2442 .endd
2443 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2444 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2445 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2446 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2447 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2448
2449 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2450 .cindex "lock files"
2451 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2452 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2453 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2454 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2455 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2456 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2457 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2458 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2459 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2460 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2461 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2462 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2463
2464 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2465 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2466 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2467 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2468 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2469 incoming SMTP mail.
2470
2471 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2472 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2473 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2474 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2475 production version.
2476
2477
2478 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2479 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2480 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2481 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2482 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2483 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2484 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2485 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2486 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2487 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2488 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2489 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2490 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2491
2492 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2493 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2494 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2495 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2496 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2497 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2498 as follows:
2499 .code
2500 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2501 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2502 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2503 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2504 .endd
2505 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2506 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2507 favourite user agent.
2508
2509 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2510 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2511 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2512 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2513 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2514 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2515
2516
2517
2518 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2519 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2520 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2521 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2522 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2523 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2524 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2525 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2526 configuration file.
2527
2528
2529
2530
2531 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2532 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2533 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2534 .code
2535 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2536 .endd
2537 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2538 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2539 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2540 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2541 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2542 .code
2543 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2544 .endd
2545 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2546
2547 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2548 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2549 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2550
2551
2552
2553
2554 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2555 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2556
2557 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2558 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2559 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2560 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2561 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2562 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2563 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2564 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2565 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2566
2567
2568 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2569 .cindex "&'mailq'&"
2570 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2571 were present before any other options.
2572 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2573 standard output.
2574 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2575 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2576 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2577
2578 .cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2579 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2580 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2581 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2582 format.
2583
2584 .cindex "&'rmail'&"
2585 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2586 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2587 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2588
2589 .cindex "&'runq'&"
2590 .cindex "queue runner"
2591 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2592 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2593 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2594
2595 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2596 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2597 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2598 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2599 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2600 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2601 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2602 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2603
2604
2605 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2606 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2607 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2608 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2609 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2610 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2611
2612 .ilist
2613 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2614 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2615 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2616 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2617 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2618 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2619
2620 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2621 .cindex "envelope sender"
2622 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2623 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2624 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2625 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2626 users to set envelope senders.
2627
2628 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2629 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2630 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2631 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2632 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2633
2634 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2635 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2636 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2637 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2638 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2639 that are available to trusted users.
2640 .next
2641 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2642 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2643 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2644 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2645 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2646
2647 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2648 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2649 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2650 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2651
2652 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2653 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2654 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2655 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2656
2657 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2658 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2659 false.
2660 .endlist
2661
2662
2663 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2664 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2665 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2666 &<<CHAPconf>>&.
2667
2668
2669
2670
2671 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2672 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2673 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2674 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2675 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2676 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2677 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2678 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2679
2680 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2681 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2682 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2683 . creates a man page for the options.
2684 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2685
2686 .literal xml
2687 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2688 .literal off
2689
2690
2691 .vlist
2692 .vitem &%--%&
2693 .oindex "--"
2694 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2695 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2696 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2697 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2698
2699 .vitem &%--help%&
2700 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2701 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2702 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2703 no arguments.
2704
2705 .vitem &%--version%&
2706 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2707 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2708 displayed.
2709
2710 .vitem &%-Ac%& &&&
2711 &%-Am%&
2712 .oindex "&%-Ac%&"
2713 .oindex "&%-Am%&"
2714 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2715 ignored by Exim.
2716
2717 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2718 .oindex "&%-B%&"
2719 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2720 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2721 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2722 clean; it ignores this option.
2723
2724 .vitem &%-bd%&
2725 .oindex "&%-bd%&"
2726 .cindex "daemon"
2727 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2728 .cindex "queue runner"
2729 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2730 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2731 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2732
2733 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2734 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2735 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2736 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2737
2738 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2739 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2740 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2741 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2742
2743 When a listening daemon
2744 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2745 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2746 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2747 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2748 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2749 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2750 running as root.
2751
2752 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2753 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2754 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2755
2756 The SIGHUP signal
2757 .cindex "SIGHUP"
2758 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2759 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2760 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2761 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2762 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2763 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2764 because these are reread each time they are used.
2765
2766 .vitem &%-bdf%&
2767 .oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2768 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2769 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2770
2771 .vitem &%-be%&
2772 .oindex "&%-be%&"
2773 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2774 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2775 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2776 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2777 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2778 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2779
2780 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2781 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2782 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2783 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2784 test data. A line history is supported.
2785
2786 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2787 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2788 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2789 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2790 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2791 message-specific values (such as &$sender_domain$&) are set, because no message
2792 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2793
2794 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2795 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2796 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2797 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2798
2799 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2800 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
2801 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2802 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2803 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2804 of a file. For example:
2805 .code
2806 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2807 .endd
2808 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2809 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2810 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2811 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2812 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2813 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2814 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2815 &%-be%&).
2816
2817 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2818 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
2819 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2820 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2821 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2822 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2823 system filters are recognized.
2824
2825 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2826 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
2827 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2828 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2829 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2830 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2831 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2832 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2833 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2834 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2835 supplied.
2836
2837 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2838 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2839 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2840 .code
2841 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2842 .endd
2843 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2844 variables that are used by the user filter.
2845
2846 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2847 .code
2848 # Exim filter
2849 # Sieve filter
2850 .endd
2851 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2852 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2853 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2854 redirection lists.
2855
2856 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2857 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2858 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2859 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2860
2861 When testing a filter file,
2862 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2863 .cindex "envelope sender"
2864 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2865 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2866 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2867 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2868 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2869 options).
2870
2871 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2872 .oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2873 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2874 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2875 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2876 &$qualify_domain$&.
2877
2878 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2879 .oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2880 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2881 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2882 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2883 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2884 actually being delivered.
2885
2886 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2887 .oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2888 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2889 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2890 prefix.
2891
2892 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2893 .oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2894 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2895 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2896 suffix.
2897
2898 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2899 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
2900 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2901 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2902 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2903 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2904 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2905 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2906 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2907 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2908 after a full stop. For example:
2909 .code
2910 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2911 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2912 .endd
2913 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2914 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2915 conversion to the canonical form is
2916 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2917
2918 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2919 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2920 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2921 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2922 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2923
2924 &*Warning 1*&:
2925 .cindex "RFC 1413"
2926 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2927 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2928 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2929 connection.
2930
2931 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2932 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2933 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2934
2935 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2936 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2937 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2938 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2939 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2940 session were authenticated.
2941
2942 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2943 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2944 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2945
2946 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2947 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2948 specialized SMTP test program such as
2949 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2950
2951 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2952 .oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2953 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2954 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2955 updating the callout cache database.
2956
2957 .vitem &%-bi%&
2958 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
2959 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2960 .cindex "building alias file"
2961 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2962 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2963 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2964 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2965 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2966 recognized.
2967
2968 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2969 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2970 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2971 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2972 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2973 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2974 &%-bi%& is a no-op.
2975
2976 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2977 .vitem &%-bI:help%&
2978 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2979 .cindex "querying exim information"
2980 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2981 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2982 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
2983 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
2984 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
2985
2986 .vitem &%-bI:dscp%&
2987 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
2988 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
2989 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
2990 recognised DSCP names.
2991
2992 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
2993 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
2994 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
2995 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
2996 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
2997 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
2998 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
2999 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3000 way to guarantee a correct response.
3001
3002 .vitem &%-bm%&
3003 .oindex "&%-bm%&"
3004 .cindex "local message reception"
3005 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3006 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3007 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3008 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3009 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3010 if no other conflicting option is present.
3011
3012 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3013 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3014 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3015 suppressing this for special cases.
3016
3017 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3018 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3019
3020 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3021 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3022 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3023
3024 The format
3025 .cindex "message" "format"
3026 .cindex "format" "message"
3027 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3028 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3029 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3030 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3031 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3032 .code
3033 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3034 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3035 .endd
3036 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3037 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3038 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3039 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3040 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3041
3042 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3043 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3044 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3045 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3046 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3047
3048 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3049 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3050 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3051 .cindex "malware scan test"
3052 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file,
3053 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3054 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3055 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3056 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3057 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3058
3059 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3060 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3061 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3062 This option requires admin privileges.
3063
3064 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3065 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3066 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3067
3068 .vitem &%-bnq%&
3069 .oindex "&%-bnq%&"
3070 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3071 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3072 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3073 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3074 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3075 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3076 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3077
3078 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3079 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3080 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3081 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3082 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3083
3084 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3085 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3086 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3087 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3088
3089
3090 .vitem &%-bP%&
3091 .oindex "&%-bP%&"
3092 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3093 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3094 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3095 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3096 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3097 arguments, for example:
3098 .code
3099 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3100 .endd
3101 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3102 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3103 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3104 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3105 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3106 users, the output is as in this example:
3107 .code
3108 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3109 .endd
3110 If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3111 output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3112
3113 If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3114 configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3115 backward compatibility.)
3116 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3117 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3118
3119 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3120 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3121 name will not be output.
3122
3123 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3124 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3125 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3126 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3127 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3128 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3129 written directly into the spool directory.
3130
3131 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3132 .code
3133 exim -bP +local_domains
3134 .endd
3135 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3136 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3137
3138 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3139 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3140 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3141 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3142 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3143 that driver are output. For example:
3144 .code
3145 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3146 .endd
3147 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3148 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3149 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3150 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3151 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3152 &%authenticators%&.
3153
3154 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3155 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3156 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3157 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3158 The output format is one item per line.
3159
3160 .vitem &%-bp%&
3161 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
3162 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3163 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3164 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3165 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3166 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3167 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3168 to allow any user to see the queue.
3169
3170 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3171 .code
3172 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3173 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3174 <other addresses>
3175 .endd
3176 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3177 .cindex "size" "of message"
3178 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3179 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3180 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3181 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3182 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3183 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3184 before the sender address.
3185
3186 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3187 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3188 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3189
3190 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3191 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3192 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3193 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3194 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3195 complete.
3196
3197
3198 .vitem &%-bpa%&
3199 .oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3200 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3201 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3202 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3203 of just &"D"&.
3204
3205
3206 .vitem &%-bpc%&
3207 .oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3208 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3209 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3210 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3211 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3212
3213
3214 .vitem &%-bpr%&
3215 .oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3216 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3217 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3218 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3219 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3220
3221 .vitem &%-bpra%&
3222 .oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3223 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3224
3225 .vitem &%-bpru%&
3226 .oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3227 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3228
3229
3230 .vitem &%-bpu%&
3231 .oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3232 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3233 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3234 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3235 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3236
3237
3238 .vitem &%-brt%&
3239 .oindex "&%-brt%&"
3240 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3241 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3242 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3243 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3244 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3245 .code
3246 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3247 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3248 .endd
3249 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3250 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3251 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3252 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3253 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3254 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3255 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3256 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3257 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3258 .code
3259 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3260 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3261 .endd
3262
3263 .vitem &%-brw%&
3264 .oindex "&%-brw%&"
3265 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3266 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3267 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3268 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3269 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3270 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3271 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3272
3273 .vitem &%-bS%&
3274 .oindex "&%-bS%&"
3275 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3276 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3277 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3278 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3279 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3280 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3281 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3282 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3283 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3284
3285 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3286 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3287 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3288
3289 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3290 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3291 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3292 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3293
3294 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3295 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3296 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3297
3298 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3299 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3300 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3301 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3302 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3303
3304 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3305 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3306
3307 .vitem &%-bs%&
3308 .oindex "&%-bs%&"
3309 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3310 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3311 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3312 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3313 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3314 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3315 messages to the MTA.
3316
3317 In
3318 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3319 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3320 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3321 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3322 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3323 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3324 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3325
3326 .cindex "inetd"
3327 The
3328 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3329 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3330 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3331 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3332 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3333 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3334 the listening daemon.
3335
3336 .vitem &%-bt%&
3337 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
3338 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3339 .cindex "address" "testing"
3340 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3341 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3342 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3343 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3344 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3345
3346 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3347 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3348
3349 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3350 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3351 security issues.
3352
3353 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3354 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3355 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3356 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3357 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3358 program.
3359
3360 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3361 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3362 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3363 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3364
3365 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3366 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3367 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3368 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3369 always shown.
3370
3371 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3372 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3373 message,
3374 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3375 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3376 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3377 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3378 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3379 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3380 doing such tests.
3381
3382 .vitem &%-bV%&
3383 .oindex "&%-bV%&"
3384 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3385 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3386 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3387 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3388 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3389 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3390
3391 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3392 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3393 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3394 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3395 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3396 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3397 dynamic testing facilities.
3398
3399 .vitem &%-bv%&
3400 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
3401 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3402 .cindex "address" "verification"
3403 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3404 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3405 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3406 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3407 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3408 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3409
3410 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3411 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3412 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3413
3414 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3415 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3416
3417 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3418 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3419 security issues.
3420
3421 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3422 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3423 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3424 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3425 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3426
3427 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3428 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3429 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3430 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3431 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3432 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3433 to succeed.
3434
3435 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3436 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3437 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3438
3439 The
3440 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3441 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3442 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3443 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3444
3445 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3446 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3447 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3448 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3449
3450 .vitem &%-bvs%&
3451 .oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3452 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3453 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3454 might happen.
3455
3456 .vitem &%-bw%&
3457 .oindex "&%-bw%&"
3458 .cindex "daemon"
3459 .cindex "inetd"
3460 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3461 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3462 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3463 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3464
3465 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3466 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3467 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3468 each port only when the first connection is received.
3469
3470 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3471 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3472
3473 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3474 .oindex "&%-C%&"
3475 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3476 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3477 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3478 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3479 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3480 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3481 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3482 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3483 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3484
3485 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3486 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3487 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3488 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3489 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3490 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3491 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3492 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3493 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3494
3495 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3496 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3497 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3498 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3499 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3500 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3501 on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3502
3503 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3504 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3505 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3506 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3507 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3508 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3509 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3510
3511 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3512 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3513 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3514 configuration file.
3515
3516 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3517 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3518 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3519 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3520 specified by this option.
3521
3522
3523 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3524 .oindex "&%-D%&"
3525 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3526 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3527 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3528 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3529 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3530 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3531
3532 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3533 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3534 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3535 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3536 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3537 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3538 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3539
3540 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3541 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3542 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3543 synonymous:
3544 .code
3545 exim -DABC ...
3546 exim -DABC= ...
3547 .endd
3548 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3549 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3550 example:
3551 .code
3552 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3553 .endd
3554 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3555 .new
3556 Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3557 .wen
3558
3559
3560 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3561 .oindex "&%-d%&"
3562 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3563 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3564 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3565 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3566 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3567 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3568 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3569 return code.
3570
3571 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3572 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3573 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3574 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3575 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3576 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3577 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3578 are:
3579 .display
3580 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3581 &`auth `& authenticators
3582 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3583 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3584 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3585 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3586 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3587 &`filter `& filter handling
3588 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3589 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3590 &`ident `& ident lookup
3591 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3592 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3593 &`load `& system load checks
3594 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3595 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3596 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3597 &`memory `& memory handling
3598 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3599 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3600 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3601 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3602 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3603 &`retry `& retry handling
3604 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3605 &`route `& address routing
3606 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3607 &`tls `& TLS logic
3608 &`transport `& transports
3609 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3610 &`verify `& address verification logic
3611 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3612 .endd
3613 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3614 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3615 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3616 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3617 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3618 turn everything off.
3619
3620 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3621 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3622 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3623 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3624 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3625 rather than stderr.
3626
3627 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3628 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3629 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3630 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3631 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3632 run in parallel.
3633
3634 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3635 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3636 in processing.
3637
3638 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3639 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3640
3641 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3642 .oindex "&%-dd%&"
3643 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3644 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3645 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3646 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3647
3648 .vitem &%-dropcr%&
3649 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3650 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3651 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3652 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3653
3654 .vitem &%-E%&
3655 .oindex "&%-E%&"
3656 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3657 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3658 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3659 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3660 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3661 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3662 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3663 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3664
3665 .vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3666 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3667 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3668 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3669 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3670 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3671
3672 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3673 .oindex "&%-F%&"
3674 .cindex "sender" "name"
3675 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3676 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3677 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3678 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3679 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3680 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3681
3682 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3683 .oindex "&%-f%&"
3684 .cindex "sender" "address"
3685 .cindex "address" "sender"
3686 .cindex "trusted users"
3687 .cindex "envelope sender"
3688 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3689 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3690 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3691 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3692 users to use it.
3693
3694 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3695 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3696 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3697 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3698 domain.
3699
3700 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3701 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3702 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3703 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3704 examples of shell commands:
3705 .code
3706 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3707 exim -f "" user@domain
3708 .endd
3709 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3710 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3711 &%-bv%& options.
3712
3713 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3714 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3715 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3716 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3717
3718 White
3719 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3720 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3721 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3722 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3723 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3724 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3725
3726 .vitem &%-G%&
3727 .oindex "&%-G%&"
3728 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3729 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3730 .code
3731 control = suppress_local_fixups
3732 .endd
3733 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3734 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3735 in future.
3736
3737 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3738 this option.
3739
3740 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3741 .oindex "&%-h%&"
3742 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3743 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3744 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3745 headers.)
3746
3747 .vitem &%-i%&
3748 .oindex "&%-i%&"
3749 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3750 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3751 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3752 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3753 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3754 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3755
3756 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3757 .oindex "&%-L%&"
3758 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3759 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3760 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3761 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3762 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3763 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3764
3765 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3766
3767 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3768 .oindex "&%-M%&"
3769 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3770 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3771 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3772 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3773 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3774 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3775 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3776
3777 Retry
3778 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3779 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3780 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3781 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3782 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3783 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3784
3785 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3786 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3787 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3788 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3789
3790 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3791 .oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3792 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3793 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3794 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3795 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3796 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3797 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3798 can be used only by an admin user.
3799
3800 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3801 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3802 .oindex "&%-MC%&"
3803 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3804 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3805 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3806 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3807 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3808 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3809 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3810 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3811
3812 .vitem &%-MCA%&
3813 .oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3814 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3815 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3816 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3817
3818 .vitem &%-MCD%&
3819 .oindex "&%-MCD%&"
3820 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3821 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3822 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3823
3824 .vitem &%-MCP%&
3825 .oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3826 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3827 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3828 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3829
3830 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3831 .oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3832 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3833 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3834 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3835 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3836 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3837 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3838
3839 .vitem &%-MCS%&
3840 .oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3841 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3842 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3843 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3844 connection.
3845
3846 .vitem &%-MCT%&
3847 .oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3848 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3849 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3850 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3851
3852 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3853 .oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3854 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3855 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3856 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3857 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3858 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3859 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3860 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3861 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3862 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3863 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3864 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3865 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3866 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3867
3868 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3869 .oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3870 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3871 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3872 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3873 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3874 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3875 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3876 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3877 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3878
3879 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3880 .oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3881 .cindex "freezing messages"
3882 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3883 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3884 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3885 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3886 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3887 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3888 user.
3889
3890 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3891 .oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3892 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3893 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3894 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3895 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3896 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3897 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3898 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3899 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3900 user.
3901
3902 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3903 .oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3904 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3905 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3906 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3907 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3908 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3909
3910 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3911 .oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3912 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3913 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3914 .cindex "removing recipients"
3915 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3916 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3917 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3918 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3919 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3920 can be used only by an admin user.
3921
3922 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3923 .oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
3924 .cindex "removing messages"
3925 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3926 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3927 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3928 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3929 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3930 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3931 placed on the queue.
3932
3933 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3934 .oindex "&%-Mset%&
3935 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3936 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3937 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3938 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3939 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3940 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3941 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3942 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3943 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3944
3945 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3946 .oindex "&%-Mt%&"
3947 .cindex "thawing messages"
3948 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3949 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3950 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3951 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3952 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3953 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3954 by an admin user.
3955
3956 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3957 .oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
3958 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3959 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3960 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3961 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3962
3963 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3964 .oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
3965 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3966 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3967 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3968 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3969 only by an admin user.
3970
3971 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3972 .oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
3973 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
3974 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
3975 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3976 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3977 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3978
3979 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3980 .oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
3981 .cindex "listing" "message log"
3982 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
3983 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3984 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3985
3986 .vitem &%-m%&
3987 .oindex "&%-m%&"
3988 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3989 treats it that way too.
3990
3991 .vitem &%-N%&
3992 .oindex "&%-N%&"
3993 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
3994 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
3995 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
3996 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
3997 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
3998 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
3999 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4000 than &"=>"&.
4001
4002 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4003 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4004 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4005 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4006 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4007 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4008 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4009 for that message.
4010
4011 .vitem &%-n%&
4012 .oindex "&%-n%&"
4013 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4014 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4015 When combined with &%-bP%& it suppresses the name of an option from being output.
4016
4017 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4018 .oindex "&%-O%&"
4019 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4020 Exim.
4021
4022 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4023 .oindex "&%-oA%&"
4024 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4025 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4026 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4027 description above.
4028
4029 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4030 .oindex "&%-oB%&"
4031 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4032 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4033 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4034 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4035 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4036 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4037
4038 .vitem &%-odb%&
4039 .oindex "&%-odb%&"
4040 .cindex "background delivery"
4041 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4042 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4043 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4044 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4045 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4046 processes to finish.
4047
4048 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4049 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4050 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4051 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4052
4053 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4054 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4055 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4056 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4057
4058 .vitem &%-odf%&
4059 .oindex "&%-odf%&"
4060 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4061 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4062 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4063 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4064 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4065 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4066
4067 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4068 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4069 during deliveries.
4070
4071 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4072 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4073
4074 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4075 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4076 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4077 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4078
4079
4080 .vitem &%-odi%&
4081 .oindex "&%-odi%&"
4082 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4083 Sendmail.
4084
4085 .vitem &%-odq%&
4086 .oindex "&%-odq%&"
4087 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4088 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4089 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4090 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4091 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4092 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4093 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4094 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4095 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4096 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4097 forces queueing.
4098
4099 .vitem &%-odqs%&
4100 .oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4101 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4102 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4103 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4104 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4105 configuration file is in effect.
4106
4107 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4108 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4109 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4110 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4111 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4112 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4113 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4114 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4115 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4116 &%-qq%& option.
4117
4118 .vitem &%-oee%&
4119 .oindex "&%-oee%&"
4120 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4121 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4122 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4123 message.
4124
4125 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4126 Provided
4127 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4128 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4129 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4130 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4131
4132 .vitem &%-oem%&
4133 .oindex "&%-oem%&"
4134 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4135 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4136 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4137 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4138 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4139
4140 .vitem &%-oep%&
4141 .oindex "&%-oep%&"
4142 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4143 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4144 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4145 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4146 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4147
4148 .vitem &%-oeq%&
4149 .oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4150 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4151 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4152 effect as &%-oep%&.
4153
4154 .vitem &%-oew%&
4155 .oindex "&%-oew%&"
4156 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4157 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4158 effect as &%-oem%&.
4159
4160 .vitem &%-oi%&
4161 .oindex "&%-oi%&"
4162 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4163 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4164 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4165 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4166 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4167 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4168
4169 .vitem &%-oitrue%&
4170 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4171 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4172
4173 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4174 .oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4175 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4176 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4177 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4178 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4179 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4180 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4181
4182 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4183 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4184 .code
4185 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4186 .endd
4187 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4188 followed by a colon and the port number:
4189 .code
4190 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4191 .endd
4192 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4193 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4194 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4195 whichever one is last.
4196
4197 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4198 .oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4199 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4200 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4201 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4202 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4203 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4204 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4205
4206 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4207 .oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4208 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4209 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4210 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4211 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4212 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4213 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4214
4215 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4216 .oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4217 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4218 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4219 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4220 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4221 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4222 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4223 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4224 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4225
4226 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4227 .oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4228 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4229 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4230 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4231 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4232 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4233
4234 .vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4235 .oindex "&%-oMm%&"
4236 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4237 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4238 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4239 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4240 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4241 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4242 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4243
4244 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4245 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4246 is sending the bounce.
4247
4248 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4249 .oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4250 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4251 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4252 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4253 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4254 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4255 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4256 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4257 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4258 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4259 be set by &%-oMr%&.
4260
4261 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4262 .oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4263 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4264 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4265 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4266 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4267 uses the name it is given.
4268
4269 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4270 .oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4271 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4272 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4273 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4274 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4275 used, when there is no default.
4276
4277 .vitem &%-om%&
4278 .oindex "&%-om%&"
4279 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4280 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4281 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4282 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4283
4284 .vitem &%-oo%&
4285 .oindex "&%-oo%&"
4286 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4287 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4288 whatever that means.
4289
4290 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4291 .oindex "&%-oP%&"
4292 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4293 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4294 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4295 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4296 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4297 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4298 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4299
4300 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4301 .oindex "&%-or%&"
4302 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4303 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4304 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4305 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4306 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4307
4308 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4309 .oindex "&%-os%&"
4310 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4311 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4312 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4313 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4314 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4315 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4316
4317 .vitem &%-ov%&
4318 .oindex "&%-ov%&"
4319 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4320
4321 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4322 .oindex "&%-oX%&"
4323 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4324 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4325 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4326 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4327 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4328 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4329 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4330 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4331
4332 .vitem &%-pd%&
4333 .oindex "&%-pd%&"
4334 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4335 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4336 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4337 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4338 needed.
4339
4340 .vitem &%-ps%&
4341 .oindex "&%-ps%&"
4342 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4343 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4344 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4345 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4346 started.
4347
4348 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4349 .oindex "&%-p%&"
4350 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4351 .display
4352 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4353 .endd
4354 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4355 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4356 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4357 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4358 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4359
4360 .vitem &%-q%&
4361 .oindex "&%-q%&"
4362 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4363 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4364 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4365 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4366 and &%-S%& options).
4367
4368 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4369 The &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4370 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4371 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4372 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4373 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4374
4375 If
4376 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4377 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4378 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4379 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4380 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4381 proceeding.
4382
4383 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4384 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4385 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4386 this to be repeated periodically.
4387
4388 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4389 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4390 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4391 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4392
4393 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4394 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4395 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4396
4397 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4398 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4399 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4400 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4401
4402 .vitem &%-qq...%&
4403 .oindex "&%-qq%&"
4404 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4405 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4406 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4407 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4408 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4409 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4410 transports are run.
4411
4412 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4413 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4414 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4415 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4416 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4417 delivered down a single SMTP
4418 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4419 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4420 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4421 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4422 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4423 intermittently.
4424
4425 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4426 .oindex "&%-qi%&"
4427 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4428 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4429 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4430 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4431 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4432
4433 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4434 .oindex "&%-qf%&"
4435 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4436 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4437 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4438 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4439 their retry times are tried.
4440
4441 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4442 .oindex "&%-qff%&"
4443 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4444 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4445 frozen or not.
4446
4447 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4448 .oindex "&%-ql%&"
4449 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4450 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4451 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4452 for later delivery.
4453
4454 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4455 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4456 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4457 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4458 starting message id. For example:
4459 .code
4460 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4461 .endd
4462 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4463 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4464 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4465 .code
4466 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4467 .endd
4468 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4469 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4470 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4471 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4472 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4473 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4474
4475 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4476 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4477 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4478 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4479 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4480 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4481 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4482 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4483 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4484 .code
4485 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4486 .endd
4487 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4488 process every 30 minutes.
4489
4490 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4491 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4492
4493 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4494 .oindex "&%-qR%&"
4495 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4496 compatibility.
4497
4498 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4499 .oindex "&%-qS%&"
4500 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4501
4502 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4503 .oindex "&%-R%&"
4504 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4505 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4506 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4507 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4508 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4509 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4510 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4511
4512 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4513 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4514 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4515 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4516 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4517 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4518
4519 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4520 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4521 .code
4522 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4523 .endd
4524 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4525 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4526 applied to each queue run.
4527
4528 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4529 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4530 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4531 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4532 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4533 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4534 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4535 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4536 address will be skipped.
4537
4538 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4539 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4540 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4541 &'ff'& is present.
4542
4543 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4544 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4545 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4546 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4547 an arbitrary command instead.
4548
4549 .vitem &%-r%&
4550 .oindex "&%-r%&"
4551 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4552
4553 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4554 .oindex "&%-S%&"
4555 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4556 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4557 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4558 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4559 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4560 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4561
4562 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4563 .oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4564 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4565 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4566 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4567
4568 .vitem &%-t%&
4569 .oindex "&%-t%&"
4570 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4571 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4572 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4573 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4574 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4575 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4576 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4577 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4578 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4579
4580 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4581 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4582 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4583 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4584 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4585 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4586 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4587 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4588 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4589 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4590 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4591
4592 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4593 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4594 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4595 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4596 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4597 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4598
4599 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4600 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4601 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4602 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4603 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4604 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4605 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4606 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4607 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4608
4609 .vitem &%-ti%&
4610 .oindex "&%-ti%&"
4611 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4612 compatibility with Sendmail.
4613
4614 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4615 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4616 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4617 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4618 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4619 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4620 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4621 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4622
4623
4624 .vitem &%-U%&
4625 .oindex "&%-U%&"
4626 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4627 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4628 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4629 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4630 set. Exim ignores this option.
4631
4632 .vitem &%-v%&
4633 .oindex "&%-v%&"
4634 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4635 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4636 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4637 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4638 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4639 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4640 unconditional.
4641
4642 .vitem &%-x%&
4643 .oindex "&%-x%&"
4644 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4645 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4646 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4647 this option.
4648
4649 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4650 .oindex "&%-X%&"
4651 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4652 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4653
4654 .vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4655 .oindex "&%-z%&"
4656 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4657 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4658 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4659 under most shells.
4660 .endlist
4661
4662 .ecindex IIDclo1
4663 .ecindex IIDclo2
4664
4665
4666 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4667 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4668 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4669 . creates a man page for the options.
4670 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4671
4672 .literal xml
4673 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4674 .literal off
4675
4676
4677
4678
4679
4680 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4681 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4682
4683
4684 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4685 "The runtime configuration file"
4686
4687 .cindex "run time configuration"
4688 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4689 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4690 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4691 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4692 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4693 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4694 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4695 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4696 control.
4697
4698 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4699 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4700 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4701 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4702 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4703 actually alter the string.
4704
4705 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4706 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4707 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4708 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4709 existing file in the list.
4710
4711 .cindex "EXIM_USER"
4712 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4713 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4714 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4715 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4716 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4717 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4718 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4719 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4720 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4721 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4722
4723 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4724 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4725 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4726 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4727 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4728
4729 Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4730 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4731 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4732 compromise the Exim user account.
4733
4734 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4735 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4736 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4737 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4738 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4739 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4740 configuration.
4741
4742
4743
4744 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4745 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4746 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4747 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4748 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4749 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4750 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4751 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4752 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4753 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4754 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4755
4756 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4757 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4758 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4759 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4760 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4761 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4762 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4763 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4764 message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4765 &%-M%&).
4766
4767 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4768 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4769 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4770 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4771 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4772
4773 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4774 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4775 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4776 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4777 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4778 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4779
4780 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4781 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4782 necessarily be discarded.
4783 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4784 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4785 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4786 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4787 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4788 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4789
4790 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4791 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4792 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4793 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4794 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4795 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4796 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4797
4798 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4799 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4800 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4801
4802
4803
4804 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4805 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4806 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4807 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4808 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4809 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4810 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4811 space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4812
4813 .ilist
4814 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4815 &<<CHAPACL>>&).
4816 .next
4817 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4818 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4819 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4820 .next
4821 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4822 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4823 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4824 .next
4825 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4826 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4827 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4828 .next
4829 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4830 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4831 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4832 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4833 &<<CHAPretry>>&.
4834 .next
4835 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4836 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4837 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4838 .next
4839 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4840 want to use this feature, you must set
4841 .code
4842 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4843 .endd
4844 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4845 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4846 .endlist
4847
4848 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4849 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4850 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4851 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4852
4853 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4854 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4855 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4856 and does not introduce a comment.
4857
4858 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4859 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4860 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4861 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4862 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4863
4864 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4865 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4866 change settings as required.
4867
4868 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4869 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4870 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4871 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4872 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4873 described.
4874
4875
4876
4877 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4878 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4879 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4880 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4881 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4882 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4883 using this syntax:
4884 .display
4885 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4886 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4887 .endd
4888 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4889 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4890 second form does nothing for non-existent files. In all cases, an absolute file
4891 name is required.
4892
4893 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4894 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4895 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4896 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4897
4898 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4899 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4900 for example:
4901 .code
4902 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4903 .include /some/file
4904 .endd
4905 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4906 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4907 inclusion appears.
4908
4909
4910
4911 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4912 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4913 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4914 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4915 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4916 definition, and must be of the form
4917 .display
4918 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4919 .endd
4920 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4921 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4922 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4923 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4924 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4925
4926 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4927 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4928 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4929
4930 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4931 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4932 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4933 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4934 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4935 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4936 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4937 define
4938 .display
4939 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4940 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4941 .endd
4942 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4943 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4944 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4945 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4946 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4947 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4948
4949
4950 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4951 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4952 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4953 &'='&. For example:
4954 .code
4955 MAC = initial value
4956 ...
4957 MAC == updated value
4958 .endd
4959 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
4960 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
4961 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
4962 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
4963 .code
4964 MAC = initial value
4965 ...
4966 MAC == MAC and something added
4967 .endd
4968 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
4969 from a number of other files.
4970
4971 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
4972 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
4973 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
4974 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
4975 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
4976 file to be ignored.
4977
4978
4979
4980 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
4981 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4982 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4983 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4984 .code
4985 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4986 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
4987 .endd
4988 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
4989 .code
4990 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4991 .endd
4992 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4993 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
4994 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
4995
4996
4997 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
4998 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
4999 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5000 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5001 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5002 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5003 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5004
5005 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5006 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5007 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5008 line. Thus:
5009 .code
5010 .ifdef AAA
5011 message_size_limit = 50M
5012 .else
5013 message_size_limit = 100M
5014 .endif
5015 .endd
5016 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5017 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5018 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5019 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5020 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5021
5022 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5023 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5024 in this line"& will always be true.
5025
5026 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5027 to clarify complicated nestings.
5028
5029
5030
5031 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5032 .cindex "common option syntax"
5033 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5034 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5035 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5036 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5037 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5038 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5039 space) and then the value. For example:
5040 .code
5041 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5042 .endd
5043 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5044 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5045 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5046 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5047 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5048 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5049 word &"hide"&. For example:
5050 .code
5051 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5052 .endd
5053 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5054 .code
5055 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5056 .endd
5057 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5058 all instances of the same driver.
5059
5060 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5061 that are found in option settings.
5062
5063
5064 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5065 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5066 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5067 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5068 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5069 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5070 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5071 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5072 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5073 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5074 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5075 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5076 .code
5077 queue_only
5078 queue_only = true
5079 .endd
5080 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5081 .code
5082 no_queue_only
5083 queue_only = false
5084 .endd
5085 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5086
5087
5088
5089
5090 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5091 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5092 .cindex "format" "integer"
5093 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5094 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5095 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5096 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5097 hexadecimal number.
5098
5099 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5100 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024. When the values
5101 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5102 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5103 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5104 used.
5105
5106
5107 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5108 .cindex "integer format"
5109 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5110 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5111 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5112 Such options are always output in octal.
5113
5114
5115 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5116 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5117 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5118 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5119 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5120
5121
5122
5123 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5124 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5125 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5126 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5127 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5128
5129 .table2 30pt
5130 .irow &%s%& seconds
5131 .irow &%m%& minutes
5132 .irow &%h%& hours
5133 .irow &%d%& days
5134 .irow &%w%& weeks
5135 .endtable
5136
5137 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5138 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5139 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5140
5141
5142
5143 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5144 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5145 .cindex "format" "string"
5146 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5147 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5148 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5149 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5150 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5151 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5152 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5153 therefore equivalent:
5154 .code
5155 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5156 trusted_users = uucp:\
5157 # This comment line is ignored
5158 mail
5159 .endd
5160 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5161 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5162 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5163 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5164 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5165
5166 .table2 100pt
5167 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5168 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5169 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5170 .irow &`\t`& "tab"
5171 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5172 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5173 character"
5174 .endtable
5175
5176 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5177 character, that character replaces the pair.
5178
5179 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5180 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5181 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5182 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5183 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5184 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5185
5186
5187 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5188 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5189 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5190 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5191 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5192 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5193 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5194 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5195 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5196 within a quoted configuration string.
5197
5198
5199 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5200 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5201 .cindex "format" "user name"
5202 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5203 .cindex "format" "group name"
5204 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5205 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5206 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5207 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5208
5209
5210 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5211 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5212 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5213 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5214 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5215 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5216 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5217 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5218 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5219 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5220 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5221
5222 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5223 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5224 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5225 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5226 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5227 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5228 example, the list
5229 .code
5230 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5231 .endd
5232 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5233
5234 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5235 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5236 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5237 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5238
5239 .section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5240 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5241 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5242 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5243 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5244 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5245 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5246 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5247 .code
5248 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5249 .endd
5250 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5251 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5252 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5253
5254 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5255 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5256 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5257 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5258 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5259 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5260 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5261 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5262 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5263 .code
5264 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5265 .endd
5266 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5267 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5268 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5269 the value in quotes. For example:
5270 .code
5271 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5272 .endd
5273 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5274 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5275 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5276 enclosing an empty list item.
5277
5278
5279
5280 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5281 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5282 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5283 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5284 .code
5285 senders = user@domain :
5286 .endd
5287 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5288 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5289 items, the second of which is empty:
5290 .code
5291 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5292 .endd
5293 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5294 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5295 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5296 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5297 .code
5298 senders = :
5299 .endd
5300 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5301 is at the end of the list.
5302
5303
5304
5305
5306 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5307 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5308 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5309 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5310 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5311 a sequence of lines like this:
5312 .display
5313 <&'instance name'&>:
5314 <&'option'&>
5315 ...
5316 <&'option'&>
5317 .endd
5318 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5319 followed by three options settings:
5320 .code
5321 localuser:
5322 driver = accept
5323 check_local_user
5324 transport = local_delivery
5325 .endd
5326 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5327 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5328 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5329 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5330 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5331 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5332
5333 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5334 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5335
5336 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5337 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5338 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5339 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5340 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5341 server.
5342
5343 .cindex "generic options"
5344 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5345 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5346 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5347 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5348 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5349 .cindex "private options"
5350 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5351 they all have default values.
5352
5353 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5354 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5355 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5356
5357 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5358 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5359 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5360 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5361 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5362 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5363 configuration lines:
5364 .code
5365 remote_smtp:
5366 driver = smtp
5367 .endd
5368 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5369 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5370 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5371 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5372 thus:
5373 .code
5374 special_smtp:
5375 driver = smtp
5376 port = 1234
5377 command_timeout = 10s
5378 .endd
5379 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5380 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5381 lines.
5382
5383 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5384 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5385 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5386 option.
5387
5388
5389
5390
5391
5392
5393 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5394 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5395
5396 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5397 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5398 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5399 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5400 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5401 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5402 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5403 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5404 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5405 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5406 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5407
5408
5409
5410 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5411 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5412 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5413 the line
5414 .code
5415 # primary_hostname =
5416 .endd
5417 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5418 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5419 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5420 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5421
5422 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5423 .code
5424 domainlist local_domains = @
5425 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5426 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5427 .endd
5428 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5429 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5430 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5431 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5432
5433 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5434 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5435 on the local host.
5436
5437 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5438 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5439 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5440 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5441 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5442 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5443
5444 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5445 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5446 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5447 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5448 domain is permitted.
5449
5450 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5451 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5452 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5453 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5454 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5455 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5456
5457 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5458 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5459 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5460
5461 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5462 .code
5463 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5464 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5465 .endd
5466 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5467 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5468 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5469 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5470 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5471 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5472 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5473 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5474 contents of a message to be checked.
5475
5476 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5477 .code
5478 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5479 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5480 .endd
5481 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5482 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5483 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5484 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5485
5486 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5487 .code
5488 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5489 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5490 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5491 .endd
5492 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5493 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5494 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5495 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5496 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5497 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5498 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5499
5500 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5501 .code
5502 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5503 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5504 .endd
5505 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5506 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5507 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5508 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5509 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5510 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5511 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5512 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5513 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5514 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5515 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5516 on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5517 port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5518 configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5519 non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5520 &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5521
5522 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5523 .code
5524 # qualify_domain =
5525 # qualify_recipient =
5526 .endd
5527 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5528 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5529 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5530 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5531 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5532 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5533
5534 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5535 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5536 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5537 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5538 .code
5539 # allow_domain_literals
5540 .endd
5541 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5542 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5543 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5544 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5545 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5546 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5547
5548 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5549 .code
5550 never_users = root
5551 .endd
5552 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5553 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5554 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5555 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5556 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5557 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5558 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5559 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5560
5561 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5562 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5563 line,
5564 .code
5565 host_lookup = *
5566 .endd
5567 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5568 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5569 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5570 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5571 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5572 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5573 unreachable.
5574
5575 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5576 1413 (hence their names):
5577 .code
5578 rfc1413_hosts = *
5579 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5580 .endd
5581 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5582 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5583 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5584 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5585 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5586 information, you can change this.
5587
5588 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5589 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5590 .code
5591 prdr_enable = true
5592 .endd
5593
5594 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5595 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5596 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5597 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5598 .code
5599 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5600 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5601 .endd
5602 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5603 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5604
5605 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5606 over the default:
5607 .code
5608 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5609 +tls_certificate_verified
5610 .endd
5611
5612 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5613 .code
5614 # percent_hack_domains =
5615 .endd
5616 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5617 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5618 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5619
5620 The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5621 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5622 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5623 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5624 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5625 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5626 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5627 always bounce messages.
5628 .code
5629 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5630 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5631 .endd
5632 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5633 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5634 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5635 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5636 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5637
5638
5639
5640 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5641 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5642 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5643 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5644 It starts with the line
5645 .code
5646 begin acl
5647 .endd
5648 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5649 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5650 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5651
5652 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5653 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5654 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5655 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5656 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5657 result of the ACL processing.
5658 .code
5659 acl_check_rcpt:
5660 .endd
5661 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5662 ACL, and names it.
5663 .code
5664 accept hosts = :
5665 .endd
5666 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5667 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5668 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5669 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5670 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5671 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5672
5673 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5674 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5675 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5676 manner.
5677 .code
5678 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5679 domains = +local_domains
5680 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5681
5682 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5683 domains = !+local_domains
5684 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5685 .endd
5686 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5687 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5688 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5689 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5690 in Internet mail addresses.
5691
5692 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5693 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5694 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5695 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5696 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5697 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5698 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5699 policy of being as safe as possible.
5700
5701 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5702 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5703 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5704 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5705 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5706 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5707
5708 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5709 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5710 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5711 have to modify this rule.
5712
5713 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5714 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5715 common convention of local parts constructed as
5716 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5717 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5718 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5719 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5720 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5721 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5722
5723 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5724 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5725 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5726 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5727 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5728 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5729 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5730 .code
5731 accept local_parts = postmaster
5732 domains = +local_domains
5733 .endd
5734 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5735 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5736 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5737 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5738 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5739
5740 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5741 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5742 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5743 .code
5744 require verify = sender
5745 .endd
5746 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5747 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5748 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5749 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5750 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5751 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5752 discusses the details of address verification.
5753 .code
5754 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5755 control = submission
5756 .endd
5757 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5758 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5759 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5760 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5761 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5762 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5763 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5764 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5765 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5766 .code
5767 accept authenticated = *
5768 control = submission
5769 .endd
5770 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5771 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5772 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5773 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5774 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5775 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5776 .code
5777 require message = relay not permitted
5778 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5779 .endd
5780 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5781 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5782 .code
5783 require verify = recipient
5784 .endd
5785 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5786 fails, the address is rejected.
5787 .code
5788 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5789 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5790 # $dnslist_text
5791 # dnslists = black.list.example
5792 #
5793 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5794 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5795 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5796 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5797 .endd
5798 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5799 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5800 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5801 line.
5802 .code
5803 # require verify = csa
5804 .endd
5805 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5806 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5807 records.
5808 .code
5809 accept
5810 .endd
5811 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5812 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5813 .code
5814 acl_check_data:
5815 .endd
5816 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5817 of this ACL are commented out:
5818 .code
5819 # deny malware = *
5820 # message = This message contains a virus \
5821 # ($malware_name).
5822 .endd
5823 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5824 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5825 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5826 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5827 .code
5828 # warn spam = nobody
5829 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5830 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5831 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5832 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5833 .endd
5834 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5835 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5836 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5837 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5838 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5839 whatever the spam score.
5840 .code
5841 accept
5842 .endd
5843 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5844
5845
5846 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5847 .cindex "default" "routers"
5848 .cindex "routers" "default"
5849 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5850 by the line
5851 .code
5852 begin routers
5853 .endd
5854 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5855 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5856 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5857 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5858 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5859 .code
5860 # domain_literal:
5861 # driver = ipliteral
5862 # domains = !+local_domains
5863 # transport = remote_smtp
5864 .endd
5865 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5866 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5867 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5868 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5869 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5870 .code
5871 dnslookup:
5872 driver = dnslookup
5873 domains = ! +local_domains
5874 transport = remote_smtp
5875 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5876 no_more
5877 .endd
5878 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5879 domains. This is specified by the line
5880 .code
5881 domains = ! +local_domains
5882 .endd
5883 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5884 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5885 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5886 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5887 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5888 passed on to the following routers.
5889
5890 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5891 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5892 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5893 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5894 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5895
5896 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5897 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5898 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
5899 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
5900 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
5901 the address fails and is bounced.
5902
5903 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5904 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5905 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5906 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5907 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5908 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5909 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5910 out.
5911 .code
5912 system_aliases:
5913 driver = redirect
5914 allow_fail
5915 allow_defer
5916 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5917 # user = exim
5918 file_transport = address_file
5919 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5920 .endd
5921 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5922 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5923 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5924 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5925 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5926 the next router.
5927
5928 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5929 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5930 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
5931 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
5932 .code
5933 userforward:
5934 driver = redirect
5935 check_local_user
5936 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5937 # local_part_suffix_optional
5938 file = $home/.forward
5939 # allow_filter
5940 no_verify
5941 no_expn
5942 check_ancestor
5943 file_transport = address_file
5944 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5945 reply_transport = address_reply
5946 .endd
5947 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5948 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5949 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
5950 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
5951 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
5952 namely:
5953 .code
5954 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5955 # local_part_suffix_optional
5956 .endd
5957 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
5958 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
5959 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
5960 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
5961 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
5962 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
5963 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
5964
5965 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
5966 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
5967 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
5968 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
5969
5970 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
5971 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5972 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
5973 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
5974 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
5975 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5976 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
5977
5978 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
5979 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
5980 There are two reasons for doing this:
5981
5982 .olist
5983 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
5984 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5985 unnecessary work.
5986 .next
5987 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
5988 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
5989 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5990 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
5991 this time.
5992 .endlist
5993
5994 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
5995 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
5996 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
5997 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
5998
5999 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6000 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6001 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6002 .code
6003 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6004 .endd
6005 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6006 transport.
6007 .code
6008 localuser:
6009 driver = accept
6010 check_local_user
6011 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6012 # local_part_suffix_optional
6013 transport = local_delivery
6014 .endd
6015 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6016 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6017 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6018 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6019 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6020
6021
6022 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6023 .cindex "default" "transports"
6024 .cindex "transports" "default"
6025 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6026 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6027 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6028 .code
6029 begin transports
6030 .endd
6031 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
6032 .code
6033 remote_smtp:
6034 driver = smtp
6035 hosts_try_prdr = *
6036 .endd
6037 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6038 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6039 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option.
6040 It is negotiated between client and server
6041 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
6042 All other options are defaulted.
6043 .code
6044 local_delivery:
6045 driver = appendfile
6046 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6047 delivery_date_add
6048 envelope_to_add
6049 return_path_add
6050 # group = mail
6051 # mode = 0660
6052 .endd
6053 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6054 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6055 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6056 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6057 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6058 show how this can be done.
6059
6060 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6061 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6062 similarly-named options above.
6063 .code
6064 address_pipe:
6065 driver = pipe
6066 return_output
6067 .endd
6068 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6069 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6070 option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6071 be returned to the sender.
6072 .code
6073 address_file:
6074 driver = appendfile
6075 delivery_date_add
6076 envelope_to_add
6077 return_path_add
6078 .endd
6079 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6080 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6081 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6082 .code
6083 address_reply:
6084 driver = autoreply
6085 .endd
6086 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6087 filter files.
6088
6089
6090
6091 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6092 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6093 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6094 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6095 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6096 introduced by the line
6097 .code
6098 begin retry
6099 .endd
6100 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6101 errors:
6102 .code
6103 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6104 .endd
6105 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6106 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6107 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6108 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced.
6109
6110 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6111 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6112 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6113
6114
6115 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6116 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6117 .code
6118 begin rewrite
6119 .endd
6120 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6121 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6122
6123
6124
6125 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6126 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6127 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6128 .code
6129 begin authenticators
6130 .endd
6131 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6132 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6133 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6134 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6135 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6136 to support most MUA software.
6137
6138 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6139 .code
6140 #PLAIN:
6141 # driver = plaintext
6142 # server_set_id = $auth2
6143 # server_prompts = :
6144 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6145 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6146 .endd
6147 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6148 .code
6149 #LOGIN:
6150 # driver = plaintext
6151 # server_set_id = $auth1
6152 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6153 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6154 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6155 .endd
6156
6157 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6158 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6159 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6160 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6161 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6162 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6163 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6164 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6165
6166 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6167 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6168 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6169 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6170
6171 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6172 usercode and password are in different positions.
6173 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6174
6175 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6176
6177
6178
6179 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6180 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6181
6182 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6183
6184 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6185 .cindex "PCRE"
6186 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6187 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6188 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6189 regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
6190 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6191 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6192
6193 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6194 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6195 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6196 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6197 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6198 case-insensitive.
6199
6200 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6201 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6202 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6203 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6204 .code
6205 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6206 .endd
6207 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6208 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6209 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6210 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6211 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6212 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6213 matched.
6214
6215 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6216 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6217 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6218 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6219 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6220 match anywhere in the subject string.
6221
6222 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6223 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6224 .code
6225 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6226 .endd
6227 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6228 You need to use:
6229 .code
6230 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6231 .endd
6232 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6233 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6234
6235
6236
6237 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6238 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6239
6240 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6241 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6242 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6243 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6244 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6245 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6246
6247 .olist
6248 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6249 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6250 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6251 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6252 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6253 The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6254 .next
6255 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6256 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6257 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6258 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6259 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6260 The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6261 .endlist
6262
6263 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6264 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6265 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6266 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6267 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6268 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6269
6270 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6271 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6272 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6273 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6274 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6275 .code
6276 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6277 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6278 .endd
6279 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6280 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6281 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6282 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6283 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6284 .code
6285 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6286 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6287 .endd
6288 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6289 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6290
6291 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6292 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6293 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6294 .code
6295 domain1:
6296 domain2:
6297 .endd
6298 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6299 matches the list item.
6300
6301 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6302 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6303 .code
6304 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6305 .endd
6306 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6307 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6308 causes a second lookup to occur.
6309
6310 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6311 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6312 lookup is permitted.
6313
6314
6315 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6316 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6317 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6318 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6319
6320 .ilist
6321 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6322 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6323 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6324 .next
6325 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6326 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6327 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6328 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6329 .endlist
6330
6331 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6332 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6333 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6334 .code
6335 LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6336 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6337 .endd
6338 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6339 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6340 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6341
6342
6343
6344
6345 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6346 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6347 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6348 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6349
6350 .ilist
6351 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6352 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6353 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6354 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6355 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6356 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6357 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6358 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6359 be found in several places:
6360 .display
6361 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6362 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6363 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6364 .endd
6365 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6366 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6367 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6368 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6369 .next
6370 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6371 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6372 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6373 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6374 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6375 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6376 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6377
6378 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6379 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6380 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6381 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6382 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6383 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6384 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6385 .next
6386 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6387 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6388 .cindex "sasldb2"
6389 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6390 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6391 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6392 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6393 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6394 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6395 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6396 .next
6397 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6398 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6399 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6400 .cindex "Courier"
6401 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6402 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6403 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6404 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6405 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6406 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6407 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6408 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6409 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6410 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6411 .next
6412 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6413 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6414 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6415 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6416 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6417 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6418 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6419 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6420 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6421 .next
6422 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6423 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6424 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6425 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6426 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6427 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6428 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6429 .code
6430 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6431 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6432 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6433 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6434 .endd
6435 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6436 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6437 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6438 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6439 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6440
6441 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6442 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6443 lookup types support only literal keys.
6444
6445 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6446 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6447 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6448 .next
6449 .cindex "linear search"
6450 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6451 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6452 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6453 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6454 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6455 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6456 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6457 in the file is used.
6458
6459 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6460 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6461 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6462 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6463 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6464 colon, for example:
6465 .code
6466 baduser: :fail:
6467 .endd
6468 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6469 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6470 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6471 wildcarding of any kind.
6472
6473 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6474 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6475 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6476 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6477 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6478 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6479 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6480 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6481 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6482
6483 .next
6484 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6485 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6486 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6487 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6488 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6489 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6490 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6491 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6492
6493 .next
6494 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6495 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6496 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6497 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6498 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6499 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6500 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6501 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6502 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6503
6504 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6505 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6506 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6507 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6508
6509 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6510 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6511
6512 .olist
6513 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6514 .code
6515 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6516 *fish data for anythingfish
6517 .endd
6518 .next
6519 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6520 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6521 .code
6522 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6523 .endd
6524 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6525 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6526 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6527 .code
6528 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6529 .endd
6530 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6531 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6532 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6533 .code
6534 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6535 .endd
6536
6537 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6538 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6539 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6540 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6541 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6542
6543 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6544 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6545 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6546 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6547 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6548
6549 .next
6550 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6551 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6552 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6553 example:
6554 .code
6555 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6556 .endd
6557 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6558 .endlist olist
6559
6560 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6561 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6562 be followed by optional colons.
6563
6564 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6565 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6566 lookup types support only literal keys.
6567 .endlist ilist
6568
6569
6570 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECID62"
6571 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6572 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6573 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6574 many of them are given in later sections.
6575
6576 .ilist
6577 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6578 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6579 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6580 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6581 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6582 .next
6583 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6584 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6585 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6586 .next
6587 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6588 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6589 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6590 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6591 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6592 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6593 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6594 .next
6595 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6596 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6597 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6598 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6599 .next
6600 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6601 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6602 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6603 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6604 .next
6605 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6606 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6607 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6608 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6609 .next
6610 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6611 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6612 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6613 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6614 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6615 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6616 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6617 password value. For example:
6618 .code
6619 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6620 .endd
6621 .next
6622 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6623 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6624 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6625 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6626
6627 .next
6628 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6629 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6630 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6631 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6632
6633 .next
6634 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6635 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6636 .next
6637 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6638 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6639 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6640 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6641 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6642 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6643 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6644 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6645 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6646 .code
6647 require condition = \
6648 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6649 .endd
6650 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6651 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6652 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6653 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6654 .endlist
6655
6656
6657
6658 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6659 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6660 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6661 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6662 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6663 options such as a list of local domains.
6664
6665 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6666 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6667 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6668 or may give up altogether.
6669
6670
6671
6672 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6673 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6674 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6675 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6676 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6677 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6678 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6679 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6680
6681 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6682 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6683 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6684
6685 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6686 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6687 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6688
6689 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6690 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6691 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6692 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6693 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6694 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6695 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6696 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6697 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6698 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6699 .code
6700 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6701 .endd
6702 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6703 looks up these keys, in this order:
6704 .code
6705 jane@eyre.example
6706 *@eyre.example
6707 *
6708 .endd
6709 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6710 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6711 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6712 Exim move on to try the next key.
6713
6714
6715
6716 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6717 .cindex "partial matching"
6718 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6719 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6720 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6721 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6722 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6723 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6724 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6725 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6726 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6727 a key in a DBM file is
6728 .code
6729 *.dates.fict.example
6730 .endd
6731 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6732 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6733 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6734 file.
6735
6736 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6737 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6738 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6739
6740 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6741 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6742 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6743 partial matching keys
6744 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6745 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6746 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6747
6748 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6749 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6750 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6751 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6752 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6753 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6754 remains.
6755
6756 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6757 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6758 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6759 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6760 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6761 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6762 .code
6763 2250.dates.fict.example
6764 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6765 *.dates.fict.example
6766 *.fict.example
6767 .endd
6768 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6769 finishes.
6770
6771 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6772 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6773 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6774 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6775 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6776 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6777 .code
6778 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6779 .endd
6780 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6781 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6782 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6783 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6784 .code
6785 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6786 .endd
6787 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6788 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6789
6790 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6791 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6792 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6793
6794 .ilist
6795 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6796 .next
6797 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6798 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6799 .next
6800 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6801 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6802 for &"*"& on its own.
6803 .next
6804 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6805 .endlist
6806
6807
6808 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6809 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6810 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6811 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6812 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6813 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6814 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6815
6816 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6817 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6818 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6819 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6820 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6821
6822
6823
6824
6825 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6826 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6827 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6828 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6829 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6830 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6831 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6832
6833 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6834 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6835 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6836 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6837 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6838 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6839
6840 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6841 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6842 complete.
6843
6844
6845
6846
6847 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6848 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6849 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6850 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6851 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6852 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6853 .code
6854 [name=$local_part]
6855 .endd
6856 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6857 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6858 .code
6859 [name="$local_part"]
6860 .endd
6861 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6862 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6863 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6864 of the following form is provided:
6865 .code
6866 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6867 .endd
6868 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6869 .code
6870 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6871 .endd
6872 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6873 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6874 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6875
6876
6877
6878
6879 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6880 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6881 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6882 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6883 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6884 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6885 an expansion string could contain:
6886 .code
6887 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6888 .endd
6889 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
6890 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
6891 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
6892 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
6893
6894 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
6895 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
6896 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
6897
6898 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
6899 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6900 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6901 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6902 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6903 .code
6904 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6905 .endd
6906 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6907 white space is ignored.
6908 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
6909 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
6910 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
6911
6912 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6913 When the type is PTR,
6914 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6915 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
6916 .code
6917 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6918 .endd
6919 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6920 altered and nothing is added.
6921
6922 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6923 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6924 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6925 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
6926 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
6927 The field separator can be modified as above.
6928
6929 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6930 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6931 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
6932 unless a field separator is specified.
6933 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
6934 For SPF records the
6935 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
6936 .code
6937 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
6938 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
6939 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
6940 .endd
6941 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6942 white space is ignored.
6943
6944 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6945 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
6946 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
6947 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
6948 specified.
6949 .code
6950 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
6951 .endd
6952
6953 .section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
6954 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
6955 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
6956 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
6957 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
6958 each followed by a comma,
6959 that may appear before the record type.
6960
6961 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6962 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6963 a defer-option modifier.
6964 The possible keywords are
6965 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
6966 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
6967 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
6968 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
6969 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
6970 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
6971 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
6972 .code
6973 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6974 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6975 .endd
6976 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
6977 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
6978
6979 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
6980 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
6981 The possible keywords are
6982 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
6983 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
6984 with the lookup.
6985 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
6986 is not labelled as authenticated data
6987 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
6988 The default is &"never"&.
6989
6990 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
6991
6992 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
6993 .cindex "DNS" timeout
6994 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
6995 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
6996 (e.g. &"5s"&).
6997 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
6998
6999 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7000 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7001 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7002
7003 .new
7004 .cindex cacheing "of dns lookup"
7005 .cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7006 .cindex DNS TTL
7007 Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7008 The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7009 value of the set of returned DNS records.
7010 .wen
7011
7012
7013 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7014 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7015 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7016 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7017 the pseudo-type MXH:
7018 .code
7019 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7020 .endd
7021 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7022 returned.
7023
7024 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7025 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7026 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7027 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7028 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7029 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7030 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7031 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7032 .code
7033 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7034 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7035 .endd
7036 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7037 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7038 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7039
7040 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7041 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7042 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7043 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7044 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7045 such a list.
7046
7047 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7048 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7049 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7050 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7051 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7052 result of a successful lookup such as:
7053 .code
7054 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7055 .endd
7056 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7057 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7058 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7059
7060 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7061 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7062 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7063 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7064 .code
7065 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7066 .endd
7067
7068
7069 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7070 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7071 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7072 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7073 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7074 .code
7075 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7076 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7077 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7078 .endd
7079 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7080 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7081 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7082 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7083
7084 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7085 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7086 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7087
7088
7089
7090
7091 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7092 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7093 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7094 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7095 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7096 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7097 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7098 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7099 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7100 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7101 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7102 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7103 .code
7104 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7105 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7106 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7107 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7108 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7109 .endd
7110 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7111 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7112
7113 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7114 the way they handle the results of a query:
7115
7116 .ilist
7117 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7118 gives an error.
7119 .next
7120 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7121 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7122 .next
7123 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7124 from all of them are returned.
7125 .endlist
7126
7127
7128 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7129 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7130 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7131 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7132
7133
7134 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7135 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7136 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7137 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7138 .code
7139 data = ${lookup ldap \
7140 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7141 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7142 .endd
7143 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7144 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7145 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7146 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7147
7148 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7149 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7150 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7151
7152 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7153 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7154 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7155 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7156 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7157 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7158 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7159 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7160 &_exim.conf_&.
7161
7162
7163 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7164 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7165 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7166 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7167 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7168 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7169
7170 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7171 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7172 the string:
7173 .code
7174 * => \2A
7175 ( => \28
7176 ) => \29
7177 \ => \5C
7178 .endd
7179 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7180 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7181 .code
7182 ! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
7183 .endd
7184 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7185 .code
7186 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7187 .endd
7188 yields
7189 .code
7190 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7191 .endd
7192 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7193 .code
7194 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7195 .endd
7196 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7197 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7198 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7199 .code
7200 , + " \ < > ;
7201 .endd
7202 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7203 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7204 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7205 .code
7206 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7207 .endd
7208 yields
7209 .code
7210 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7211 .endd
7212 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7213 .code
7214 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7215 .endd
7216 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7217 authentication below.
7218
7219
7220 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7221 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7222 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7223 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7224 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7225 by starting it with
7226 .code
7227 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7228 .endd
7229 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7230 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7231 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7232 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7233 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7234 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7235 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7236 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7237 failures, and timeouts.
7238
7239 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7240 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7241 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7242 doubled. For example
7243 .code
7244 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7245 .endd
7246 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7247 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7248 the local host) is used.
7249
7250 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7251 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7252 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7253 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7254 not available.
7255
7256 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7257 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7258 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7259 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7260 .code
7261 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7262 .endd
7263 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7264 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7265 .code
7266 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7267 .endd
7268 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7269 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7270 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7271 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7272 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7273 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7274 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7275 backup host.
7276
7277 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7278 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7279 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7280
7281 .ilist
7282 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7283 interface.
7284 .next
7285 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7286 .endlist
7287
7288
7289 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7290 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7291
7292
7293
7294 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7295 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7296 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7297 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7298 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7299 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7300 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7301 them. The following names are recognized:
7302 .display
7303 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7304 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7305 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7306 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7307 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7308 &`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7309 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7310 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7311 .endd
7312 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7313 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7314 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7315 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7316
7317 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7318 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7319 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7320 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7321 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7322 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7323 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7324 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7325 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7326
7327 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7328 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7329
7330 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7331 to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7332 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7333 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7334 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7335 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7336 alternate list (colon-separated).
7337
7338 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7339 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7340 .code
7341 ${lookup ldap
7342 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7343 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7344 {$value}fail}
7345 .endd
7346 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7347 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7348 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7349 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7350
7351 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7352 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7353 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7354
7355 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7356 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7357 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7358 quoting has two advantages:
7359
7360 .ilist
7361 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7362 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7363 .next
7364 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7365 .endlist
7366
7367 For example, a setting such as
7368 .code
7369 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7370 .endd
7371 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7372
7373 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7374 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7375 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7376 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7377 .code
7378 PASS=${quote:$3}
7379 .endd
7380 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7381 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7382 &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7383
7384
7385
7386 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7387 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7388 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7389 as a sequence of values, for example
7390 .code
7391 cn=manager, o=University of Cambridge, c=UK
7392 .endd
7393 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7394 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7395 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7396 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7397 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7398 directory.
7399
7400 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7401 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7402 has multiple values, they are separated by commas.
7403
7404 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7405 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7406 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7407 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7408 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7409 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7410 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7411 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7412 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7413
7414 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7415 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7416 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7417 &%attr2%& has only one value:
7418 .code
7419 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7420 value1.1,value1,,2
7421
7422 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7423 value two
7424
7425 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7426 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7427
7428 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7429 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7430 .endd
7431 You can
7432 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7433 results of LDAP lookups.
7434 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7435 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7436 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7437 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7438 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7439 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7440
7441
7442
7443
7444 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7445 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7446 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7447 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7448 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7449 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7450 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7451 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7452 .code
7453 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7454 .endd
7455 might return the string
7456 .code
7457 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7458 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7459 .endd
7460 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7461 .code
7462 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7463 .endd
7464 would just return
7465 .code
7466 Martin Guerre
7467 .endd
7468 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7469 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7470 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7471
7472
7473
7474 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7475 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7476 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7477 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7478 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7479 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7480 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7481 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7482 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7483 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7484 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, and SQLite
7485 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7486 might be
7487 .code
7488 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7489 {$value}fail}
7490 .endd
7491 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7492 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7493 .code
7494 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7495 {$value}}
7496 .endd
7497 might be
7498 .code
7499 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7500 .endd
7501 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7502 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7503 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7504 .code
7505 Mister X
7506 .endd
7507 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7508 with a newline between the data for each row.
7509
7510
7511 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, and InterBase" "SECID72"
7512 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7513 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7514 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7515 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7516 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7517 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7518 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7519 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7520 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, or InterBase lookups are used, the
7521 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, or &%ibase_servers%&
7522 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7523 information.
7524 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL only, the global option need not be set if all
7525 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7526 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.) Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7527 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7528 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7529 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7530 .code
7531 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7532 .endd
7533 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7534 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7535 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7536 .code
7537 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7538 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7539 .endd
7540 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7541 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7542 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7543 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7544 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7545 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7546
7547 .new
7548 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7549 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7550 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7551 itself are escaped with backslashes.
7552 .wen
7553
7554 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7555 For MySQL and PostgreSQL lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7556 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7557 done by starting the query with
7558 .display
7559 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7560 .endd
7561 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7562 .olist
7563 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7564 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7565 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7566 taken from there.
7567 .next
7568 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7569 .endlist
7570 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7571 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7572 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7573
7574 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7575 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7576 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7577 like this:
7578 .code
7579 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7580 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7581 master/db/name/pw
7582 .endd
7583 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7584 .code
7585 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7586 .endd
7587 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7588 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7589 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7590 .code
7591 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7592 .endd
7593
7594
7595 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7596 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7597 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7598 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
7599 .new
7600 An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
7601 the default value is &"exim"&.
7602 .wen
7603 The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7604 .display
7605 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
7606 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7607 .endd
7608 Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7609 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7610
7611 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7612 the queries.
7613
7614 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7615 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7616
7617 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7618 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7619 is zero because no rows are affected.
7620
7621
7622 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7623 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7624 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7625 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7626 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7627 looks like this:
7628 .code
7629 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7630 .endd
7631 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7632 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7633 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7634
7635 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7636 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7637 affected.
7638
7639 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7640 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7641 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7642 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7643 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7644 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7645 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7646 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7647 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7648 .code
7649 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7650 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7651 .endd
7652 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7653 .code
7654 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7655 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7656 .endd
7657 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7658 quote, which it doubles.
7659
7660 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7661 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7662 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7663 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7664 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7665 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7666 option.
7667 .ecindex IIDfidalo1
7668 .ecindex IIDfidalo2
7669
7670
7671 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7672 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7673
7674 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7675 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7676 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7677 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7678 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7679 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7680 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7681 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7682 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7683
7684 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7685 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7686 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7687 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7688
7689 Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
7690 support all the complexity available in
7691 domain, host, address and local part lists.
7692
7693
7694
7695 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECID75"
7696 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7697 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
7698 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7699 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7700 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7701 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7702 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7703
7704
7705 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7706 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7707 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7708
7709 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7710 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7711 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7712 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7713 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7714 .code
7715 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7716 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7717 .endd
7718 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7719 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7720 senders based on the receiving domain.
7721
7722
7723
7724
7725 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7726 .cindex "list" "negation"
7727 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7728 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7729 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7730 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7731 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7732 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7733
7734 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7735 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7736 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7737 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7738 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7739 .code
7740 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7741 .endd
7742 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7743 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7744 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7745 .code
7746 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
7747 .endd
7748 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7749 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7750 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7751
7752 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7753 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7754 item.
7755
7756
7757
7758 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7759 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7760 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7761 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7762 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7763 file names are not allowed,
7764 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7765 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7766 lines:
7767
7768 .ilist
7769 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7770 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7771 .next
7772 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7773 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7774 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7775 .code
7776 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7777 .endd
7778 .endlist
7779
7780 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7781 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7782 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7783 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7784
7785 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7786 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7787 .code
7788 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7789 .endd
7790 and the file contains the lines
7791 .code
7792 !a.b.c
7793 *.b.c
7794 .endd
7795 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7796 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7797
7798
7799
7800 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7801 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7802 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7803 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7804 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7805 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7806 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7807 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7808
7809 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7810 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7811 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7812 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7813
7814
7815
7816
7817 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7818 .cindex "named lists"
7819 .cindex "list" "named"
7820 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7821 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7822 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7823 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7824 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7825 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7826 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7827 .code
7828 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7829 .endd
7830 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7831 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7832 configured with the line
7833 .code
7834 domains = +local_domains
7835 .endd
7836 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7837 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7838 .code
7839 dnslookup:
7840 driver = dnslookup
7841 domains = ! +local_domains
7842 transport = remote_smtp
7843 no_more
7844 .endd
7845 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7846 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
7847 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7848 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7849 .code
7850 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7851 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7852 .endd
7853 A named list may refer to other named lists:
7854 .code
7855 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7856 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7857 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7858 .endd
7859 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7860 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7861 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7862 .code
7863 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7864 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7865 .endd
7866 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
7867 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
7868 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7869 .code
7870 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7871 .endd
7872 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7873 referenced lists if you can.
7874
7875 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7876 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7877 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7878 .code
7879 domains = +local_domains
7880 .endd
7881 on several of your routers
7882 or in several ACL statements,
7883 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7884 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7885 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7886 the same each time they are referenced.
7887
7888 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7889 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7890 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7891 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7892
7893
7894
7895 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
7896 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
7897 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
7898 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7899 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7900 write
7901 .code
7902 ALIST = host1 : host2
7903 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7904 .endd
7905 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7906 .code
7907 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7908 .endd
7909 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7910 list, and write
7911 .code
7912 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7913 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7914 .endd
7915 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7916 .code
7917 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7918 .endd
7919
7920
7921 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
7922 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
7923 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
7924 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7925 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7926 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
7927 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7928 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7929 message. For example:
7930 .code
7931 domainlist special_domains = \
7932 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7933 .endd
7934 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7935 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7936 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7937 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7938 same list each time.
7939
7940 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7941 cache the result anyway. For example:
7942 .code
7943 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7944 .endd
7945 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
7946 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
7947
7948
7949
7950 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
7951 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
7952 .cindex "list" "domain list"
7953 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
7954 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
7955
7956 .ilist
7957 .cindex "primary host name"
7958 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
7959 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
7960 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
7961 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
7962 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
7963 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
7964 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
7965 differ only in their names.
7966 .next
7967 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
7968 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
7969 .cindex "domain literal"
7970 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
7971 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
7972 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
7973 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
7974 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
7975 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
7976 .next
7977 .cindex "@mx_any"
7978 .cindex "@mx_primary"
7979 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
7980 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
7981 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
7982 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
7983 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
7984 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
7985 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
7986 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
7987 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
7988 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
7989
7990 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
7991 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
7992 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
7993 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
7994 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
7995
7996 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
7997 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
7998 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
7999 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8000 on a router). For example:
8001 .code
8002 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8003 .endd
8004 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8005 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8006
8007 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8008 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8009 contain negative items.
8010
8011 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8012 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8013 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8014 .code
8015 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8016 an.other.domain : ...
8017 .endd
8018 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8019 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8020 .code
8021 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8022 an.other.domain ? ...
8023 .endd
8024 .next
8025 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8026 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8027 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8028 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8029 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8030 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8031 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8032 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8033 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8034 &'cipher.key.ex'&.
8035
8036 .next
8037 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8038 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8039 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8040 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8041 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8042 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8043 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8044 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8045 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8046
8047 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8048 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8049 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8050 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8051 expression by expansion, of course).
8052 .next
8053 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8054 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8055 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8056 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8057 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8058 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8059 .code
8060 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8061 .endd
8062 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8063 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8064 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8065 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8066 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8067 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8068 other statements in the same ACL.
8069
8070 .next
8071 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8072 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8073 .code
8074 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8075 .endd
8076 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8077 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8078
8079 .next
8080 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8081 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8082 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8083 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8084 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8085 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8086 expansion variable.
8087 .next
8088 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8089 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8090 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8091 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8092 .code
8093 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8094 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8095 .endd
8096 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8097 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8098 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8099 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8100 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8101 .next
8102 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8103 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8104 between the pattern and the domain.
8105 .endlist
8106
8107 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8108 .code
8109 domainlist funny_domains = \
8110 @ : \
8111 lib.unseen.edu : \
8112 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8113 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8114 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8115 nis;domains.byname : \
8116 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8117 .endd
8118 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8119 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8120 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8121 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8122 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8123 patterns earlier.
8124
8125
8126
8127 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8128 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8129 .cindex "list" "host list"
8130 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8131 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8132 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8133 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8134 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8135 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8136 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8137
8138
8139 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8140 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8141 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8142 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8143 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8144 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8145 not used.
8146
8147 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8148 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8149 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8150
8151
8152
8153 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8154 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8155 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8156 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8157 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8158 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8159 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8160 concerns.)
8161
8162 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8163 inspecting its IP address:
8164
8165 .ilist
8166 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8167 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8168 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8169 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8170 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8171 with the IP address of the subject host.
8172
8173 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8174 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8175 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8176 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8177 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8178
8179 .next
8180 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8181 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8182 domain name, as just described.
8183
8184 .next
8185 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8186 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8187 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8188 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8189 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8190 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8191 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8192 that can never match a client host.
8193
8194 .next
8195 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8196 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8197 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8198 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8199 .code
8200 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8201 accept hosts = @[]
8202 .endd
8203 .next
8204 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8205 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8206 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8207 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8208 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8209 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8210 significant end of the address.
8211
8212 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8213 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8214 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8215 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8216 .code
8217 192.168.23.236/31
8218 .endd
8219 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8220 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8221 matches.
8222
8223 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8224 .code
8225 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8226 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8227 .endd
8228 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8229 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8230 For example:
8231 .code
8232 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8233 .endd
8234 could make use of a file containing
8235 .code
8236 172.16.0.0/12
8237 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8238 .endd
8239 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8240 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8241 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8242 .code
8243 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8244 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8245 .endd
8246 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8247 list.
8248 .endlist
8249
8250
8251
8252 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8253 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8254 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8255 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8256 address, the pattern takes this form:
8257 .display
8258 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8259 .endd
8260 For example:
8261 .code
8262 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8263 .endd
8264 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8265 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8266 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8267 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8268 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8269 returned by the lookup is not used.
8270
8271 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8272 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8273 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8274 patterns of this form:
8275 .display
8276 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8277 .endd
8278 For example:
8279 .code
8280 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8281 .endd
8282 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8283 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8284 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8285 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8286 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8287
8288 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8289 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8290 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8291 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8292 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8293 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8294 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8295 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8296 addresses are always used.
8297
8298 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8299 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8300 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8301 configurations.
8302
8303 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8304 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8305 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8306 case the IP address is used on its own.
8307
8308
8309
8310 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8311 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8312 .cindex "unknown host name"
8313 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8314 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8315 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8316 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8317 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8318 above.)
8319
8320 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8321 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8322 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8323 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8324 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8325 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8326 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8327
8328 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8329 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8330
8331 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8332 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8333 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8334 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8335 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8336 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8337 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8338 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8339 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8340
8341 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8342 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8343
8344 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8345 .cindex "alias for host"
8346 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8347 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8348
8349 .ilist
8350 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8351 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8352 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8353 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8354 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8355 expression.
8356 .next
8357 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8358 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8359 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8360 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8361 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8362 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8363 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8364 example,
8365 .code
8366 ^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8367 .endd
8368 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8369 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8370 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8371 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8372 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8373 .code
8374 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8375 .endd
8376 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8377 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8378 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8379 required.
8380 .endlist
8381
8382
8383
8384
8385 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8386 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8387 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8388 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8389 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8390 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8391
8392 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8393 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8394
8395 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8396 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8397 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8398 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8399 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8400 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8401 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8402 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8403 not recognized in an indirected file).
8404
8405 .ilist
8406 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8407 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8408 .code
8409 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8410 .endd
8411 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8412 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8413
8414 .next
8415 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8416 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8417 example:
8418 .code
8419 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8420 192.168.4.5
8421 .endd
8422 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8423 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8424 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8425 .endlist
8426
8427 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8428 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8429 list.
8430
8431 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8432 "SECTmixwilhos"
8433 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8434
8435 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8436 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8437 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8438
8439 .ilist
8440 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8441 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8442 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8443 .code
8444 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8445 .endd
8446 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8447 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8448 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8449 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8450 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8451 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8452 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8453
8454 .next
8455 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8456 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8457 .code
8458 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8459 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8460 .endd
8461 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8462 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8463 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8464 this section.
8465 .endlist
8466
8467
8468 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8469 "SECTtemdnserr"
8470 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8471 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8472 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8473 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8474 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8475 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
8476 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8477 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8478 host lists such as whitelists.
8479
8480
8481
8482 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8483 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8484 .cindex "unknown host name"
8485 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8486 If a pattern is of the form
8487 .display
8488 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8489 .endd
8490 for example
8491 .code
8492 dbm;/host/accept/list
8493 .endd
8494 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8495 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8496 is not used.
8497
8498 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8499 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8500 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8501 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8502 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8503 lookup, both using the same file.
8504
8505
8506
8507 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8508 If a pattern is of the form
8509 .display
8510 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8511 .endd
8512 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8513 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8514 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8515 .code
8516 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8517 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8518 .endd
8519 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8520 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8521 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8522 operator.
8523
8524 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8525 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8526 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8527
8528 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8529 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8530 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8531 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8532 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8533 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8534
8535
8536
8537
8538
8539 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8540 .cindex "list" "address list"
8541 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8542 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8543 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8544 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8545 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8546 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8547 using this option setting:
8548 .code
8549 senders = :
8550 .endd
8551 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8552 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8553 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8554 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8555
8556 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8557 example:
8558 .code
8559 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8560 .endd
8561 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8562 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8563 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8564 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8565 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8566 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8567 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8568 .code
8569 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8570 *@+hostile_domains:\
8571 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8572 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8573 .endd
8574 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8575 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8576 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8577 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8578 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8579
8580 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8581 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8582 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8583 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8584 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8585 .code
8586 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8587 .endd
8588
8589 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8590 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8591 senders:
8592
8593 .ilist
8594 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8595 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8596 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8597 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8598 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8599 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8600 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8601 .code
8602 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8603 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8604 .endd
8605 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8606 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8607
8608 .next
8609 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8610 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8611 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8612 example:
8613 .code
8614 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8615 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8616 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8617 .endd
8618 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8619 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8620 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8621 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8622
8623 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8624 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8625 panic log.
8626 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8627 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8628 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8629 default. For example, with this lookup:
8630 .code
8631 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8632 .endd
8633 the file could contains lines like this:
8634 .code
8635 user1@domain1.example
8636 *@domain2.example
8637 .endd
8638 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8639 that are tried is:
8640 .code
8641 nimrod@jaeger.example
8642 *@jaeger.example
8643 *
8644 .endd
8645 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8646 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8647
8648 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8649 .code
8650 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8651 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8652 .endd
8653 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8654 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8655 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8656 .endlist
8657
8658
8659 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8660 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8661 always fails.
8662
8663
8664 .ilist
8665 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8666 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8667 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8668 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8669 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8670 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8671 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8672 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8673 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8674
8675 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8676 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8677 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8678 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8679 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8680 with
8681 .code
8682 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8683 .endd
8684 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8685 .code
8686 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8687 .endd
8688 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8689
8690 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8691 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8692 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8693 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8694 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8695 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8696 .code
8697 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8698 spammer3 : spammer4
8699 .endd
8700 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8701 doubling.
8702
8703 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8704 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8705 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8706 might have entries like
8707 .code
8708 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8709 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8710 *: ^\d{8}$
8711 .endd
8712 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8713 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8714 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8715 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8716
8717 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8718 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8719 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8720
8721 .next
8722 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8723 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8724 can only return a single list of local parts.
8725 .endlist
8726
8727 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8728 in these two examples:
8729 .code
8730 senders = +my_list
8731 senders = *@+my_list
8732 .endd
8733 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8734 example it is a named domain list.
8735
8736
8737
8738
8739 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8740 .cindex "case of local parts"
8741 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8742 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8743 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8744 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8745 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8746 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8747 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8748 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8749 default.
8750
8751 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8752 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8753 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8754 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8755 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8756 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8757 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8758 case-independent.
8759
8760 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8761 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8762 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8763 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8764 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8765 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8766 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8767 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8768
8769
8770
8771 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8772 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8773 .cindex "local part" "list"
8774 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8775 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8776 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8777 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8778 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8779 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8780 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8781 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8782
8783 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8784 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8785 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8786 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8787 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8788 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8789 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8790 types.
8791 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8792
8793
8794
8795
8796 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8797 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8798
8799 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8800 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8801 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8802 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8803
8804 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8805 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8806 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8807 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8808 escape character, as described in the following section.
8809
8810 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
8811 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
8812 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
8813 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
8814 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
8815 reasons.
8816
8817
8818
8819 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8820 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8821 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8822 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8823 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8824 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8825 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8826 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8827
8828 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8829 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8830 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8831 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8832 .code
8833 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8834 .endd
8835 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8836 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8837 string.
8838
8839
8840
8841 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
8842 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
8843 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
8844 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
8845 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
8846 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
8847 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
8848 encoding.
8849
8850 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
8851 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
8852 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
8853
8854
8855 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
8856 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
8857 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
8858 .oindex "&%-be%&"
8859 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
8860 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
8861 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
8862 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
8863 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
8864 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
8865 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
8866 and &%nhash%&.
8867
8868 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
8869 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
8870 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
8871
8872 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
8873 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
8874 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
8875 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
8876 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
8877 .code
8878 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
8879 .endd
8880 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
8881 Exim message identifier. For example:
8882 .code
8883 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
8884 .endd
8885 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
8886 is therefore restricted to admin users.
8887
8888
8889 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
8890 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
8891 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
8892 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
8893 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
8894 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
8895 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
8896 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
8897 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
8898 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
8899 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
8900 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
8901 being expanded.
8902
8903
8904
8905
8906 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
8907 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8908 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8909 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
8910 white space is significant.
8911
8912 .vlist
8913 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
8914 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
8915 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
8916 .code
8917 $local_part
8918 ${domain}
8919 .endd
8920 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8921 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
8922 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
8923 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
8924 given, the expansion fails.
8925
8926 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
8927 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
8928 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
8929 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
8930 .code
8931 ${lc:$local_part}
8932 .endd
8933 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8934 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
8935 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
8936 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8937 string easier to understand.
8938
8939 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
8940 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
8941 expansion item below.
8942
8943
8944 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8945 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
8946 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
8947 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
8948 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
8949 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
8950 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
8951 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
8952 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
8953 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
8954 the result of the expansion.
8955 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
8956 the expansion result is an empty string.
8957 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
8958
8959
8960 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
8961 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8962 .cindex "expansion" "extracting cerificate fields"
8963 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
8964 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
8965 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
8966 The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
8967 the certificate. Supported fields are:
8968 .display
8969 &`version `&
8970 &`serial_number `&
8971 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
8972 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
8973 &`notbefore `& time
8974 &`notafter `& time
8975 &`sig_algorithm `&
8976 &`signature `&
8977 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
8978 &`ocsp_uri `& list
8979 &`crl_uri `& list
8980 .endd
8981 If the field is found,
8982 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
8983 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
8984 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
8985 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
8986
8987 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
8988 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
8989 extracted is used.
8990
8991 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
8992
8993 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
8994 output a Distinguished Name string which is
8995 not quite
8996 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
8997 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
8998 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
8999 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9000 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9001 The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9002 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9003 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9004
9005 The field selectors marked as "time" above
9006 take an optional modifier of "int"
9007 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9008 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9009 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9010
9011 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9012 newline-separated by default,
9013 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9014 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9015 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9016
9017 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9018 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9019 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9020 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9021 if so the element tags are omitted.
9022
9023 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9024
9025 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9026 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9027 .cindex &%dlfunc%&
9028 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9029 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9030 .code
9031 EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
9032 .endd
9033 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9034 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9035 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9036
9037 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
9038 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
9039 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9040 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9041 must have the following type:
9042 .code
9043 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9044 .endd
9045 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9046 function should return one of the following values:
9047
9048 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9049 into the expanded string that is being built.
9050
9051 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9052 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9053
9054 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9055 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9056
9057 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9058
9059 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9060 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9061 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9062
9063
9064 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9065 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9066 .cindex "environment" "value from"
9067 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9068 removed.
9069 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9070 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9071 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9072
9073 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9074 appear, for example:
9075 .code
9076 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9077 .endd
9078 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9079 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9080
9081 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9082 search failure.
9083 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9084 search success.
9085
9086
9087 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9088 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9089 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9090 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9091 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9092 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9093 must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the
9094 form:
9095 .display
9096 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9097 .endd
9098 .vindex "&$value$&"
9099 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9100 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9101 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9102 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9103 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9104 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9105 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9106 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9107 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9108
9109 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9110 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9111 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9112 yield &"2001"&:
9113 .code
9114 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9115 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9116 .endd
9117 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9118 appear, for example:
9119 .code
9120 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9121 .endd
9122 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9123 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9124
9125
9126 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9127 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9128 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9129 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9130 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9131 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9132 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9133 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9134 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9135 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9136 <&'string3'&> as before.
9137
9138 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9139 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9140 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9141 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9142 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9143 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9144 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9145 provided. For example:
9146 .code
9147 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9148 .endd
9149 yields &"42"&, and
9150 .code
9151 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9152 .endd
9153 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9154 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9155
9156
9157 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9158 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9159 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9160 .vindex "&$item$&"
9161 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9162 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9163 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9164 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9165 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9166 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9167 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9168 .code
9169 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
9170 .endd
9171 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9172 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9173
9174
9175 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9176 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9177 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9178 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9179 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9180 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9181
9182 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9183 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9184 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9185 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9186 .code
9187 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9188 .endd
9189 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9190 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9191 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9192 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9193 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9194 .code
9195 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9196 .endd
9197 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9198 letters appear. For example:
9199 .display
9200 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9201 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9202 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9203 .endd
9204
9205 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9206 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9207 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9208 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9209 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9210 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9211 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9212 .vindex "&$header_$&"
9213 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9214 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9215 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9216 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9217 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9218 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9219 .code
9220 $header_reply-to:
9221 .endd
9222 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9223 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9224 lines) may be present.
9225
9226 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
9227 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9228
9229 .ilist
9230 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9231 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9232 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9233
9234 .next
9235 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9236 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9237 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9238 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9239 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9240 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9241 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9242 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9243
9244 .next
9245 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9246 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9247 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9248 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9249 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9250 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9251 .endlist ilist
9252
9253 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9254 command of the following form:
9255 .code
9256 headers charset "UTF-8"
9257 .endd
9258 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9259 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9260 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9261 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9262 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9263 ISO-8859-1.
9264
9265 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9266 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9267 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9268 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9269
9270 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9271 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9272 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9273 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9274 router or transport are not accessible.
9275
9276 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
9277 before the DATA ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
9278 message is received. Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9279 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9280 point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running, however, header lines added
9281 by earlier ACLs are visible.
9282
9283 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9284 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9285 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9286 white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
9287 expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
9288 expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
9289 section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
9290 header.)
9291
9292 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9293 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9294 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9295 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9296 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9297 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9298 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9299 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9300
9301
9302 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9303 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9304 .cindex &%hmac%&
9305 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9306 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9307 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9308 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9309 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9310 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9311 present. For example:
9312 .code
9313 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9314 .endd
9315 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9316 produces:
9317 .code
9318 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9319 .endd
9320 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9321 an Exim configuration:
9322 .code
9323 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9324 .endd
9325 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9326 .code
9327 headers_add = \
9328 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9329 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9330 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9331 .endd
9332 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9333 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9334 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9335 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9336 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
9337 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9338
9339
9340 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9341 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9342 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9343 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9344 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9345 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9346 .code
9347 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9348 .endd
9349 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9350 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9351 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9352 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9353 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9354
9355 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9356 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9357 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9358 .code
9359 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9360 .endd
9361 you can use
9362 .code
9363 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9364 .endd
9365
9366 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9367 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9368 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9369 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9370 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9371 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9372 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9373 some of the braces:
9374 .code
9375 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9376 .endd
9377 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9378 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9379 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9380
9381
9382 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9383 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9384 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9385 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9386 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9387 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9388 apart from an optional leading minus,
9389 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9390
9391 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9392 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9393
9394 The first field of the list is numbered one.
9395 If the number is negative, the fields are
9396 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9397 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9398 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9399
9400 If the modulus of the
9401 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9402 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9403
9404 For example:
9405 .code
9406 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9407 .endd
9408 yields &"42"&, and
9409 .code
9410 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9411 .endd
9412 yields &"result: 42"&.
9413
9414 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9415 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9416 extracted is used.
9417 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9418
9419
9420 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9421 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9422 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9423 described in the next item.
9424
9425 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9426 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9427 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9428 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9429 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9430 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9431 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9432 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9433 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9434
9435 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9436 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9437 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9438 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9439 out by the system administrator.
9440
9441 .vindex "&$value$&"
9442 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9443 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9444 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9445 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9446 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9447 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9448 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9449 original lookup fails.
9450
9451 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9452 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9453 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9454 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9455 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9456 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9457 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9458 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9459
9460 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9461 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9462 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9463 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9464
9465 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9466 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9467 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9468 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9469
9470 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9471 .code
9472 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9473 .endd
9474 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9475 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9476 .code
9477 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9478 {$value}fail}
9479 .endd
9480
9481
9482 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9483 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9484 .vindex "&$item$&"
9485 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9486 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9487 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9488 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9489 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9490 setting is not included in the output. For example:
9491 .code
9492 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9493 .endd
9494 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9495 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9496 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9497
9498 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9499 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9500 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9501 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9502 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9503 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9504 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9505 .code
9506 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9507 .endd
9508 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9509 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9510 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9511 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9512 example,
9513 .code
9514 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9515 .endd
9516 returns the string &"6/33"&.
9517
9518
9519
9520 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9521 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9522 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9523 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9524 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9525 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9526 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9527 name of the subroutine, is nine.
9528
9529 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9530 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9531 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9532 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9533 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9534 not its contents.
9535
9536 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9537 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9538 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9539
9540 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9541 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9542
9543
9544 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9545 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9546 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9547 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9548 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9549 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9550 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9551 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9552
9553 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9554 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9555 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9556 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9557 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9558 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9559 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9560 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9561 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9562 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9563
9564 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9565 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9566 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9567 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9568
9569 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9570 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9571 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9572 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9573 is the expansion of the third argument.
9574
9575 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9576 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9577 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9578
9579 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9580 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9581 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9582 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9583 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9584 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9585 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9586 newlines are left in the string.
9587 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9588 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9589 the string expansion fails.
9590
9591 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9592 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9593
9594
9595
9596 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9597 {*&<&'timeout'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9598 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9599 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9600 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9601 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
9602 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9603 examples:
9604 .code
9605 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9606 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9607 .endd
9608 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9609 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9610 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9611 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9612 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9613 example:
9614 .code
9615 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9616 .endd
9617 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9618 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9619 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9620 (unless it is an empty string) and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9621 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9622 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9623 .code
9624 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9625 .endd
9626 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9627 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9628 turns them into spaces:
9629 .code
9630 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9631 .endd
9632 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9633 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9634 addition, the following errors can occur:
9635
9636 .ilist
9637 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9638 .next
9639 Failure to connect the socket;
9640 .next
9641 Failure to write the request string;
9642 .next
9643 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9644 .endlist
9645
9646 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9647 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9648 errors occurs. For example:
9649 .code
9650 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9651 {socket failure}}
9652 .endd
9653 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9654 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9655 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9656 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9657 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9658
9659 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9660 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9661
9662
9663 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9664 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9665 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9666 .vindex "&$value$&"
9667 .vindex "&$item$&"
9668 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9669 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9670 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9671 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9672 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9673 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9674 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9675 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9676 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9677 .code
9678 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9679 .endd
9680 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9681 can be found:
9682 .code
9683 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9684 .endd
9685 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9686 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9687 expansion items.
9688
9689 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9690 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9691 expansion item above.
9692
9693 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9694 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9695 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9696 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9697 The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
9698 split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
9699 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
9700 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
9701 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9702
9703 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
9704 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
9705 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
9706 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
9707 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
9708 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
9709 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
9710 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
9711 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
9712 character.
9713
9714 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9715 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9716 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9717 .vindex "&$value$&"
9718 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9719 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9720 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9721 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9722 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9723 &$value$&.
9724
9725 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9726 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9727 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9728 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9729
9730 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
9731 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
9732 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
9733 troubleshoot:
9734 .code
9735 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
9736 log_message = Output of id: $value
9737 .endd
9738 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
9739 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
9740 .code
9741 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
9742 .endd
9743
9744 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
9745 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9746 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9747 .code
9748 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9749 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9750 ...
9751 endif
9752 .endd
9753 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9754 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9755 commands.
9756
9757 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9758 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9759 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9760 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9761
9762 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9763 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9764
9765
9766 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9767 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9768 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9769 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9770 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9771 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9772 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9773 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9774 .code
9775 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9776 .endd
9777 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9778 if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9779 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9780 .code
9781 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9782 .endd
9783 yields &"defabc"&, and
9784 .code
9785 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9786 .endd
9787 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9788 the regular expression from string expansion.
9789
9790
9791
9792 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
9793 .cindex sorting "a list"
9794 .cindex list sorting
9795 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
9796 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9797 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9798 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
9799 of a two-argument expansion condition.
9800 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
9801 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
9802 if the first value should sort before the second value.
9803 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
9804 the element being placed in &$item$&,
9805 to give values for comparison.
9806
9807 The item result is a sorted list,
9808 with the original list separator,
9809 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
9810
9811 Examples:
9812 .code
9813 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
9814 .endd
9815 sorts a list of numbers, and
9816 .code
9817 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
9818 .endd
9819 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
9820
9821
9822 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9823 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9824 .cindex "substring extraction"
9825 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
9826 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9827 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9828 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9829 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9830 .code
9831 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9832 .endd
9833 The second number is optional (in both notations).
9834 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
9835 omitted.
9836
9837 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
9838 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
9839 length required. For example
9840 .code
9841 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
9842 .endd
9843 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
9844 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
9845 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
9846 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
9847
9848 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
9849 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
9850 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
9851 .code
9852 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
9853 .endd
9854 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
9855 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
9856 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
9857 .code
9858 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
9859 .endd
9860 yields an empty string, but
9861 .code
9862 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
9863 .endd
9864 yields &"1"&.
9865
9866 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
9867 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
9868 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
9869 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
9870 .code
9871 ${substr_-1:abcde}
9872 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
9873 .endd
9874 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
9875
9876
9877
9878 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
9879 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
9880 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
9881 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
9882 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
9883 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
9884 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
9885 replacement list. For example
9886 .code
9887 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
9888 .endd
9889 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
9890 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
9891 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
9892 place.
9893 .endlist
9894
9895
9896
9897 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
9898 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9899 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
9900 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
9901 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
9902 following operations can be performed:
9903
9904 .vlist
9905 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9906 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9907 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
9908 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
9909 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
9910 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9911
9912
9913 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9914 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9915 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
9916 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
9917 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
9918 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
9919 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
9920 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
9921 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
9922
9923 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
9924 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
9925 character. For example:
9926 .code
9927 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
9928 .endd
9929 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
9930 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
9931 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
9932 processing lists.
9933
9934 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
9935 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
9936 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
9937 email address separator. For the example header line:
9938 .code
9939 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
9940 .endd
9941 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
9942 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
9943 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
9944 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
9945 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
9946 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
9947 quoted.
9948 .code
9949 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
9950 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
9951 user@example.com
9952 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
9953 Last:user@example.com
9954 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
9955 user@example.com
9956 .endd
9957
9958 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
9959 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
9960 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9961 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
9962 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
9963 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
9964 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
9965 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
9966 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
9967
9968 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
9969 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
9970 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9971 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
9972 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
9973 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
9974 string.
9975
9976
9977 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9978 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
9979 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
9980 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
9981 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9982
9983
9984 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9985 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
9986 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
9987 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
9988 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
9989 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
9990 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
9991
9992
9993 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9994 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
9995 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
9996 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
9997 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
9998 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
9999 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
10000 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
10001 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
10002 C programming language):
10003 .table2 70pt 300pt
10004 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10005 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10006 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10007 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10008 .irow "" "and (&&)"
10009 .irow "" "xor (^)"
10010 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10011 .endtable
10012 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10013 space is permitted before or after operators.
10014
10015 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10016 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10017 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10018 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10019 times, which often do have leading zeros.
10020
10021 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10022 or 1024*1024*1024,
10023 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10024 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10025
10026 .display
10027 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10028 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10029 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10030 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10031 &`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
10032 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10033 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10034 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10035 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10036 &`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
10037 &`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10038 .endd
10039
10040 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10041 .code
10042 deny message = Too many bad recipients
10043 condition = \
10044 ${if and { \
10045 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10046 { \
10047 < \
10048 {$recipients_count} \
10049 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10050 } \
10051 }{yes}{no}}
10052 .endd
10053 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10054 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10055
10056
10057 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10058 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10059 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10060 example,
10061 .code
10062 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10063 .endd
10064 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10065 and then re-expands what it has found.
10066
10067
10068 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10069 .cindex "Unicode"
10070 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10071 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10072 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10073 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10074 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10075 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10076 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10077 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10078 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10079
10080 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10081 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10082 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10083 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10084 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10085 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10086 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10087
10088
10089 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10090 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10091 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10092 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10093 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10094 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10095 .code
10096 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10097 .endd
10098 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10099 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10100
10101
10102
10103 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10104 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10105 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10106 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10107 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10108 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
10109
10110
10111
10112 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10113 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10114 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10115 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10116 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10117 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example a
10118 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10119
10120
10121 .new
10122 .vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10123 .cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
10124 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10125 This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
10126 of hex digits including leading zeroes.
10127 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10128 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10129
10130 .vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10131 .cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
10132 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10133 .cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
10134 This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
10135 Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
10136 set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
10137 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10138 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10139 .wen
10140
10141
10142 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10143 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10144 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10145 .cindex "lower casing"
10146 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10147 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10148 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10149 .code
10150 ${lc:$local_part}
10151 .endd
10152
10153 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10154 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10155 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10156 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10157 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10158 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10159 .code
10160 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10161 .endd
10162 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10163 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10164 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10165
10166
10167 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10168 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10169 .cindex "list" "item count"
10170 .cindex "list" "count of items"
10171 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10172 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10173
10174
10175 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10176 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
10177 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10178 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10179 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10180 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10181 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10182 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10183 matching list is returned.
10184
10185
10186 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10187 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10188 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10189 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10190 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10191 empty.
10192
10193
10194 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10195 .cindex "masked IP address"
10196 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
10197 .cindex "CIDR notation"
10198 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10199 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10200 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10201 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10202 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10203 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10204 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10205 .code
10206 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10207 .endd
10208 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10209 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10210 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10211 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10212 .code
10213 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10214 .endd
10215 returns the string
10216 .code
10217 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10218 .endd
10219 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10220
10221
10222 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10223 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10224 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10225 .cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10226 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10227 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10228 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10229
10230
10231 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10232 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10233 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10234 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10235 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10236 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10237 .code
10238 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10239 .endd
10240 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10241
10242
10243 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10244 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10245 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10246 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10247 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10248 is an empty string or
10249 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10250 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10251 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10252 respectively For example,
10253 .code
10254 ${quote:ab"*"cd}
10255 .endd
10256 becomes
10257 .code
10258 "ab\"*\"cd"
10259 .endd
10260 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10261 variable or a message header.
10262
10263 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10264 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10265 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10266 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10267 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10268 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10269 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10270
10271
10272 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10273 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10274 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10275 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10276 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10277 .code
10278 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
10279 .endd
10280 returns
10281 .code
10282 two%20%5C2A%20two
10283 .endd
10284 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10285 yields an unchanged string.
10286
10287
10288 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10289 .cindex "random number"
10290 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10291 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10292 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10293 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10294 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10295 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10296 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10297 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10298 random().
10299
10300
10301 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10302 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10303 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10304 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
10305 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10306 for DNS. For example,
10307 .code
10308 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10309 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10310 .endd
10311 returns
10312 .code
10313 4.2.0.192
10314 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10315 .endd
10316
10317
10318 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10319 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10320 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10321 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10322 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10323 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10324 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10325 &%headers_charset%& option, which defaults to ISO-8859-1. If the string
10326 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10327 characters
10328 .code
10329 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10330 .endd
10331 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10332 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10333 characters.
10334
10335
10336 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10337 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10338 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10339 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10340 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10341 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10342 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10343 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10344
10345 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10346 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10347 to use this operator as well.
10348
10349
10350
10351 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10352 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10353 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10354 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10355 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10356 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10357 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10358
10359
10360 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10361 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10362 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10363 .cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10364 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
10365 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10366 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10367
10368
10369 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'certificate'&>&*}*&
10370 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10371 .cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10372 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10373 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10374 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the
10375 certificate,
10376 and returns
10377 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10378 Only arguments which are a single variable of certificate type are supported.
10379
10380
10381 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10382 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
10383 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
10384 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
10385 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
10386 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
10387 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
10388 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
10389 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
10390 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
10391 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
10392 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
10393 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
10394
10395 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
10396 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
10397 systems for files larger than 2GB.
10398
10399 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10400 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10401 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10402 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
10403 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10404
10405
10406
10407 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10408 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
10409 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
10410 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
10411 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
10412 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
10413
10414
10415 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10416 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10417 .cindex "substring extraction"
10418 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
10419 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
10420 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
10421 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10422 .code
10423 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
10424 .endd
10425 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
10426 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
10427
10428 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10429 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
10430 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
10431 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
10432 seconds.
10433
10434 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10435 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
10436 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
10437 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
10438 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
10439 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
10440 &`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
10441
10442 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10443 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10444 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10445 .cindex "upper casing"
10446 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10447 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
10448 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
10449
10450 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10451 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
10452 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
10453 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
10454 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
10455 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
10456 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
10457 .endlist
10458
10459
10460
10461
10462
10463
10464 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
10465 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
10466 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
10467 while expanding strings:
10468
10469 .vlist
10470 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
10471 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
10472 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
10473 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
10474 condition.
10475
10476 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10477 .cindex "numeric comparison"
10478 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
10479 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
10480 are:
10481 .display
10482 &`= `& equal
10483 &`== `& equal
10484 &`> `& greater
10485 &`>= `& greater or equal
10486 &`< `& less
10487 &`<= `& less or equal
10488 .endd
10489 For example:
10490 .code
10491 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
10492 .endd
10493 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
10494 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
10495 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
10496 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
10497 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
10498 zero.
10499
10500 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
10501 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
10502 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
10503
10504
10505 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
10506 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
10507 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
10508 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
10509 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
10510 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
10511 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
10512 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
10513 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
10514 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
10515 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
10516 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
10517 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
10518 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
10519
10520 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10521 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10522 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
10523 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
10524 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
10525 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
10526 false if zero.
10527 An empty string is treated as false.
10528 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
10529 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
10530 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
10531
10532 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
10533 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
10534 For example:
10535 .code
10536 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
10537 .endd
10538
10539
10540 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10541 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10542 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
10543 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
10544 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
10545 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
10546 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
10547 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
10548
10549 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
10550
10551 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10552 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10553 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10554 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10555 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10556 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10557 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10558 included in the binary.
10559
10560 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10561 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10562 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10563 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10564 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10565 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10566 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10567 string in LDAP form is:
10568 .code
10569 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10570 .endd
10571 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10572 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10573 .code
10574 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10575 .endd
10576 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10577 supported:
10578
10579 .ilist
10580 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10581 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10582 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10583 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10584 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10585 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10586 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10587 comparison fails.
10588
10589 .next
10590 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10591 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10592 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10593 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10594 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10595 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10596
10597 .next
10598 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10599 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10600 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10601 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10602 whatever its length.
10603
10604 .next
10605 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10606 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10607 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10608 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10609 .endlist
10610 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10611 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10612 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10613 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10614 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10615 support &[crypt16()]&.
10616
10617 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10618 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10619 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10620 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10621 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10622
10623 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10624 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10625 Exim is seen as very low priority.
10626
10627 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10628 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10629 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10630 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10631 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10632
10633 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10634 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10635 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10636 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10637 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10638 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10639 .code
10640 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10641 .endd
10642 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10643 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10644
10645 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10646 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10647 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10648 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10649 exists in the message. For example,
10650 .code
10651 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10652 .endd
10653 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
10654 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
10655
10656 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10657 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10658 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10659 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10660 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
10661 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
10662 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
10663 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
10664 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
10665
10666 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
10667 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
10668 .cindex "file" "existence test"
10669 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
10670 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
10671 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
10672 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
10673 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
10674
10675 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
10676 .cindex "delivery" "first"
10677 .cindex "first delivery"
10678 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
10679 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
10680 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
10681 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
10682
10683
10684 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
10685 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
10686 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10687 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
10688 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
10689 .vindex "&$item$&"
10690 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
10691 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
10692 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
10693 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
10694 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
10695 .ilist
10696 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
10697 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
10698 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
10699 .next
10700 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
10701 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
10702 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
10703 .endlist
10704 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
10705 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
10706 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
10707 list separator is changed to a comma:
10708 .code
10709 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
10710 .endd
10711 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
10712 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
10713
10714 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
10715
10716
10717 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10718 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10719 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10720 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10721 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
10722 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
10723 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10724 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
10725 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
10726 case-independent.
10727
10728 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10729 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10730 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10731 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10732 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
10733 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
10734 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10735 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
10736 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
10737 case-independent.
10738
10739 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10740 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10741 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10742 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10743 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
10744 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
10745 is true.
10746
10747 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
10748 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
10749 .code
10750 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
10751 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
10752 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
10753 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
10754 .endd
10755
10756 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10757 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10758 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10759 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
10760 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
10761 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
10762 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
10763 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
10764 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
10765 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
10766 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
10767
10768 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
10769 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
10770 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
10771 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
10772 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
10773
10774 &*Note*&: The checks are just on the form of the address; actual numerical
10775 values are not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passes the IPv4
10776 check. The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
10777 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
10778 .code
10779 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
10780 .endd
10781 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
10782
10783 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
10784 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
10785 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
10786 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
10787 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
10788 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
10789 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
10790 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
10791 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
10792 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
10793 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
10794 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
10795 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
10796 this can be used.
10797
10798
10799 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10800 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10801 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10802 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10803 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
10804 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
10805 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10806 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
10807 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
10808 case-independent.
10809
10810 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10811 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10812 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10813 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10814 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
10815 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
10816 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10817 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
10818 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
10819 case-independent.
10820
10821
10822 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10823 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
10824 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
10825 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
10826 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
10827 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
10828 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
10829 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
10830 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
10831 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
10832 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
10833 For example,
10834 .code
10835 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
10836 .endd
10837 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
10838 backslashes is also required.
10839
10840 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
10841 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
10842 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
10843 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
10844 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
10845 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
10846
10847 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
10848 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
10849 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
10850 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
10851 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
10852 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
10853 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
10854 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
10855
10856 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10857 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
10858 See &*match_local_part*&.
10859
10860 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10861 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
10862 See &*match_local_part*&.
10863
10864 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10865 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
10866 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
10867 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
10868 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
10869 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
10870 .code
10871 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
10872 .endd
10873 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
10874
10875 .ilist
10876 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
10877 .next
10878 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
10879 .next
10880 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
10881 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
10882 in a single test such as
10883 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
10884 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
10885 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
10886 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
10887 .code
10888 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
10889 .endd
10890 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
10891 .next
10892 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
10893 .next
10894 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
10895 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
10896 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
10897 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
10898 masks. For example:
10899 .code
10900 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
10901 .endd
10902 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
10903 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
10904 address mask, for example:
10905 .code
10906 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
10907 .endd
10908 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
10909 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
10910 .code
10911 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
10912 .endd
10913 .endlist ilist
10914
10915 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10916 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10917
10918 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
10919
10920 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10921 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
10922 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
10923 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
10924 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
10925 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
10926 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
10927 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
10928 example is:
10929 .code
10930 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
10931 .endd
10932 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
10933 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
10934 expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
10935 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
10936 .code
10937 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
10938 .endd
10939 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
10940 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
10941 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
10942 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
10943 caselessly.
10944
10945 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10946 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10947
10948 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
10949 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
10950 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
10951 matched using &%match_ip%&.
10952
10953 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
10954 .cindex "PAM authentication"
10955 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
10956 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
10957 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
10958 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
10959 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
10960 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
10961 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
10962 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
10963 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
10964 .code
10965 SUPPORT_PAM=yes
10966 .endd
10967 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
10968 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
10969
10970 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
10971 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
10972 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
10973 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
10974 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
10975 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
10976 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
10977
10978 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
10979 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
10980 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
10981 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
10982 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
10983 .code
10984 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
10985 .endd
10986 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
10987 .code
10988 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
10989 .endd
10990 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
10991 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
10992 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
10993 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
10994 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
10995 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
10996 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
10997 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
10998
10999
11000 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11001 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
11002 .cindex "Cyrus"
11003 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
11004 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
11005 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
11006 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
11007 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
11008 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
11009
11010 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11011 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11012 building Exim. For example:
11013 .code
11014 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
11015 .endd
11016 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11017 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11018 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
11019 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
11020
11021 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11022 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11023 configuration, you might have this:
11024 .code
11025 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11026 .endd
11027 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11028 .code
11029 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11030 .endd
11031 .vitem &*queue_running*&
11032 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11033 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11034 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11035 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11036 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11037
11038
11039 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11040 .cindex "Radius"
11041 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11042 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11043 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11044 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11045 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11046 support.
11047
11048 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11049 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11050 this library, you need to set
11051 .code
11052 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11053 .endd
11054 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11055 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11056 .code
11057 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11058 .endd
11059 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11060 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11061 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11062
11063 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11064 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11065 the authentication is successful. For example:
11066 .code
11067 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11068 .endd
11069
11070
11071 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11072 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11073 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11074 .cindex "Cyrus"
11075 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11076 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11077 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11078 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11079 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11080 by a process that is not running as root.
11081
11082 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11083 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11084 building Exim. For example:
11085 .code
11086 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11087 .endd
11088 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11089 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11090 from the Cyrus SASL library.
11091
11092 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11093 two are mandatory. For example:
11094 .code
11095 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11096 .endd
11097 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11098 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11099 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11100 .endlist vlist
11101
11102
11103
11104 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11105 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11106 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11107 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11108 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11109 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11110 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11111
11112
11113 .vlist
11114 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11115 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11116 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11117 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11118 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11119 For example,
11120 .code
11121 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11122 .endd
11123 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11124 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11125 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11126
11127 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11128 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11129 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11130 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11131 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11132 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11133 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11134 parsed but not evaluated.
11135 .endlist
11136 .ecindex IIDexpcond
11137
11138
11139
11140
11141 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11142 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11143 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11144 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11145 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11146
11147 .vlist
11148 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11149 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11150 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11151 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11152 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11153 In the expansion condition case
11154 they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11155 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11156 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11157 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11158 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11159 matching condition.
11160
11161 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11162 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11163 any arguments are copied to these variables,
11164 any unused variables being made empty.
11165
11166 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11167 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11168 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11169 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11170 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11171 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11172 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11173 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11174 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11175 during subsequent delivery.
11176
11177 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11178 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11179 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11180 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11181 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11182 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11183 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11184 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11185 delivery.
11186
11187 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
11188 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11189 this variable has the number of arguments.
11190
11191 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11192 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11193 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11194 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11195 be preserved by coding like this:
11196 .code
11197 warn !verify = sender
11198 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11199 .endd
11200 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11201 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11202 failure.
11203
11204 .vitem &$address_data$&
11205 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11206 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11207 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11208 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11209 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11210 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11211 user filter files.
11212
11213 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11214 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11215 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11216 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11217 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11218 from the child's routing.
11219
11220 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11221 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11222 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11223 address.
11224
11225 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11226 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11227 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11228
11229 .vitem &$address_file$&
11230 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
11231 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11232 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11233 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11234 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11235 .code
11236 /home/r2d2/savemail
11237 .endd
11238 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11239 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11240 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11241 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11242 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11243 to the relevant file.
11244
11245 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
11246 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11247 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11248 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11249
11250 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11251 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11252 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11253 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPspa>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11254
11255 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11256 .cindex "authentication" "id"
11257 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11258 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11259 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11260 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11261 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11262 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11263 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11264 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11265 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11266 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11267 command line option.
11268
11269 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11270 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11271 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11272 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11273 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11274 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11275 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11276 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11277 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11278 the ACL's as well.
11279
11280
11281 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11282 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11283 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
11284 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11285 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11286 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11287 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11288 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11289 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11290 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11291 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11292
11293 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11294 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11295 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11296 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11297 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11298
11299
11300 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11301 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
11302 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
11303 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
11304 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
11305 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
11306 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
11307 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
11308 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
11309 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
11310 an undefined mechanism.
11311
11312 .vitem &$av_failed$&
11313 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
11314 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
11315 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
11316 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
11317 the ACL malware condition.
11318
11319 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
11320 .cindex "message body" "line count"
11321 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
11322 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
11323 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11324 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
11325
11326 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
11327 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
11328 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
11329 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11330 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
11331 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11332 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
11333
11334 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
11335 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
11336 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
11337 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
11338 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11339
11340 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
11341 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
11342 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
11343 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
11344 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11345
11346 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
11347 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
11348 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11349 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11350 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
11351 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11352 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
11353
11354 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
11355 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
11356 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11357 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11358 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
11359 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11360 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
11361
11362 .vitem &$callout_address$&
11363 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
11364 After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
11365 address that was connected to.
11366
11367 .vitem &$compile_number$&
11368 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
11369 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
11370 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
11371 compilations of the same version of the program.
11372
11373 .vitem &$config_dir$&
11374 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
11375 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
11376 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
11377 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
11378 &$config_dir$& is ".".
11379
11380 .vitem &$config_file$&
11381 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
11382 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
11383
11384 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
11385 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
11386 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
11387 the content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For
11388 details, see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11389
11390 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
11391 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
11392 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11393 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11394 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11395
11396 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
11397 &$dkim_verify_status$& &&&
11398 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
11399 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
11400 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
11401 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
11402 &$dkim_algo$& &&&
11403 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
11404 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
11405 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
11406 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
11407 &$dkim_created$& &&&
11408 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
11409 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
11410 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
11411 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
11412 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
11413 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
11414 &$dkim_key_notes$&
11415 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
11416 For details see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
11417
11418 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
11419 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
11420 When a message has been received this variable contains
11421 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
11422 For details see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
11423
11424 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
11425 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
11426 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
11427 &$dnslist_value$&
11428 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
11429 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
11430 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
11431 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
11432 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
11433 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
11434 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
11435 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
11436 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
11437
11438 .vitem &$domain$&
11439 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11440 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
11441 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
11442 case for &$domain$&.
11443
11444 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11445 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
11446 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
11447 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
11448
11449 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
11450 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
11451 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
11452 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
11453 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
11454 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
11455
11456 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
11457 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
11458 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
11459
11460 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
11461
11462 .ilist
11463 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
11464 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
11465 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
11466 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
11467 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
11468 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
11469 the &(smtp)& transport.
11470
11471 .next
11472 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11473 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
11474 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
11475 rewrite domains by file lookup.
11476
11477 .next
11478 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
11479 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
11480 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
11481 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
11482 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
11483 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
11484
11485 .next
11486 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
11487 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
11488 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
11489 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
11490 .endlist
11491
11492
11493 .vitem &$domain_data$&
11494 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
11495 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
11496 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
11497 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
11498 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
11499 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
11500 used.
11501
11502 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
11503 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
11504 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
11505 to nothing.
11506
11507 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
11508 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
11509 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
11510
11511 .vitem &$exim_path$&
11512 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
11513 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
11514
11515 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
11516 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
11517 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
11518
11519 .vitem &$exim_version$&
11520 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
11521 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
11522 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
11523 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
11524 There may be other characters following the minor version.
11525
11526 .vitem &$found_extension$&
11527 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
11528 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11529 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11530 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11531
11532 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
11533 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
11534 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
11535 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
11536 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
11537
11538 .vitem &$headers_added$&
11539 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
11540 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
11541 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
11542 The headers are a newline-separated list.
11543
11544 .vitem &$home$&
11545 .vindex "&$home$&"
11546 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
11547 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
11548 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
11549 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
11550 by a setting on the transport itself.
11551
11552 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
11553 of the environment variable HOME.
11554
11555 .vitem &$host$&
11556 .vindex "&$host$&"
11557 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
11558 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
11559 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
11560 to local and remote transports.
11561
11562 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11563 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11564 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
11565 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
11566 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
11567 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
11568 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
11569 is connected.
11570
11571 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
11572 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
11573 client is connected.
11574
11575
11576 .vitem &$host_address$&
11577 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
11578 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
11579 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
11580 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
11581
11582 .vitem &$host_data$&
11583 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
11584 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
11585 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
11586 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
11587 .code
11588 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
11589 message = $host_data
11590 .endd
11591 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11592 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
11593 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11594 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
11595 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
11596 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
11597 variables is set to &"1"&.
11598
11599 .ilist
11600 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
11601 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11602
11603 .next
11604 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
11605 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
11606 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
11607 .endlist ilist
11608
11609 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
11610 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
11611 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
11612 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
11613 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
11614 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
11615 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
11616 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
11617 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
11618 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
11619
11620 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
11621 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11622 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
11623
11624 .vitem &$host_port$&
11625 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
11626 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
11627 for an outbound connection.
11628
11629
11630 .vitem &$inode$&
11631 .vindex "&$inode$&"
11632 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11633 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11634 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11635 a unique name for the file.
11636
11637 .vitem &$interface_address$&
11638 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
11639 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
11640
11641 .vitem &$interface_port$&
11642 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
11643 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
11644
11645 .vitem &$item$&
11646 .vindex "&$item$&"
11647 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
11648 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
11649 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
11650 empty.
11651
11652 .vitem &$ldap_dn$&
11653 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
11654 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
11655 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
11656 lookup.
11657
11658 .vitem &$load_average$&
11659 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
11660 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
11661 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
11662 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
11663
11664 .vitem &$local_part$&
11665 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11666 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
11667 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
11668 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
11669 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
11670
11671 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11672 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
11673 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
11674 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
11675 once.
11676
11677 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11678 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11679 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
11680 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
11681 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
11682 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
11683
11684 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
11685 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
11686 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
11687 &$address_pipe$&).
11688
11689 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
11690 local part of the recipient address.
11691
11692 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11693 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
11694 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
11695
11696 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
11697 the addresses
11698 .code
11699 "abc:xyz"@test.example
11700 abc\:xyz@test.example
11701 .endd
11702 the value of &$local_part$& is
11703 .code
11704 abc:xyz
11705 .endd
11706 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
11707 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
11708 have:
11709 .code
11710 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
11711 .endd
11712 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
11713 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
11714 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
11715
11716 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
11717 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
11718 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
11719 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
11720 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
11721 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
11722 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
11723
11724 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
11725 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
11726 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
11727 variable expands to nothing.
11728
11729 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
11730 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11731 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11732 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11733 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11734
11735 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
11736 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11737 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11738 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11739 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11740
11741 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
11742 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
11743 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
11744 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
11745
11746 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
11747 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
11748 See &$local_user_uid$&.
11749
11750 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
11751 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
11752 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
11753 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
11754 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
11755 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
11756 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
11757 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
11758
11759 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
11760 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
11761 This contains the expanded value of the
11762 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
11763 been read.
11764
11765 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
11766 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
11767 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
11768 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
11769 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
11770 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
11771
11772 .vitem &$log_space$&
11773 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
11774 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
11775 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
11776 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
11777 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
11778 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
11779
11780
11781 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
11782 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
11783 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
11784 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
11785 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
11786 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
11787 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
11788 and &"yes"& if it was.
11789 Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
11790 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
11791 as authenticated data.
11792
11793 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
11794 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
11795 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
11796 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
11797 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
11798 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
11799 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
11800 variable is empty.
11801
11802 .vitem &$malware_name$&
11803 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
11804 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11805 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
11806 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
11807
11808 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
11809 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
11810 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
11811 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
11812 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
11813 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
11814 character(s).
11815
11816 .vitem &$message_age$&
11817 .cindex "message" "age of"
11818 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
11819 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
11820 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
11821 delivery attempt.
11822
11823 .vitem &$message_body$&
11824 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11825 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11826 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11827 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
11828 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
11829 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
11830 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
11831 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
11832 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
11833
11834 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
11835 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
11836 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
11837 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
11838 zeros are always converted into spaces.
11839
11840 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
11841 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11842 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11843 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
11844 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
11845 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
11846 &$message_body$&.
11847
11848 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
11849 .cindex "body of message" "size"
11850 .cindex "message body" "size"
11851 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
11852 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
11853 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
11854 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
11855 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11856
11857 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
11858 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
11859 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11860 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
11861 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
11862 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
11863 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
11864 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
11865
11866 .vitem &$message_headers$&
11867 .vindex &$message_headers$&
11868 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
11869 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
11870 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
11871 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
11872
11873 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
11874 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
11875 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
11876 contents of header lines is done.
11877
11878 .vitem &$message_id$&
11879 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
11880
11881 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
11882 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
11883 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
11884 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
11885 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
11886 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
11887 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
11888 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
11889 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
11890 from the body is not counted.
11891
11892 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
11893 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
11894 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
11895 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
11896 header and the body).
11897
11898 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
11899 .code
11900 deny message = Too many lines in message header
11901 condition = \
11902 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
11903 .endd
11904 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
11905 message has not yet been received.
11906
11907 .vitem &$message_size$&
11908 .cindex "size" "of message"
11909 .cindex "message" "size"
11910 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
11911 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
11912 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
11913 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
11914 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
11915 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
11916 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
11917 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
11918 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11919
11920 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
11921 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
11922 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
11923 value may not, of course, be truthful.
11924
11925 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
11926 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
11927 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
11928 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
11929
11930 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
11931 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
11932 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
11933
11934 .vitem &$original_domain$&
11935 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11936 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
11937 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11938 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
11939 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
11940 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
11941 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
11942 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
11943 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
11944
11945 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11946 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11947 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11948
11949 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
11950 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11951 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
11952 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11953 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
11954 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
11955 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
11956 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
11957 the original address.
11958
11959 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
11960 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
11961 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
11962 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
11963 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
11964
11965 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11966 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11967 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11968
11969 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
11970 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
11971 .cindex "sender" "gid"
11972 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11973 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
11974 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
11975 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
11976 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
11977 normally the gid of the Exim user.
11978
11979 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
11980 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
11981 .cindex "sender" "uid"
11982 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11983 .vindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
11984 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
11985 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
11986 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
11987 user.
11988
11989 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
11990 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
11991 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
11992 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11993
11994 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
11995 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
11996 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
11997 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11998
11999 .vitem &$pid$&
12000 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
12001 .vindex "&$pid$&"
12002 This variable contains the current process id.
12003
12004 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
12005 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12006 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12007 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
12008 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
12009 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
12010 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
12011 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
12012 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
12013 variable"& error if encountered.
12014
12015 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
12016 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
12017 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
12018 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
12019 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
12020 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
12021 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12022
12023
12024 .new
12025 .vitem &$prdr_requested$&
12026 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
12027 This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
12028 current message, otherwise &"no"&.
12029 .wen
12030
12031 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12032 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12033 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12034 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12035
12036 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12037 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12038 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12039 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12040
12041 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12042 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12043 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12044 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12045
12046 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12047 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12048 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12049
12050 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12051 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12052 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12053 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12054
12055 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12056 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12057 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12058 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12059 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12060
12061 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12062 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12063 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12064 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12065 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12066 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12067
12068 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12069 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12070 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12071 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12072 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12073
12074 .vitem &$received_count$&
12075 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
12076 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12077 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12078 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12079 delivering.
12080
12081 .vitem &$received_for$&
12082 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
12083 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12084 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12085 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12086 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12087
12088 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12089 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12090 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12091 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12092 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12093 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12094 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12095 option.
12096
12097 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12098 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
12099 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12100 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12101 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12102 time.
12103 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12104
12105 .vitem &$received_port$&
12106 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
12107 See &$received_ip_address$&.
12108
12109 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
12110 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12111 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12112 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12113 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12114 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12115 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12116 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12117 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12118
12119 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12120 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12121 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12122 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12123 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12124 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12125
12126 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12127 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12128 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12129
12130 .vitem &$received_time$&
12131 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
12132 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12133 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12134
12135 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
12136 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12137 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12138 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12139 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12140 .display
12141 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12142 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12143 .endd
12144 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12145 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12146 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12147 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12148
12149 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12150 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12151 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12152 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12153
12154 .ilist
12155 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12156 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12157
12158 .next
12159 &"route"&: Routing failed.
12160
12161 .next
12162 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12163 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12164 MAIL).
12165
12166 .next
12167 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12168 .next
12169
12170 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12171 .endlist
12172
12173 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12174 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12175
12176 .vitem &$recipients$&
12177 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
12178 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12179 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12180 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12181 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12182 cases:
12183
12184 .olist
12185 In a system filter file.
12186 .next
12187 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12188 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12189 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12190 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12191 .next
12192 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12193 .endlist
12194
12195
12196 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
12197 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12198 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12199 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12200 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12201 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12202
12203
12204 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12205 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12206 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12207 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12208
12209 .vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
12210 .cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
12211 When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
12212 these variables contain the
12213 captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
12214
12215
12216 .vitem &$reply_address$&
12217 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12218 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12219 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12220 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12221 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12222 decoding or character code translation takes place.
12223
12224 .vitem &$return_path$&
12225 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
12226 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12227 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12228 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12229 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12230 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12231 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12232 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12233 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12234 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12235 envelope sender.
12236
12237 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12238 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12239 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12240
12241 .vitem &$router_name$&
12242 .cindex "router" "name"
12243 .cindex "name" "of router"
12244 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
12245 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12246
12247 .vitem &$runrc$&
12248 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12249 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
12250 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
12251 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
12252 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
12253 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
12254 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
12255 another.
12256
12257 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
12258 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
12259 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
12260 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
12261 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
12262 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
12263 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
12264 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
12265
12266 .vitem &$sender_address$&
12267 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
12268 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
12269 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
12270 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
12271 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
12272
12273 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
12274 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12275 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
12276 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12277 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
12278 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
12279 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
12280 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
12281
12282 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
12283 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
12284 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
12285
12286 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
12287 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
12288 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
12289
12290 .vitem &$sender_data$&
12291 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
12292 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
12293 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
12294 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
12295 this:
12296 .display
12297 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12298 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
12299 .endd
12300 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12301 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12302 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12303 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12304
12305 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
12306 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
12307 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
12308 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
12309 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
12310 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
12311 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
12312 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
12313 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
12314 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
12315 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
12316 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
12317 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
12318
12319 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
12320 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
12321 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
12322 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12323 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
12324
12325 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
12326 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
12327 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
12328 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
12329 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
12330 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
12331
12332 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
12333 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
12334 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
12335 this variable contains that
12336 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
12337
12338 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
12339 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
12340 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
12341 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
12342 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
12343 &$authenticated_id$&.
12344
12345 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
12346 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
12347 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
12348 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
12349 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
12350 resolver library states that both
12351 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
12352 other times, this variable is false.
12353
12354 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12355 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
12356 library, by setting:
12357 .code
12358 dns_dnssec_ok = 1
12359 .endd
12360
12361 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
12362 validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
12363
12364 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
12365 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
12366
12367
12368 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
12369 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
12370 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12371 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
12372 other means, this variable is empty.
12373
12374 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12375 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
12376 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
12377 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
12378 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
12379 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
12380 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12381
12382 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12383 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
12384 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
12385 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
12386
12387 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
12388 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
12389 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12390 is set to &"1"&.
12391
12392 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
12393 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
12394 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
12395 following are true:
12396
12397 .ilist
12398 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
12399 .next
12400 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
12401 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
12402 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
12403 .next
12404 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
12405 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
12406 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
12407 .next
12408 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
12409 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
12410 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
12411 .next
12412 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
12413 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
12414 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12415 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
12416 .code
12417 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
12418 .endd
12419 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
12420 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
12421 .endlist
12422
12423
12424 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
12425 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
12426 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
12427 number that was used on the remote host.
12428
12429 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
12430 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
12431 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12432 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
12433 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
12434 called Exim.
12435
12436 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
12437 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
12438 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
12439 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
12440
12441 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
12442 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
12443 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
12444 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
12445 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
12446 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
12447 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
12448 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
12449 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
12450 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
12451 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
12452 the parentheses.
12453
12454 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
12455 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
12456 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
12457 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
12458 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
12459
12460 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
12461 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
12462 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
12463 about the failure. The details are the same as for
12464 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
12465
12466 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
12467 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
12468 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12469 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
12470 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
12471 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
12472 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
12473
12474 .vitem &$sending_port$&
12475 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
12476 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12477 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
12478 connections, see &$received_port$&.
12479
12480 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
12481 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
12482 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
12483 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
12484 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
12485 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
12486
12487 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
12488 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
12489 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
12490 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
12491 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
12492 .code
12493 MAIL FROM:<>
12494 MAIL FROM: <>
12495 .endd
12496 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
12497 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
12498 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
12499 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
12500
12501 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
12502 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
12503 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
12504 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
12505 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
12506 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
12507 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
12508
12509 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
12510 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
12511 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
12512 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
12513 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
12514 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
12515 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
12516 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
12517 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
12518 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
12519 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
12520
12521 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
12522 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
12523 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
12524 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
12525 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
12526 message is junk mail.
12527
12528 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
12529 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
12530 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
12531 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
12532
12533
12534 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
12535 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
12536 The name of Exim's spool directory.
12537
12538 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
12539 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12540 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
12541 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
12542 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
12543 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
12544
12545 .vitem &$spool_space$&
12546 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12547 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
12548 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
12549 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
12550 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
12551 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
12552 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
12553 .code
12554 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
12555 .endd
12556 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
12557
12558
12559 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
12560 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
12561 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
12562 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
12563 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
12564 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
12565
12566 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
12567 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
12568 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12569 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
12570 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12571 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12572 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
12573 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
12574
12575 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
12576 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12577 the outbound.
12578
12579 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
12580 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
12581 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12582 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
12583 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12584 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12585
12586 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
12587 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
12588 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12589 inbound connection when the message was received.
12590 It is only useful as the argument of a
12591 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12592 or a &%def%& condition.
12593
12594 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
12595 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
12596 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12597 inbound connection when the message was received.
12598 It is only useful as the argument of a
12599 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12600 or a &%def%& condition.
12601 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12602 which is not the leaf.
12603
12604 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
12605 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
12606 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12607 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12608 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12609 or a &%def%& condition.
12610
12611 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
12612 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
12613 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12614 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12615 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12616 or a &%def%& condition.
12617 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12618 which is not the leaf.
12619
12620 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
12621 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
12622 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
12623 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
12624
12625 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
12626 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12627 the outbound.
12628
12629 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
12630 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
12631 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
12632 outbound SMTP connection was made,
12633 and &"0"& otherwise.
12634
12635 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
12636 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
12637 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
12638 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12639 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
12640 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
12641 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
12642 &$tls_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
12643 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
12644
12645 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
12646 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
12647 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
12648
12649 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
12650 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
12651 This variable is
12652 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
12653 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
12654 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
12655 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
12656
12657 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
12658 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
12659 When a message is received from a remote client connection
12660 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
12661 .code
12662 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
12663 1 No response to request
12664 2 Response not verified
12665 3 Verification failed
12666 4 Verification succeeded
12667 .endd
12668
12669 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
12670 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
12671 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
12672 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
12673 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
12674
12675 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
12676 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
12677 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
12678 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12679 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
12680 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12681 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12682 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12683 which is not the leaf.
12684
12685 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
12686 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12687 the outbound.
12688
12689 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
12690 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
12691 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12692 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
12693 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12694 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12695 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12696 which is not the leaf.
12697
12698 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
12699 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
12700 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
12701 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12702 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
12703 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
12704 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
12705 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
12706 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
12707 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
12708 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
12709
12710 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
12711 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12712 the outbound.
12713
12714 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
12715 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
12716 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12717 During outbound
12718 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
12719 the transport.
12720
12721 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
12722 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
12723 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
12724 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
12725
12726 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
12727 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
12728 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12729
12730 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
12731 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
12732 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12733
12734 .vitem &$tod_full$&
12735 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
12736 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
12737 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
12738 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
12739 values for those that are behind (west).
12740
12741 .vitem &$tod_log$&
12742 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
12743 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
12744 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
12745
12746 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
12747 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
12748 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
12749 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
12750 flag.
12751
12752 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
12753 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
12754 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
12755 -0500.
12756
12757 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
12758 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
12759 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
12760 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
12761
12762 .vitem &$transport_name$&
12763 .cindex "transport" "name"
12764 .cindex "name" "of transport"
12765 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
12766 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
12767
12768 .vitem &$value$&
12769 .vindex "&$value$&"
12770 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
12771 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
12772 &*reduce*& expansion.
12773
12774 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
12775 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
12776 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode
12777 or for cutthrough delivery,
12778 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
12779 Otherwise, empty.
12780
12781 .vitem &$version_number$&
12782 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
12783 The version number of Exim.
12784
12785 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
12786 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
12787 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12788 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12789
12790 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
12791 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
12792 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12793 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12794 .endlist
12795 .ecindex IIDstrexp
12796
12797
12798
12799 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12800 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12801
12802 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
12803 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
12804 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
12805 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
12806 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
12807 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
12808 the line
12809 .code
12810 EXIM_PERL = perl.o
12811 .endd
12812 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
12813
12814
12815 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
12816 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
12817 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
12818 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
12819 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
12820 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
12821 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
12822 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
12823 a newly created Perl interpreter.
12824
12825 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
12826 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
12827 should usually be something like
12828 .code
12829 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
12830 .endd
12831 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
12832 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
12833 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
12834 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
12835 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
12836 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
12837 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
12838 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
12839 two ways:
12840
12841 .ilist
12842 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
12843 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
12844 a startup when Exim is entered.
12845 .next
12846 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
12847 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
12848 .endlist
12849
12850 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
12851 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
12852
12853
12854 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
12855 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
12856 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
12857 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
12858 forms:
12859 .code
12860 ${perl{foo}}
12861 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
12862 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
12863 .endd
12864 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
12865 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
12866 with an error message of the form
12867 .code
12868 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
12869 .endd
12870 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
12871 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
12872 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
12873 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
12874 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
12875 that was passed to &%die%&.
12876
12877
12878 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
12879 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
12880 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
12881 the Perl code
12882 .code
12883 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
12884 .endd
12885 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
12886 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
12887 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
12888
12889 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
12890 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
12891 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
12892 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
12893
12894 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
12895 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
12896 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
12897 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
12898 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
12899 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
12900 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
12901
12902
12903 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
12904 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
12905 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
12906 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
12907 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
12908 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
12909 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
12910 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
12911 avoided, but the output is lost.
12912
12913 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
12914 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
12915 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
12916 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
12917 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
12918 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
12919 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
12920 .code
12921 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
12922 .endd
12923 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
12924 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
12925 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
12926 as the first subroutine argument.
12927 .ecindex IIDperl
12928
12929
12930 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12931 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12932
12933 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
12934 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
12935 "Starting the daemon"
12936 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
12937 .cindex "interface" "listening"
12938 .cindex "network interface"
12939 .cindex "interface" "network"
12940 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
12941 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
12942 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
12943 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
12944 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
12945 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
12946 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
12947 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
12948 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
12949 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
12950 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
12951
12952 .olist
12953 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
12954 and ports to listen on.
12955 .next
12956 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
12957 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
12958 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
12959 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
12960 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
12961 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
12962 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
12963 as an error situation.
12964 .next
12965 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
12966 for the outgoing connection.
12967 .endlist
12968
12969
12970 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
12971 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
12972 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
12973 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
12974 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
12975
12976 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
12977 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
12978 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
12979 chapter describes how they operate.
12980
12981 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
12982 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
12983
12984
12985
12986 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
12987 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
12988 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
12989 following options:
12990
12991 .ilist
12992 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
12993 or service names.
12994 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
12995 .next
12996 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
12997 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
12998 .endlist
12999
13000 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
13001 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
13002 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
13003 colons. For example:
13004 .code
13005 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
13006 192.168.23.65 ; \
13007 ::1 ; \
13008 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
13009 .endd
13010 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
13011 in &%local_interfaces%&:
13012
13013 .olist
13014 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
13015 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
13016 .code
13017 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
13018 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
13019 .endd
13020 .next
13021 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
13022 with a colon separator, for example:
13023 .code
13024 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
13025 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
13026 .endd
13027 .endlist
13028
13029 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
13030 default setting contains just one port:
13031 .code
13032 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13033 .endd
13034 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13035 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13036 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13037 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13038 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13039
13040
13041
13042 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13043 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13044 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13045 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13046 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13047 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13048 .code
13049 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13050 .endd
13051 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
13052 .code
13053 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13054 .endd
13055 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13056
13057
13058
13059 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13060 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13061 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13062 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13063 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13064 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13065 exim.
13066
13067 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13068 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
13069 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13070 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13071 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13072 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13073 .code
13074 -oX 1225
13075 .endd
13076 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13077 whereas
13078 .code
13079 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13080 .endd
13081 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13082 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13083 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13084
13085
13086
13087 .section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13088 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13089 .cindex "smtps protocol"
13090 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13091 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13092 Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
13093 before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
13094 still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
13095 list of port numbers or service names,
13096 connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
13097 common use of this option is expected to be
13098 .code
13099 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13100 .endd
13101 because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
13102 a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
13103 this way when a daemon is started.
13104
13105 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13106 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13107 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13108 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13109 connections via the daemon.)
13110
13111
13112
13113
13114 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13115 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13116 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13117 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13118 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13119 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13120 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13121 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13122 .code
13123 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13124 .endd
13125 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13126 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13127 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13128 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13129 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13130 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13131 .code
13132 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13133 .endd
13134 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13135 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13136 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13137 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13138 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13139
13140 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13141 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13142 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13143 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13144 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13145 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13146 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13147 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13148 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13149 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13150 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13151 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13152
13153 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13154 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13155 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13156 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13157 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13158
13159
13160
13161 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
13162 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
13163 .code
13164 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13165 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13166 .endd
13167 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
13168 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
13169 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
13170 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
13171
13172 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
13173 .code
13174 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
13175 .endd
13176 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
13177 .code
13178 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
13179 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
13180 .endd
13181 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
13182 IPv4 loopback address only:
13183 .code
13184 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
13185 .endd
13186 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
13187 .code
13188 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
13189 .endd
13190 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
13191
13192
13193
13194 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
13195 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
13196 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
13197 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
13198 treated as local.
13199
13200 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
13201 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
13202 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
13203 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
13204
13205 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
13206 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
13207 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
13208 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
13209 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
13210 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
13211 used for listening. Consider this example:
13212 .code
13213 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
13214 192.168.53.235 ; \
13215 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
13216
13217 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13218 .endd
13219 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
13220 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
13221 Exim is routing.
13222
13223 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
13224 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
13225 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
13226 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
13227 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
13228 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
13229 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
13230 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
13231
13232
13233
13234 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
13235 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
13236 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
13237 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
13238 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
13239 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
13240 details.
13241
13242
13243
13244
13245 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13246 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13247
13248 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
13249 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
13250 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
13251 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
13252
13253 .ilist
13254 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
13255 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
13256 .next
13257 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
13258 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
13259 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
13260 .next
13261 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
13262 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
13263 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
13264 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
13265 settings.
13266 .endlist
13267
13268 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
13269 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
13270 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
13271 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
13272 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
13273 listed in more than one group.
13274
13275 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
13276 .table2
13277 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
13278 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13279 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
13280 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
13281 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
13282 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
13283 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
13284 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
13285 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
13286 .endtable
13287
13288
13289 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
13290 .table2
13291 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
13292 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13293 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
13294 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
13295 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
13296 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
13297 .endtable
13298
13299
13300
13301 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
13302 .table2
13303 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
13304 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
13305 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
13306 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13307 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13308 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
13309 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
13310 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
13311 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
13312 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
13313 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
13314 .endtable
13315
13316
13317
13318 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
13319 .table2
13320 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
13321 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13322 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
13323 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
13324 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
13325 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
13326 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
13327 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
13328 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
13329 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
13330 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
13331 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
13332 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
13333 .endtable
13334
13335
13336
13337 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
13338 .table2
13339 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
13340 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
13341 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
13342 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
13343 .endtable
13344
13345
13346
13347 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
13348 .table2
13349 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
13350 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13351 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13352 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
13353 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
13354 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
13355 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
13356 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
13357 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
13358 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
13359 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
13360 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
13361 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
13362 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
13363 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
13364 .endtable
13365
13366
13367
13368 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
13369 .table2
13370 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
13371 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
13372 .endtable
13373
13374
13375
13376 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
13377 .table2
13378 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
13379 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
13380 .endtable
13381
13382
13383
13384 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
13385 .table2
13386 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
13387 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
13388 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
13389 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
13390 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
13391 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13392 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13393 .endtable
13394
13395
13396
13397 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
13398 .table2
13399 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13400 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
13401 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13402 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
13403 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
13404 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
13405 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13406 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13407 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13408 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13409 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13410 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13411 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13412 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13413 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13414 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13415 connection"
13416 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13417 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13418 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13419 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
13420 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13421 .endtable
13422
13423
13424
13425 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
13426 .table2
13427 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
13428 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
13429 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
13430 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
13431 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
13432 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
13433 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
13434 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
13435 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
13436 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
13437 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
13438 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
13439 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
13440 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
13441 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
13442 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
13443 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
13444 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
13445 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
13446 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
13447 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
13448 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13449 words""&"
13450 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
13451 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
13452 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13453 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13454 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
13455 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
13456 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
13457 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
13458 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
13459 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13460 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13461 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
13462 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
13463 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
13464 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
13465 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13466 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
13467 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
13468 .endtable
13469
13470
13471
13472 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
13473 .table2
13474 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
13475 item"
13476 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
13477 item"
13478 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
13479 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
13480 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
13481 .endtable
13482
13483
13484
13485 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
13486 .table2
13487 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
13488 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
13489 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
13490 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13491 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
13492 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
13493 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
13494 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
13495 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
13496 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
13497 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
13498 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
13499 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
13500 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
13501 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
13502 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
13503 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
13504 .endtable
13505
13506
13507
13508 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
13509 .table2
13510 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
13511 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
13512 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
13513 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
13514 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
13515 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
13516 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
13517 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
13518 .endtable
13519
13520
13521
13522 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
13523 .table2
13524 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13525 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13526 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
13527 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13528 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
13529 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
13530 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
13531 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
13532 .endtable
13533
13534
13535
13536
13537 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
13538 .table2
13539 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
13540 .endtable
13541
13542
13543
13544
13545
13546 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
13547 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
13548
13549 .table2
13550 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domain for which DKIM ACL is run"
13551 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13552 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13553 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
13554 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
13555 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
13556 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
13557 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
13558 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13559 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13560 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13561 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13562 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13563 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13564 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13565 connection"
13566 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13567 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
13568 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
13569 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13570 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13571 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
13572 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
13573 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
13574 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
13575 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
13576 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
13577 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
13578 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
13579 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
13580 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13581 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13582 .endtable
13583
13584
13585
13586 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
13587 .table2
13588 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
13589 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
13590 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
13591 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
13592 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
13593 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
13594 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
13595 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13596 .endtable
13597
13598
13599
13600 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
13601 .table2
13602 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
13603 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
13604 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
13605 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13606 words""&"
13607 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13608 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13609 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
13610 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
13611 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
13612 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
13613 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13614 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
13615 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
13616 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
13617 .endtable
13618
13619
13620
13621 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
13622 .table2
13623 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
13624 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
13625 directory"
13626 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
13627 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
13628 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
13629 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
13630 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
13631 .endtable
13632
13633
13634
13635 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
13636 .table2
13637 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13638 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
13639 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
13640 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
13641 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
13642 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
13643 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
13644 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
13645 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
13646 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
13647 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
13648 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
13649 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
13650 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
13651 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
13652 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13653 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
13654 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
13655 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
13656 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
13657 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13658 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
13659 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
13660 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
13661 .endtable
13662
13663
13664
13665 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
13666 .table2
13667 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
13668 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
13669 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
13670 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
13671 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
13672 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
13673 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
13674 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
13675 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
13676 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
13677 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
13678 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
13679 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13680 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
13681 .endtable
13682
13683
13684
13685 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
13686 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
13687 &dagger;.
13688
13689 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
13690 .cindex "8BITMIME"
13691 .cindex "8-bit characters"
13692 .cindex "log" "selectors"
13693 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
13694 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
13695 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
13696 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
13697 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
13698
13699 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
13700 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
13701 It now defaults to true.
13702 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
13703 .display
13704 &url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
13705 .endd
13706
13707 To log received 8BITMIME status use
13708 .code
13709 log_selector = +8bitmime
13710 .endd
13711
13712 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
13713 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
13714 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13715 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
13716 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13717 further details.
13718
13719 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13720 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
13721 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
13722 SMTP messages.
13723
13724 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
13725 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
13726 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13727 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
13728 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13729
13730 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
13731 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
13732 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
13733 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
13734 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13735
13736 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
13737 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
13738 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
13739 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13740
13741 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
13742 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
13743 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
13744 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
13745 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13746
13747 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
13748 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
13749 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
13750 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
13751 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
13752 This option defines the ACL that,
13753 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
13754 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
13755 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
13756 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13757
13758 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
13759 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
13760 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
13761 of a received message.
13762 See chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>& for further details.
13763
13764 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
13765 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
13766 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
13767 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13768
13769 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
13770 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
13771 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
13772 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13773
13774 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
13775 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
13776 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
13777 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
13778 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13779
13780
13781 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
13782 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
13783 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
13784 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13785
13786 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
13787 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
13788 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
13789 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
13790 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
13791
13792 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13793 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
13794 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
13795 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
13796 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
13797
13798 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
13799 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
13800 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
13801 ends without a QUIT command being received.
13802 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13803
13804 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
13805 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
13806 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13807 further details.
13808
13809 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
13810 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
13811 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
13812 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13813
13814 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
13815 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
13816 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
13817 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13818
13819 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
13820 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
13821 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
13822 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13823
13824 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
13825 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
13826 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
13827 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13828
13829 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
13830 .cindex "admin user"
13831 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
13832 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
13833 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
13834 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
13835 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
13836 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
13837 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
13838
13839 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
13840 .cindex "domain literal"
13841 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
13842 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
13843 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
13844 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
13845
13846 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
13847 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
13848 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
13849 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
13850 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
13851 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
13852 the local host's IP addresses.
13853
13854
13855 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
13856 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
13857 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
13858 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
13859 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
13860 that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
13861 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
13862 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
13863 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
13864
13865 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
13866 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
13867 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
13868 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
13869 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
13870 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
13871 experiment if they wish.
13872
13873 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
13874 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
13875 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
13876 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
13877 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
13878 suitable setting is:
13879 .code
13880 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
13881 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
13882 .endd
13883 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
13884 .code
13885 dns_check_names_pattern =
13886 .endd
13887 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
13888
13889
13890 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
13891 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
13892 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
13893 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
13894 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
13895 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
13896 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
13897 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
13898 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
13899 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
13900 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
13901
13902 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
13903 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
13904 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
13905 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
13906 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
13907 which Exim advertises AUTH.
13908
13909 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
13910 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
13911 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
13912 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
13913 .code
13914 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
13915 .endd
13916 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13917 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
13918 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
13919 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
13920
13921
13922 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
13923 .cindex "thawing messages"
13924 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
13925 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
13926 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
13927 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
13928 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
13929 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
13930
13931 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
13932 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
13933 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
13934
13935
13936 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
13937 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
13938 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
13939 .code
13940 sophie:/var/run/sophie
13941 .endd
13942 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
13943 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
13944
13945
13946 .option bi_command main string unset
13947 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
13948 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
13949 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
13950 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
13951 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
13952
13953
13954 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
13955 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
13956 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
13957 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
13958 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
13959 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
13960
13961
13962 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
13963 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
13964 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
13965 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
13966
13967 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
13968 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
13969 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
13970 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
13971 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
13972 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
13973 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
13974 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
13975 point at which the error was detected are returned.
13976 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
13977
13978 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
13979 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
13980 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
13981 &%bounce_return_body%&.
13982
13983
13984 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
13985 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
13986 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
13987 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
13988 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
13989 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
13990 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
13991 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
13992 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
13993
13994 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
13995 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
13996 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
13997 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
13998 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
13999 messages.
14000
14001 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
14002 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
14003 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
14004 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
14005 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
14006 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
14007 connection. A typical setting might be:
14008 .code
14009 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14010 .endd
14011 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
14012 .code
14013 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14014 .endd
14015 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
14016 address.
14017
14018 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
14019 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
14020 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
14021 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
14022 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14023 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14024
14025
14026 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
14027 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
14028 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14029 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14030
14031
14032 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
14033 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
14034 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14035 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14036
14037
14038 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
14039 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
14040 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14041 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14042
14043
14044 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
14045 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
14046 callout verification. The default value is
14047 .code
14048 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
14049 .endd
14050 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
14051
14052
14053 .option check_log_inodes main integer 0
14054 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14055
14056
14057 .option check_log_space main integer 0
14058 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14059
14060 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14061 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14062 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14063 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14064 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14065 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14066 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14067 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14068 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14069 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14070
14071
14072 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 0
14073 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14074
14075
14076 .option check_spool_space main integer 0
14077 .cindex "checking disk space"
14078 .cindex "disk space, checking"
14079 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14080 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14081 message is accepted.
14082
14083 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14084 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
14085 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14086 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14087 When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14088 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14089 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14090 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14091
14092
14093 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14094 either value is greater than zero, for example:
14095 .code
14096 check_spool_space = 10M
14097 check_spool_inodes = 100
14098 .endd
14099 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14100 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14101 transit.
14102
14103 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14104 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14105 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14106
14107 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14108 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14109 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14110 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14111 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14112 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
14113
14114 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
14115 number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
14116
14117 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
14118 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
14119 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
14120
14121 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
14122 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
14123 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14124 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
14125 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
14126 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
14127
14128 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
14129 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
14130 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
14131 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
14132 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
14133 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
14134 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
14135
14136 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
14137 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
14138
14139 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
14140 .cindex "warning of delay"
14141 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
14142 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
14143 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
14144 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
14145 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
14146 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
14147 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
14148 with
14149 .code
14150 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
14151 .endd
14152 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
14153 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
14154 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
14155 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
14156 .code
14157 delay_warning = 6h
14158 .endd
14159 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
14160 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
14161 .code
14162 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
14163 .endd
14164 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
14165 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
14166 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
14167
14168 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
14169 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14170 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
14171 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
14172 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
14173 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
14174 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
14175 not sent. The default is:
14176 .code
14177 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
14178 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
14179 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
14180 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
14181 } {no}{yes}}
14182 .endd
14183 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
14184 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
14185 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
14186 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
14187
14188 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
14189 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
14190 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
14191 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
14192 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
14193 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
14194 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
14195 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
14196
14197 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
14198 .cindex "load average"
14199 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
14200 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
14201 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
14202 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
14203 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14204
14205
14206 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
14207 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
14208 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
14209 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14210 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
14211 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
14212 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
14213 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14214
14215 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
14216 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
14217 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
14218 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
14219 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
14220 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
14221 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
14222 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
14223
14224 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
14225 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
14226 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
14227 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
14228
14229
14230 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
14231 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14232 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14233 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14234 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
14235 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14236 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14237
14238
14239 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
14240 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
14241 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
14242 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
14243 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
14244 See chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
14245
14246
14247 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
14248 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
14249 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
14250 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
14251 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
14252 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
14253 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
14254 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
14255 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
14256 by a setting such as this:
14257 .code
14258 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
14259 .endd
14260 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
14261 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
14262 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
14263 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
14264 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
14265 options are applied after this global option.
14266
14267 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
14268 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
14269 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
14270 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
14271 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
14272 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
14273 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
14274 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
14275 value of this option. The default pattern is
14276 .code
14277 dns_check_names_pattern = \
14278 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
14279 .endd
14280 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
14281 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
14282 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
14283 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
14284 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
14285 empty string.
14286
14287 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
14288 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
14289 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14290
14291 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
14292 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
14293 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
14294 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14295
14296
14297 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
14298 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14299 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14300 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14301 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
14302 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
14303
14304 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
14305
14306
14307 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
14308 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
14309 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
14310 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
14311 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
14312 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
14313 domain matches this list.
14314
14315 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
14316 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
14317 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
14318
14319
14320 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
14321 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14322 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
14323 .cindex "DNS" timeout
14324 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
14325 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
14326 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
14327 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
14328 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
14329 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
14330 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
14331 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
14332 to set in them.
14333 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
14334
14335
14336 .option dns_retry main integer 0
14337 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
14338
14339
14340 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
14341 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14342 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14343 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
14344 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
14345 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
14346 match with this expanded domain list.
14347
14348 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
14349 authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
14350 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
14351 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
14352 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
14353 a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
14354
14355 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
14356 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
14357 zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
14358
14359 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
14360 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
14361 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
14362 authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
14363 record in the authoritative section is used instead.
14364
14365 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14366 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
14367 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14368 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
14369 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14370 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
14371 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
14372 on.
14373
14374 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
14375
14376
14377 .option drop_cr main boolean false
14378 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
14379 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
14380 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
14381
14382 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14383 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
14384 .cindex "DSN" "success"
14385 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
14386 DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
14387 and accepted from, these hosts.
14388 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
14389 and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
14390 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
14391 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
14392 are sent.
14393
14394 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
14395 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
14396 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
14397 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
14398 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
14399 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
14400 .code
14401 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
14402 .endd
14403 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
14404 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
14405
14406 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
14407 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
14408 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
14409 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14410 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
14411 message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
14412 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
14413 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
14414 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14415
14416
14417 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
14418 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
14419 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
14420 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
14421 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
14422 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
14423 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
14424 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
14425 must be enclosed in double quotes.
14426
14427 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
14428 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
14429 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
14430 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
14431 are examined. For example:
14432 .code
14433 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
14434 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
14435 postmaster@mydomain.example
14436 .endd
14437 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14438 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
14439 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
14440 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
14441 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
14442 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
14443 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
14444
14445
14446 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
14447 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
14448 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
14449 .display
14450 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
14451 .endd
14452 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
14453 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
14454 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
14455 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
14456 overrides the default.
14457
14458 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
14459 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
14460 and warning messages. For example:
14461 .code
14462 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
14463 .endd
14464 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
14465 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
14466 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
14467 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
14468 not used.
14469
14470
14471 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
14472 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
14473 .cindex "Exim group"
14474 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14475 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
14476 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
14477 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
14478 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
14479 security issues.
14480
14481
14482 .option exim_path main string "see below"
14483 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
14484 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
14485 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
14486 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
14487 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
14488 other place.
14489 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
14490 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
14491 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
14492 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
14493
14494
14495 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
14496 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
14497 .cindex "Exim user"
14498 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14499 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
14500 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
14501 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
14502
14503 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
14504 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
14505 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
14506 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
14507
14508
14509 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
14510 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
14511 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
14512 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
14513
14514
14515 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14516 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14517
14518 .option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
14519 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
14520 .oindex "&%-t%&"
14521 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
14522 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
14523 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
14524 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
14525 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
14526 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
14527 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
14528 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
14529 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
14530 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
14531 addresses.
14532
14533
14534 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
14535 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
14536 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
14537 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
14538 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
14539 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
14540 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
14541 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
14542 retries.
14543
14544 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
14545 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
14546 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
14547 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
14548
14549
14550
14551 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
14552 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
14553 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
14554 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
14555 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
14556 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
14557 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
14558 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
14559 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
14560 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
14561 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
14562 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
14563 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
14564 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
14565 logging that you require.
14566
14567
14568 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
14569 .cindex "HP-UX"
14570 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
14571 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
14572 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
14573 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
14574 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
14575 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
14576 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
14577 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
14578
14579 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
14580 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
14581 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
14582 user's name.
14583
14584 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
14585 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
14586 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
14587 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
14588 .code
14589 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
14590 gecos_name = $1
14591 .endd
14592
14593 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
14594 See &%gecos_name%& above.
14595
14596
14597 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
14598 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
14599 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
14600 implementations of TLS.
14601
14602
14603 option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
14604 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
14605 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
14606
14607 See
14608 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
14609 for documentation.
14610
14611
14612
14613 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
14614 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
14615 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
14616 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
14617 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
14618 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
14619
14620
14621
14622 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
14623 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
14624 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
14625 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
14626 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
14627 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
14628 sections are rejected.
14629
14630
14631 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
14632 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
14633 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
14634 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
14635 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
14636 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
14637 zero means &"no limit"&.
14638
14639
14640
14641
14642 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14643 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
14644 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
14645 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
14646 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
14647 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
14648 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
14649 if you want to do semantic checking.
14650 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
14651 set.
14652
14653
14654 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
14655 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
14656 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
14657 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
14658 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
14659 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
14660 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
14661 .code
14662 helo_allow_chars = _
14663 .endd
14664 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
14665
14666
14667 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
14668 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14669 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14670 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
14671 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
14672 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
14673 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
14674 do.
14675
14676
14677 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14678 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
14679 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
14680 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
14681 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
14682 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
14683 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
14684 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
14685 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
14686 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
14687 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
14688 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
14689
14690 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
14691 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
14692 EHLO command either:
14693
14694 .ilist
14695 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
14696 .next
14697 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
14698 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
14699 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
14700 calling host address, or
14701 .next
14702 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
14703 .endlist
14704
14705 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
14706 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
14707 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
14708
14709 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
14710 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14711 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
14712
14713 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14714 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
14715 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
14716 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
14717 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
14718 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
14719 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
14720 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
14721 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
14722 error.
14723
14724 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14725 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
14726 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
14727 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
14728 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
14729 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
14730 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
14731 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
14732 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
14733
14734 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
14735 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
14736 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
14737 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
14738 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
14739
14740 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
14741 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
14742 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
14743 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
14744
14745
14746 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
14747 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
14748 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
14749 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
14750 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
14751 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
14752 default configuration file contains
14753 .code
14754 host_lookup = *
14755 .endd
14756 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
14757 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
14758
14759 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
14760 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
14761 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
14762
14763 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
14764 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
14765 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
14766 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
14767 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
14768 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
14769
14770
14771 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
14772 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
14773 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
14774 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
14775 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
14776 if you want.
14777
14778 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
14779 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
14780 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
14781 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
14782
14783
14784
14785 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
14786 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
14787 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
14788 as soon as the connection is made.
14789 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
14790 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
14791 connections immediately.
14792
14793 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
14794 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
14795 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
14796 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
14797 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
14798
14799
14800 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
14801 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
14802 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
14803 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
14804 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
14805 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
14806 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
14807 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
14808 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
14809 .code
14810 hosts_connection_nolog = :
14811 .endd
14812 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
14813
14814
14815
14816 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
14817 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
14818 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
14819 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
14820 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
14821 records
14822 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
14823 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
14824
14825 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
14826 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
14827 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
14828 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
14829 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
14830 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
14831 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
14832
14833
14834 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
14835 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
14836 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
14837 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14838 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
14839
14840
14841
14842 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
14843 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
14844 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
14845 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
14846 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
14847 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
14848
14849 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
14850 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
14851 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
14852 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
14853 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
14854 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
14855 for frozen messages. For example,
14856 .code
14857 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
14858 .endd
14859 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
14860 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
14861 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
14862 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
14863 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
14864 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
14865
14866
14867 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14868 .cindex "&""From""& line"
14869 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
14870 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
14871 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
14872 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
14873 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
14874 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
14875 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
14876 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
14877
14878
14879 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
14880 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
14881
14882
14883 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
14884 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
14885 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
14886 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
14887 logged.
14888
14889
14890 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
14891 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
14892 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
14893 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14894 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14895 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14896 and constrained to be a directory.
14897
14898
14899 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
14900 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
14901 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
14902 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14903 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14904 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14905 and constrained to be a file.
14906
14907
14908 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
14909 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
14910 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
14911 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14912 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
14913
14914
14915 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
14916 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
14917 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
14918 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14919 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
14920 identity to be proven.
14921
14922
14923 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
14924 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
14925 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
14926 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
14927 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
14928
14929
14930 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
14931 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
14932 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
14933 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
14934 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
14935 with LDAP support.
14936
14937
14938 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
14939 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
14940 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
14941 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
14942 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
14943 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
14944 to hard/demand.
14945
14946
14947 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
14948 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
14949 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
14950 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
14951 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
14952 of SSL-on-connect.
14953 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
14954 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
14955
14956
14957 .option ldap_version main integer unset
14958 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
14959 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
14960 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
14961 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
14962 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
14963 has been built with LDAP support.
14964
14965
14966
14967 .option local_from_check main boolean true
14968 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
14969 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
14970 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14971 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
14972 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
14973 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
14974
14975 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
14976 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
14977 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14978
14979 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
14980 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
14981 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
14982 and the default qualify domain.
14983
14984 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
14985 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
14986 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
14987 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
14988
14989 .cindex "envelope sender"
14990 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
14991 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
14992 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
14993
14994 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
14995 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
14996 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14997
14998
14999
15000
15001 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
15002 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
15003 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
15004 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
15005 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
15006 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
15007 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
15008 example, if
15009 .code
15010 local_from_prefix = *-
15011 .endd
15012 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
15013 .code
15014 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
15015 .endd
15016 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
15017 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
15018 qualify domain.
15019
15020
15021 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
15022 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
15023
15024
15025 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
15026 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
15027 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
15028 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
15029 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
15030 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
15031 &%local_interfaces%& is
15032 .code
15033 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
15034 .endd
15035 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
15036 .code
15037 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
15038 .endd
15039
15040 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
15041 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
15042 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
15043 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
15044 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
15045 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
15046 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
15047 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
15048
15049
15050
15051 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
15052 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
15053 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15054 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
15055 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
15056 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
15057 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
15058 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15059
15060
15061
15062
15063 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
15064 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
15065 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
15066 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
15067 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
15068 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
15069 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
15070 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
15071 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
15072 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
15073 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
15074 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
15075 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
15076 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
15077 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
15078
15079
15080
15081 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
15082 .cindex "log" "file path for"
15083 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
15084 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
15085 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
15086 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time,
15087 or if the option is unset at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
15088 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
15089 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
15090 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
15091 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
15092 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
15093 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
15094 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
15095 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
15096
15097
15098 .option log_selector main string unset
15099 .cindex "log" "selectors"
15100 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
15101 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
15102 minus characters. For example:
15103 .code
15104 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
15105 .endd
15106 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
15107 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
15108
15109
15110 .option log_timezone main boolean false
15111 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
15112 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
15113 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
15114 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
15115 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
15116 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
15117 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
15118 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
15119 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
15120 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
15121 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
15122 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
15123
15124
15125 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
15126 .cindex "too many open files"
15127 .cindex "open files, too many"
15128 .cindex "file" "too many open"
15129 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
15130 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
15131 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
15132 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
15133 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
15134 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
15135 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
15136 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
15137 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
15138 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
15139 &%lookup_open_max%&.
15140
15141
15142 .option max_username_length main integer 0
15143 .cindex "length of login name"
15144 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
15145 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
15146 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
15147 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
15148 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
15149 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
15150
15151
15152 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
15153 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
15154 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
15155 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15156 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15157 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
15158 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
15159 option is set true, this no longer happens.
15160
15161
15162 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
15163 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
15164 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
15165 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15166 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15167 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
15168 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
15169
15170
15171 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
15172 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
15173 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
15174 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
15175 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
15176 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
15177 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
15178 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
15179 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
15180 empty string, the option is ignored.
15181
15182
15183 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
15184 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
15185 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
15186 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
15187 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
15188 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
15189 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
15190 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
15191 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
15192 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
15193 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
15194 colons will become hyphens.
15195
15196
15197 .option message_logs main boolean true
15198 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
15199 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
15200 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
15201 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
15202 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
15203 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
15204 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
15205 which is not affected by this option.
15206
15207
15208 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
15209 .cindex "message" "size limit"
15210 .cindex "limit" "message size"
15211 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
15212 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
15213 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
15214 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
15215 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
15216 optionally followed by K or M.
15217
15218 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
15219 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
15220 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
15221 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
15222 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15223
15224 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
15225 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
15226 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
15227 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
15228 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
15229 message that an individual transport can process.
15230
15231 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
15232 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
15233 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
15234 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
15235 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
15236 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
15237 some problems may result.
15238
15239 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
15240 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
15241 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
15242
15243
15244 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
15245 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
15246 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
15247 .code
15248 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
15249 .endd
15250 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
15251 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
15252 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
15253 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
15254 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
15255
15256
15257 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
15258 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
15259 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
15260 contains a full description of this facility.
15261
15262
15263
15264 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
15265 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
15266 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
15267 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
15268 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
15269
15270
15271 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
15272 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
15273 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
15274 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
15275 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
15276 safety precaution.
15277
15278 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
15279 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
15280 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
15281 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
15282 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
15283
15284 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
15285 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
15286 example is
15287 .code
15288 never_users = root:daemon:bin
15289 .endd
15290 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
15291 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
15292 transport driver.
15293
15294
15295 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2"
15296 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
15297 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
15298 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
15299 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
15300
15301 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
15302 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
15303 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
15304 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
15305 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
15306 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
15307 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
15308
15309 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
15310 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
15311 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
15312 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
15313 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
15314
15315 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
15316
15317 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
15318 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
15319 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
15320 some now infamous attacks.
15321
15322 Examples:
15323 .code
15324 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
15325 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
15326 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
15327
15328 # Disable older protocol versions:
15329 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
15330 .endd
15331
15332 Possible options may include:
15333 .ilist
15334 &`all`&
15335 .next
15336 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
15337 .next
15338 &`cipher_server_preference`&
15339 .next
15340 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
15341 .next
15342 &`ephemeral_rsa`&
15343 .next
15344 &`legacy_server_connect`&
15345 .next
15346 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
15347 .next
15348 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
15349 .next
15350 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
15351 .next
15352 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
15353 .next
15354 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
15355 .next
15356 &`no_compression`&
15357 .next
15358 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
15359 .next
15360 &`no_sslv2`&
15361 .next
15362 &`no_sslv3`&
15363 .next
15364 &`no_ticket`&
15365 .next
15366 &`no_tlsv1`&
15367 .next
15368 &`no_tlsv1_1`&
15369 .next
15370 &`no_tlsv1_2`&
15371 .next
15372 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
15373 .next
15374 &`single_dh_use`&
15375 .next
15376 &`single_ecdh_use`&
15377 .next
15378 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
15379 .next
15380 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
15381 .next
15382 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
15383 .next
15384 &`tls_d5_bug`&
15385 .next
15386 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
15387 .endlist
15388
15389 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
15390 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
15391 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
15392 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
15393 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
15394 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
15395
15396
15397 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
15398 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
15399 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
15400 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15401 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
15402
15403
15404 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15405 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
15406 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
15407 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
15408 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
15409 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
15410 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
15411 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
15412 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
15413 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
15414 an ACL.
15415
15416 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
15417 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
15418 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
15419 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
15420 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
15421 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
15422 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
15423
15424
15425 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
15426 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15427 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15428
15429
15430 .option perl_startup main string unset
15431 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15432 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15433
15434
15435 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
15436 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
15437 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
15438 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
15439 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
15440 PostgreSQL support.
15441
15442
15443 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
15444 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
15445 .cindex "pid file, path for"
15446 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
15447 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
15448 to the host name:
15449 .code
15450 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
15451 .endd
15452 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
15453 spool directory.
15454 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
15455 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
15456 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
15457
15458
15459 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15460 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
15461 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
15462 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
15463 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
15464 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
15465 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
15466 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
15467 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
15468
15469
15470 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
15471 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
15472 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
15473 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
15474 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
15475 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
15476 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
15477 is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
15478
15479 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
15480 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
15481 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
15482 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
15483 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
15484 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
15485 volume of mail. Use with care!
15486
15487
15488 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
15489 .cindex "name" "of local host"
15490 .cindex "host" "name of local"
15491 .cindex "local host" "name of"
15492 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
15493 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
15494 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
15495 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
15496 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
15497 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
15498
15499 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
15500 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
15501 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
15502 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
15503 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
15504 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
15505
15506
15507 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
15508 .cindex "printing characters"
15509 .cindex "8-bit characters"
15510 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
15511 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
15512 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
15513 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
15514 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
15515 characters.
15516
15517 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
15518 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
15519 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
15520 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
15521 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
15522 standards.
15523
15524
15525 .option process_log_path main string unset
15526 .cindex "process log path"
15527 .cindex "log" "process log"
15528 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
15529 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
15530 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
15531 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
15532 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
15533 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
15534 different spool directories.
15535
15536
15537 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
15538 .oindex "&%-M%&"
15539 .oindex "&%-R%&"
15540 .oindex "&%-q%&"
15541 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
15542 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
15543 &%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
15544
15545
15546 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
15547 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
15548 .cindex "address" "qualification"
15549 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
15550 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
15551 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
15552 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
15553 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
15554 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15555
15556 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
15557 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
15558 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
15559 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
15560 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
15561 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
15562 &%primary_hostname%& value.
15563
15564
15565 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
15566 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
15567 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
15568
15569
15570
15571 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15572 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
15573 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15574 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
15575 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
15576 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
15577 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
15578 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
15579
15580
15581 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
15582 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
15583 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
15584 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
15585 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
15586
15587
15588 .option queue_only main boolean false
15589 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15590 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
15591 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
15592 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
15593 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
15594 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
15595
15596 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
15597 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
15598 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
15599 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
15600
15601
15602 .option queue_only_file main string unset
15603 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15604 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
15605 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
15606 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
15607 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
15608 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
15609 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
15610 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
15611 .code
15612 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
15613 .endd
15614 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
15615 &_/some/file_& exists.
15616
15617
15618 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
15619 .cindex "load average"
15620 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15621 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
15622 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
15623 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
15624 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
15625 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
15626 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15627 false.
15628
15629 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
15630 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
15631 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
15632 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15633
15634
15635 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
15636 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
15637 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
15638 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
15639 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
15640 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
15641 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
15642 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
15643 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
15644 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15645 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
15646 re-evaluated for each message.
15647
15648
15649 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
15650 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15651 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
15652 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
15653 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
15654 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
15655
15656
15657 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
15658 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
15659 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
15660 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
15661 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
15662 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
15663 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
15664 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
15665 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
15666 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
15667 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
15668 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
15669 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
15670
15671
15672
15673 .option queue_run_max main integer 5
15674 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
15675 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
15676 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
15677 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
15678 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
15679 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
15680 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
15681 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
15682
15683 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
15684 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
15685 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
15686 the daemon's command line.
15687
15688 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15689 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15690 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
15691 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
15692 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
15693 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
15694 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
15695 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
15696 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
15697 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
15698 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
15699 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
15700 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
15701 &%queue_domains%&.
15702
15703
15704 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
15705 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
15706 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
15707 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
15708 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
15709 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
15710 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
15711
15712 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
15713 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
15714 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
15715 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
15716 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
15717 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
15718 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
15719 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
15720 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
15721 header lines. The default setting is:
15722
15723 .code
15724 received_header_text = Received: \
15725 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
15726 {${if def:sender_ident \
15727 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
15728 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
15729 by $primary_hostname \
15730 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
15731 ${if def:tls_in_cipher {($tls_in_cipher)\n\t}}\
15732 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
15733 ${if def:sender_address \
15734 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
15735 id $message_exim_id\
15736 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
15737 .endd
15738
15739 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
15740 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
15741 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
15742 header lines such as the following:
15743 .code
15744 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
15745 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
15746 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
15747 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
15748 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
15749 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
15750 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
15751 .endd
15752 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
15753 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
15754 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
15755 message was accepted.
15756
15757
15758 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
15759 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
15760 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
15761 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
15762 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
15763 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
15764 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
15765 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
15766
15767
15768 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15769 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
15770 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15771 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15772 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
15773 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
15774 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
15775 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
15776 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
15777 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
15778 option was not set.
15779
15780
15781 .option recipients_max main integer 0
15782 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
15783 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
15784 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
15785 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
15786 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
15787 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
15788 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
15789 done.
15790
15791 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
15792 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
15793 RCPT commands in a single message.
15794
15795
15796 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
15797 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
15798 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
15799 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
15800 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
15801 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
15802 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
15803
15804
15805 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
15806 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
15807 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
15808 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
15809 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
15810 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
15811 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
15812 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
15813 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
15814 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
15815 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
15816 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
15817 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
15818 tagged with its process id.
15819
15820 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
15821 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
15822 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
15823 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
15824 is received.
15825
15826 .cindex "number of deliveries"
15827 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
15828 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
15829 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
15830 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
15831 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
15832 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
15833 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
15834 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
15835 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
15836 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
15837
15838 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
15839 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
15840 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
15841 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
15842
15843
15844 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15845 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
15846 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
15847 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
15848 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
15849 .code
15850 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
15851 .endd
15852 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
15853 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
15854
15855
15856 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
15857 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
15858 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
15859 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
15860 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
15861 past failures.
15862
15863
15864 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
15865 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
15866 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
15867 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
15868 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
15869 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
15870 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
15871 the default value.
15872
15873
15874 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
15875 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
15876 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
15877 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
15878 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
15879 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
15880 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
15881 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
15882 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
15883 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
15884
15885
15886 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
15887 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15888
15889
15890 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
15891 .cindex "RFC 1413"
15892 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
15893 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
15894 an item in the list.
15895 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
15896 for the system.
15897
15898 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
15899 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
15900 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
15901 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
15902 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
15903
15904
15905 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15906 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
15907 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15908 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15909 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
15910 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
15911 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
15912 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
15913 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
15914 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
15915
15916
15917 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
15918 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
15919 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
15920 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
15921 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
15922 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
15923 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
15924
15925
15926
15927 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
15928 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
15929 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
15930 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
15931 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
15932 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
15933 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
15934 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
15935 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
15936 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
15937 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
15938
15939
15940
15941 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
15942 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
15943 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15944 .cindex "inetd"
15945 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
15946 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
15947 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
15948 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
15949 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
15950 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15951
15952 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
15953 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
15954 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
15955 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
15956
15957
15958 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
15959 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
15960 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
15961 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
15962 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
15963 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
15964 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
15965 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
15966
15967 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
15968 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
15969 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
15970 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
15971 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
15972 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
15973 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
15974 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
15975
15976
15977 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15978 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
15979 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
15980 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
15981 live with.
15982
15983
15984 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15985 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15986 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
15987 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
15988 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
15989 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
15990 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
15991 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
15992 . the option name to split.
15993
15994 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
15995 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
15996 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
15997 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
15998 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
15999 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
16000 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
16001 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
16002 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
16003 seen).
16004
16005
16006 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
16007 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
16008 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
16009 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
16010 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
16011 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
16012 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
16013 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
16014 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
16015 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
16016 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
16017
16018 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
16019 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
16020 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
16021 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
16022 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
16023 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
16024
16025
16026
16027 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
16028 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16029 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16030 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
16031 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
16032 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
16033 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
16034 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
16035 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
16036 to all messages received in the same connection.
16037
16038 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
16039 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
16040 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
16041 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
16042
16043
16044 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16045
16046 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
16047 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
16048 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16049 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
16050 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
16051 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
16052 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
16053 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
16054 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
16055 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
16056 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
16057 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
16058 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
16059
16060
16061 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
16062 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
16063 .cindex "host" "reserved"
16064 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
16065 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
16066 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
16067 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
16068 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
16069 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
16070 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
16071 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
16072 individual host.
16073
16074 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
16075 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
16076 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
16077 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
16078
16079
16080 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
16081 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
16082 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
16083 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16084 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
16085 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
16086 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
16087 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
16088 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
16089
16090 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
16091 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
16092 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
16093 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
16094
16095 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
16096 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
16097 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
16098 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
16099 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
16100 For example:
16101 .code
16102 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
16103 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
16104 .endd
16105
16106 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
16107 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
16108 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
16109 &%helo_data%& value.
16110
16111 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
16112 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
16113 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
16114 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
16115 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
16116 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
16117 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
16118 .code
16119 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
16120 $version_number $tod_full
16121 .endd
16122 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
16123 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
16124 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
16125 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
16126 multiline response).
16127
16128
16129 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
16130 .cindex "checking disk space"
16131 .cindex "disk space, checking"
16132 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
16133 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
16134 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
16135 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
16136 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
16137 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
16138
16139
16140 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
16141 .cindex "connection backlog"
16142 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
16143 .cindex "backlog of connections"
16144 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
16145 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
16146 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
16147 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
16148 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
16149 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
16150 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
16151 attacks by SYN flooding.
16152
16153
16154 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
16155 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
16156 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
16157 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
16158 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
16159 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
16160 fewer, but they still exist.
16161
16162 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
16163 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
16164 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
16165 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
16166 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
16167 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
16168 does detect many instances.
16169
16170 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
16171 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
16172 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
16173 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
16174
16175
16176
16177 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
16178 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
16179 .vindex "&$domain$&"
16180 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
16181 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
16182 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
16183 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
16184 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
16185 example:
16186 .code
16187 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
16188 $sender_host_address
16189 .endd
16190 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
16191 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
16192 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
16193 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
16194 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
16195 the command.
16196
16197
16198 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
16199 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
16200 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
16201 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
16202 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
16203
16204
16205 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
16206 .cindex "load average"
16207 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
16208 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
16209 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
16210 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
16211 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
16212 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
16213
16214
16215
16216 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
16217 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
16218 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
16219 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
16220 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
16221 .code
16222 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
16223 .endd
16224 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
16225 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
16226 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
16227 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
16228 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
16229
16230 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
16231 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
16232 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
16233 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
16234 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
16235 not count towards the limit.
16236
16237
16238
16239 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
16240 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
16241 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
16242 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
16243 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
16244 that subvert web
16245 clients
16246 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
16247 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
16248
16249
16250
16251 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16252 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
16253 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
16254 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
16255 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
16256 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
16257 recipients.
16258
16259 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
16260 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
16261 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
16262 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
16263
16264 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
16265 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
16266 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
16267 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
16268 values:
16269
16270 .ilist
16271 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
16272 .next
16273 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
16274 fractional parts are allowed here.
16275 .next
16276 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
16277 .next
16278 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
16279 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
16280 .endlist
16281
16282 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
16283 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
16284 .code
16285 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
16286 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
16287 .endd
16288 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
16289 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
16290 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
16291 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
16292
16293
16294 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
16295 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16296
16297
16298 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
16299 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16300
16301
16302 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
16303 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
16304 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
16305 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
16306 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
16307 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
16308 the message is abandoned.
16309 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
16310 .code
16311 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
16312 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
16313 .endd
16314 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
16315 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
16316
16317 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
16318 expanded before use and may depend on
16319 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
16320
16321
16322 .oindex "&%-os%&"
16323 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
16324 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
16325 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
16326 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
16327 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
16328
16329
16330 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16331 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
16332 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
16333
16334
16335 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
16336 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
16337 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
16338 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
16339 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
16340 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
16341 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
16342 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
16343 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
16344 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
16345 .code
16346 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
16347 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
16348 .endd
16349
16350 .option spamd_address main string "see below"
16351 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
16352 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
16353 The default value is
16354 .code
16355 127.0.0.1 783
16356 .endd
16357 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
16358
16359
16360
16361 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
16362 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
16363 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
16364 .cindex "directories, multiple"
16365 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
16366 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
16367 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
16368 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
16369 arrival of the message.
16370
16371 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
16372 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
16373 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
16374 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
16375 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
16376
16377 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
16378 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
16379 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
16380 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
16381 automatically deleted.
16382
16383 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
16384 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
16385 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
16386 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
16387 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
16388 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
16389 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
16390 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
16391 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
16392
16393
16394 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
16395 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
16396 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
16397 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
16398 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
16399 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
16400 &$primary_hostname$&.
16401
16402 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
16403 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
16404 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
16405 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
16406 as failures in the configuration file.
16407
16408 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
16409 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
16410
16411 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
16412 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
16413 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
16414 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
16415
16416 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
16417 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
16418 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
16419 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
16420 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
16421 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
16422
16423 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
16424 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
16425 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
16426 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
16427 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
16428 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
16429 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
16430
16431
16432 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
16433 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
16434 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
16435 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
16436 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
16437 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
16438 domain causes a syntax error.
16439 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
16440 syntax checking.
16441
16442
16443 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
16444 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
16445 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
16446 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
16447 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
16448 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
16449 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
16450 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
16451 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
16452 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
16453 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
16454 the LOG_ALERT priority.
16455
16456
16457 .option syslog_facility main string unset
16458 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
16459 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16460 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
16461 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
16462 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16463 details of Exim's logging.
16464
16465
16466
16467 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
16468 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
16469 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16470 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
16471 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
16472
16473
16474
16475 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
16476 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
16477 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
16478 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16479 details of Exim's logging.
16480
16481
16482 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
16483 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
16484 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
16485 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
16486 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
16487 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
16488 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
16489 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
16490 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
16491 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
16492 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
16493
16494
16495 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
16496 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
16497 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
16498 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
16499 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
16500 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16501
16502
16503 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
16504 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
16505 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
16506 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
16507 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16508
16509 .option system_filter_group main string unset
16510 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
16511 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
16512 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
16513 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
16514
16515 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
16516 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
16517 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
16518 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
16519 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
16520 contains the pipe command.
16521
16522
16523 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
16524 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
16525 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
16526 is used in a system filter.
16527
16528
16529 .option system_filter_user main string unset
16530 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
16531 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
16532 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
16533 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
16534 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
16535 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
16536 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
16537 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
16538 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
16539
16540 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
16541 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
16542 transport option overrides.
16543
16544
16545 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
16546 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
16547 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
16548 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
16549 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
16550 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
16551 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
16552 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
16553 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
16554 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
16555 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
16556 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
16557 TCP_NODELAY.
16558
16559
16560 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
16561 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
16562 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
16563 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
16564 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
16565 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
16566 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
16567 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
16568 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
16569 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
16570
16571 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
16572 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
16573 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
16574
16575
16576 .option timezone main string unset
16577 .cindex "timezone, setting"
16578 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
16579 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
16580 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
16581 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
16582 .code
16583 timezone = UTC
16584 .endd
16585 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
16586 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
16587 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
16588 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
16589 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
16590 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
16591
16592
16593 .new
16594 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16595 .wen
16596 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
16597 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
16598 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
16599 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
16600 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
16601 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
16602 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
16603 .new
16604 Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
16605 using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If no certificate is available then
16606 the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
16607 .wen
16608
16609
16610 .option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
16611 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
16612 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
16613 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16614 file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
16615 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
16616 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16617
16618 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
16619 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
16620 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
16621 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
16622
16623 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
16624 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
16625 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
16626 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
16627
16628 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
16629 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
16630 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
16631 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
16632 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
16633
16634 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16635
16636
16637 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
16638 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
16639 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
16640 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
16641 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
16642 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
16643
16644 The value must be at least 1024.
16645
16646 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
16647 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
16648 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
16649
16650 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
16651 number.
16652
16653 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
16654 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
16655 larger prime than requested.
16656
16657
16658 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
16659 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
16660 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
16661 to be used by Exim.
16662
16663 If it is a filename starting with a &`/`&, then it names a file from which DH
16664 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
16665 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
16666 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
16667 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
16668 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
16669 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
16670
16671 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
16672 loaded by Exim.
16673
16674 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
16675 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
16676 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
16677 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
16678
16679 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
16680 a default DH prime; the default is the 2048 bit prime described in section
16681 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
16682 in IKE is assigned number 23.
16683
16684 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
16685 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526 and RFC 5114. As names, Exim uses
16686 "ike" followed by the number used by IKE, of "default" which corresponds to
16687 "ike23".
16688
16689 The available primes are:
16690 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
16691 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
16692 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& (aka &`default`&) and &`ike24`&.
16693
16694 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
16695 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
16696
16697 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
16698 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
16699 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
16700 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
16701 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
16702 userbase.
16703
16704 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
16705 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
16706 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
16707 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
16708 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
16709 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
16710 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
16711
16712
16713 .option tls_eccurve main string&!! prime256v1
16714 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
16715 If built with a recent-enough version of OpenSSL,
16716 this option selects a EC curve for use by Exim.
16717
16718 Curve names of the form &'prime256v1'& are accepted.
16719 For even more-recent library versions, names of the form &'P-512'&
16720 are also accepted, plus the special value &'auto'&
16721 which tell the library to choose.
16722
16723 If the option is set to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
16724
16725
16726 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
16727 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
16728 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
16729 This option
16730 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
16731 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
16732 Certificate Authority.
16733
16734 .new
16735 Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
16736 .wen
16737
16738
16739 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
16740 .cindex SSMTP
16741 .cindex SMTPS
16742 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
16743 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
16744 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
16745 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
16746
16747
16748
16749 .option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
16750 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
16751 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16752 file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
16753 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
16754 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
16755 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16756
16757 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16758
16759
16760 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
16761 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
16762 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
16763 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
16764 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
16765 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
16766 TLS session.
16767
16768
16769 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
16770 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
16771 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
16772 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
16773 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
16774 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
16775 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
16776 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
16777 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
16778 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
16779 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
16780
16781
16782 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16783 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16784 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16785 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
16786
16787
16788 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
16789 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16790 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16791 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
16792 word "system"
16793 or the absolute path to
16794 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
16795 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
16796
16797 The "system" value for the option will use a
16798 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
16799 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
16800 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
16801 must be specified.
16802
16803 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
16804 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
16805
16806 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
16807 explicitly
16808 either by file or directory
16809 are added to those given by the system default location.
16810
16811 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
16812 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
16813 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
16814 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
16815 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
16816 use the explicit directory version.
16817
16818 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16819
16820 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
16821 being unset.
16822
16823
16824 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16825 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16826 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16827 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
16828 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
16829 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
16830 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
16831 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
16832
16833 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
16834 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
16835 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
16836 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
16837 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
16838 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
16839 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
16840
16841 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
16842 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
16843 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
16844 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
16845 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
16846 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
16847 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
16848 certificate"&.
16849
16850 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
16851 certificates.
16852
16853
16854 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
16855 .cindex "trusted groups"
16856 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
16857 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16858 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
16859 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
16860 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
16861 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
16862 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
16863 are trusted.
16864
16865 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
16866 .cindex "trusted users"
16867 .cindex "user" "trusted"
16868 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16869 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
16870 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
16871 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
16872 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
16873 Exim user are trusted.
16874
16875 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
16876 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
16877 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
16878 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
16879 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
16880 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
16881 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
16882 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
16883 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
16884 &%-F%& option.
16885
16886 .option unknown_username main string unset
16887 See &%unknown_login%&.
16888
16889 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
16890 .cindex "trusted users"
16891 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
16892 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
16893 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
16894 .cindex "envelope sender"
16895 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
16896 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
16897 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
16898 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
16899 is used) is ignored.
16900
16901 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
16902 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
16903 .code
16904 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
16905 .endd
16906 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
16907 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
16908 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
16909 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
16910 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
16911 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
16912 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
16913 followed by a hyphen
16914 by a setting like this:
16915 .code
16916 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
16917 .endd
16918 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
16919 restriction, you can use
16920 .code
16921 untrusted_set_sender = *
16922 .endd
16923 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
16924 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
16925 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
16926 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
16927 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
16928 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
16929 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
16930 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
16931
16932 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
16933 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
16934 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
16935 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
16936 sender address.
16937
16938
16939 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
16940 .cindex "&""From""& line"
16941 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
16942 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
16943 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
16944 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
16945 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
16946 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
16947 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
16948 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
16949 .code
16950 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
16951 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
16952 .endd
16953 The pattern can be seen by running
16954 .code
16955 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
16956 .endd
16957 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
16958 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
16959 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
16960 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
16961 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
16962 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
16963
16964
16965 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
16966 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
16967
16968
16969 .option warn_message_file main string unset
16970 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
16971 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
16972 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
16973 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
16974 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
16975 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
16976 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
16977
16978
16979 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
16980 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
16981 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
16982 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
16983 .ecindex IIDconfima
16984 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
16985
16986
16987
16988
16989 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16990 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16991
16992 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
16993 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
16994 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
16995 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
16996 Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
16997
16998 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
16999 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
17000 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
17001 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
17002 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
17003
17004
17005
17006 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
17007 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
17008 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
17009 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
17010 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
17011 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
17012 delivery of the address to be deferred.
17013
17014 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17015 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
17016 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
17017 routers, and the eventual transport.
17018
17019 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
17020 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
17021 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
17022 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
17023 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
17024
17025 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
17026 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
17027 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
17028 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
17029 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
17030
17031 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
17032 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
17033 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
17034 .code
17035 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
17036 .endd
17037 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
17038 .code
17039 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
17040 .endd
17041 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
17042 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
17043
17044 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
17045 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17046 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
17047 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
17048 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
17049 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
17050 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
17051
17052
17053
17054 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
17055 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
17056 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
17057 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
17058 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
17059 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
17060 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
17061 routing.
17062
17063
17064
17065 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
17066 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
17067 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
17068 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
17069 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
17070 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
17071 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
17072 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
17073 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
17074 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
17075 you could put:
17076 .code
17077 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
17078 .endd
17079 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
17080 and
17081 .code
17082 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
17083 .endd
17084 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
17085 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
17086 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
17087 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
17088
17089
17090 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
17091 .cindex "case of local parts"
17092 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
17093 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
17094 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
17095 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
17096 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
17097 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
17098 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
17099 more details.
17100
17101 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17102 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
17103 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
17104 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
17105 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
17106 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
17107 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
17108 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
17109 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
17110
17111 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
17112 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
17113 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
17114 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
17115
17116
17117
17118 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
17119 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
17120 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
17121 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
17122 .vindex "&$home$&"
17123 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
17124 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
17125 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
17126 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
17127 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
17128 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
17129 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
17130 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
17131 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
17132 the router is skipped.
17133
17134 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
17135 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
17136 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
17137 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
17138 setting to achieve this. For example:
17139 .code
17140 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
17141 .endd
17142 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
17143 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
17144 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
17145
17146
17147
17148 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
17149 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
17150 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
17151 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
17152 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
17153 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
17154 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
17155 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
17156
17157 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
17158 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
17159
17160 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
17161 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
17162
17163 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
17164 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
17165 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
17166 .code
17167 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17168 .endd
17169 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
17170 .code
17171 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
17172 .endd
17173
17174 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
17175 .code
17176 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17177 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
17178 condition = foobar
17179 .endd
17180
17181 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
17182 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
17183 be specified using &%condition%&.
17184
17185 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
17186 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
17187 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
17188 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17189 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17190 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
17191 Router rules processing behavior.
17192
17193 This is best illustrated in an example:
17194 .code
17195 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
17196 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
17197
17198 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17199 true {yes} {no}}
17200
17201 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17202 {yes} {no}}
17203 .endd
17204 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
17205 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
17206 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
17207 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
17208 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
17209 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
17210 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
17211 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
17212
17213 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
17214 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
17215 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
17216 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
17217 string characters.
17218
17219 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
17220 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
17221 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
17222 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
17223 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
17224
17225
17226 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
17227 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
17228 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
17229 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
17230 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
17231 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
17232 output, and Exim carries on processing.
17233 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
17234 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
17235 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
17236 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
17237 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
17238 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
17239 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
17240
17241
17242
17243 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
17244 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
17245 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
17246 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
17247 transport option of the same name.
17248
17249 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17250 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17251 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17252 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17253 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17254 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17255 the dnssec request bit set.
17256 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17257
17258 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17259 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17260 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17261 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17262 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17263 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17264 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
17265 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
17266 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17267
17268
17269 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
17270 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
17271 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
17272 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
17273 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
17274 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
17275 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
17276 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
17277
17278
17279
17280 .option driver routers string unset
17281 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
17282 to be used.
17283
17284
17285 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
17286 .cindex "DSN" "success"
17287 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
17288 If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
17289 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
17290 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
17291 Not effective on redirect routers.
17292
17293
17294
17295 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
17296 .cindex "envelope sender"
17297 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
17298 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
17299 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
17300 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
17301 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
17302 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
17303 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
17304
17305 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
17306 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
17307 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
17308 setting.
17309
17310 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
17311 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
17312 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
17313 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
17314
17315 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
17316 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
17317 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
17318 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
17319 settings:
17320 .code
17321 errors_to =
17322 errors_to = ""
17323 .endd
17324 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
17325 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
17326 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
17327 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
17328 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
17329
17330 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17331 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
17332 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
17333 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
17334 setting &%return_path%&.
17335
17336 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
17337 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
17338 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
17339
17340
17341
17342 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
17343 .cindex "address" "testing"
17344 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
17345 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
17346 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
17347 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
17348 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
17349 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
17350 on for the system alias file.
17351 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17352 are evaluated.
17353
17354 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
17355 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
17356 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
17357
17358
17359
17360 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
17361 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
17362 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
17363 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
17364
17365
17366
17367 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
17368 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17369 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
17370
17371
17372
17373 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
17374 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17375 verifying a sender, verification fails.
17376
17377
17378
17379 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
17380 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
17381 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
17382 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
17383 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
17384 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
17385 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
17386 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
17387 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
17388
17389 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
17390 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
17391 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
17392 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
17393 transport for further details.
17394
17395
17396 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
17397 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
17398 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17399 .cindex "transport" "local"
17400 .cindex "router" "setting group"
17401 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
17402 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
17403 process.
17404 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
17405 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
17406 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
17407 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
17408 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17409
17410
17411
17412 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
17413 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
17414 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
17415 This option specifies a list of text headers,
17416 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
17417 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17418 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17419 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17420 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
17421 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
17422 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
17423 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
17424 &"see"& the added header lines.
17425
17426 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
17427 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
17428 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
17429 failures are treated as configuration errors.
17430
17431 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
17432 for a router; all listed headers are added.
17433
17434 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17435 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17436
17437 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
17438 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
17439 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17440 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
17441 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
17442 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
17443 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
17444 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
17445 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
17446 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
17447
17448
17449
17450 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
17451 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
17452 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
17453 This option specifies a list of text headers,
17454 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
17455 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17456 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17457 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17458 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
17459 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
17460 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
17461 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
17462 &"see"& the original header lines.
17463
17464 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
17465 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
17466 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
17467 errors.
17468
17469 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
17470 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
17471
17472 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17473 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17474
17475 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17476 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
17477 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
17478 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
17479
17480 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
17481 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
17482 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
17483
17484
17485
17486 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
17487 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
17488 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
17489 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
17490 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
17491 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
17492 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
17493 like
17494 .code
17495 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
17496 .endd
17497 by setting
17498 .code
17499 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
17500 .endd
17501 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
17502 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
17503 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
17504 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
17505 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
17506 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
17507
17508 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
17509 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
17510 .code
17511 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
17512 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
17513 .endd
17514 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
17515 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
17516
17517 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
17518 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
17519 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
17520 domain that is being routed.
17521
17522 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
17523 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
17524 checked.
17525
17526 .option initgroups routers boolean false
17527 .cindex "additional groups"
17528 .cindex "groups" "additional"
17529 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17530 .cindex "transport" "local"
17531 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
17532 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
17533 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
17534 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
17535 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17536
17537
17538
17539 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
17540 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
17541 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
17542 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
17543 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
17544 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
17545 evaluated.
17546
17547 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
17548 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
17549 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
17550 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
17551 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
17552 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
17553 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
17554 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
17555 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
17556
17557 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17558 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
17559 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
17560 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
17561 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
17562 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
17563 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
17564 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
17565 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
17566 the relevant transport.
17567
17568 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
17569 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
17570 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
17571 callout.
17572
17573 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
17574 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
17575 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
17576 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
17577 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
17578 .code
17579 real_localuser:
17580 driver = accept
17581 local_part_prefix = real-
17582 check_local_user
17583 transport = local_delivery
17584 .endd
17585 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
17586 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
17587 .code
17588 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
17589 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
17590 .endd
17591
17592 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
17593 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
17594 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
17595 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
17596
17597
17598 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
17599 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
17600
17601
17602
17603 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
17604 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
17605 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
17606 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
17607 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
17608 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
17609 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
17610 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
17611 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
17612 &%username-foo%&.
17613
17614
17615 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
17616 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
17617
17618
17619
17620 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
17621 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
17622 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
17623 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
17624 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17625 are evaluated, and
17626 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
17627 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
17628 example:
17629 .code
17630 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
17631 .endd
17632 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
17633 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
17634 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
17635 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
17636 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
17637 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
17638 each virtual domain:
17639 .code
17640 postmaster:
17641 driver = redirect
17642 local_parts = postmaster
17643 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
17644 .endd
17645
17646
17647 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
17648 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
17649 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
17650 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
17651 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
17652 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
17653 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
17654 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
17655 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
17656 redirect addresses.
17657
17658
17659
17660 .option more routers boolean&!! true
17661 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
17662 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
17663 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
17664 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
17665 delivery to be deferred.
17666
17667 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
17668 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
17669 .oindex "&%self%&"
17670 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
17671 means of the setting
17672 .code
17673 self = pass
17674 .endd
17675 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
17676 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
17677 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
17678
17679 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
17680 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
17681 controls what happens next.
17682
17683
17684 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
17685 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
17686 .cindex "router" "timeout"
17687 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
17688 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
17689 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
17690 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
17691 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
17692
17693 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
17694 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
17695 applies to all of them.
17696
17697
17698
17699 .option pass_router routers string unset
17700 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
17701 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
17702 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
17703 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
17704 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
17705 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
17706 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
17707 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
17708 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
17709 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
17710
17711
17712
17713 .option redirect_router routers string unset
17714 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
17715 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
17716 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
17717 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
17718 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
17719
17720 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
17721 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
17722 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
17723 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
17724
17725
17726
17727 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
17728 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
17729 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
17730 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
17731 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
17732 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
17733 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
17734
17735 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
17736 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
17737 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
17738 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
17739
17740 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
17741 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
17742 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
17743 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
17744 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
17745
17746 .cindex "NFS"
17747 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
17748 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
17749 unavailable.
17750
17751 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
17752 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
17753 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
17754 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
17755 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
17756 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
17757 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
17758 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
17759
17760 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
17761 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
17762 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
17763 operates as follows:
17764
17765 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
17766 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
17767 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
17768 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
17769 used. For example:
17770 .code
17771 require_files = mail:/some/file
17772 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
17773 .endd
17774 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
17775 &%require_files%& condition fails.
17776
17777 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
17778 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
17779 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
17780 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
17781
17782 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
17783 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
17784 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
17785 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
17786 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
17787
17788 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
17789 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
17790 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
17791 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
17792 check again in that process.
17793
17794 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
17795 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
17796 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
17797 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
17798 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
17799 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
17800 as if the file did not exist. For example:
17801 .code
17802 require_files = +/some/file
17803 .endd
17804 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
17805 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
17806 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
17807
17808
17809
17810 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
17811 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
17812 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
17813 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
17814 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
17815 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
17816 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
17817 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
17818 latter kind.
17819
17820 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
17821 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
17822 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
17823 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
17824 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
17825 same name.
17826
17827 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
17828 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
17829 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
17830
17831
17832
17833 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
17834 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
17835 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
17836 .vindex "&$home$&"
17837 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
17838 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
17839 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
17840 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
17841 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
17842 cause the router to defer.
17843
17844 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
17845 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
17846 place.
17847 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17848 are evaluated.)
17849 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
17850 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
17851
17852 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
17853 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
17854 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
17855 of these values that is set:
17856
17857 .ilist
17858 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
17859 .next
17860 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
17861 .next
17862 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
17863 .next
17864 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
17865 .endlist
17866
17867 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
17868 router, but not for the transport.
17869
17870
17871
17872 .option self routers string freeze
17873 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
17874 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
17875 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
17876 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
17877 and &(manualroute)& routers.
17878 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
17879 of remote hosts.
17880 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
17881 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
17882 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
17883 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
17884 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
17885
17886 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
17887 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
17888 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
17889 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
17890 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
17891 cases:
17892
17893 .vlist
17894 .vitem &%defer%&
17895 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
17896
17897 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
17898 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
17899 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
17900 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
17901
17902 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
17903 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
17904 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
17905 rewritten.
17906
17907 .vitem &%pass%&
17908 .oindex "&%more%&"
17909 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
17910 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
17911 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
17912 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
17913 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
17914 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
17915 combination
17916 .code
17917 self = pass
17918 no_more
17919 .endd
17920 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
17921 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
17922 be passed to the next router.
17923
17924 .vitem &%fail%&
17925 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
17926
17927 .vitem &%send%&
17928 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
17929 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
17930 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
17931 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
17932 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
17933 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
17934 .endlist
17935
17936
17937
17938 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
17939 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
17940 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
17941 address matches something on the list.
17942 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17943 are evaluated.
17944
17945 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
17946 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
17947 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
17948 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
17949 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
17950 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
17951 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
17952 matters.
17953
17954
17955 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
17956 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
17957 .cindex "packet radio"
17958 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
17959 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
17960 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
17961 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
17962 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
17963 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
17964 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
17965 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
17966
17967 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
17968 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
17969 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
17970 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
17971 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
17972 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
17973 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
17974 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
17975 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
17976 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
17977 .code
17978 translate_ip_address = \
17979 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
17980 {$value}fail}}
17981 .endd
17982 The file would contain lines like
17983 .code
17984 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
17985 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
17986 .endd
17987 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
17988 are doing.
17989
17990
17991
17992 .option transport routers string&!! unset
17993 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
17994 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
17995 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
17996 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
17997 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
17998 delivery is deferred.
17999
18000 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
18001 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
18002 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
18003
18004
18005
18006 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
18007 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
18008 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
18009 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
18010 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
18011 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
18012 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
18013 overridden by a setting on the transport.
18014 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18015 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18016 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
18017 environment.
18018
18019
18020
18021
18022 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
18023 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
18024 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
18025 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
18026 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
18027 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
18028 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
18029 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
18030 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18031 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18032
18033 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
18034 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
18035 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
18036 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
18037 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
18038
18039 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
18040 environment.
18041
18042
18043
18044
18045 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
18046 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
18047 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18048 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18049 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18050 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
18051 delivery to be deferred.
18052
18053 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
18054 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
18055 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
18056 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
18057 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
18058 sometimes true and sometimes false).
18059
18060 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
18061 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
18062 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
18063 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
18064 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
18065 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
18066 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
18067 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
18068
18069 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
18070 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
18071 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
18072 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
18073 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
18074 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
18075 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
18076 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
18077 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
18078 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18079
18080 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
18081 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
18082 subsequent routers.
18083
18084
18085 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
18086 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
18087 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18088 .cindex "transport" "local"
18089 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
18090 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
18091 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18092 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
18093 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18094 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18095 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
18096 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
18097 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
18098 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
18099 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
18100 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18101
18102
18103
18104 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
18105 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
18106 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18107
18108
18109 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
18110 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
18111 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
18112 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
18113 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
18114 delivering in cutthrough mode or
18115 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
18116 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
18117 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
18118 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
18119
18120 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
18121 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
18122 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
18123 user or group.
18124
18125
18126 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
18127 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
18128 addresses,
18129 delivering in cutthrough mode
18130 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
18131 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18132 are evaluated.
18133 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18134
18135
18136 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
18137 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
18138 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
18139 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18140 are evaluated.
18141 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18142 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
18143 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
18144
18145
18146
18147
18148
18149
18150 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18151 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18152
18153 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
18154 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
18155 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
18156 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
18157 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
18158 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
18159 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
18160 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
18161 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
18162 .code
18163 localusers:
18164 driver = accept
18165 domains = mydomain.example
18166 check_local_user
18167 transport = local_delivery
18168 .endd
18169 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
18170 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
18171 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
18172 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
18173
18174
18175
18176
18177
18178
18179 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18180 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18181
18182 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
18183 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
18184 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
18185 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
18186 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
18187 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
18188
18189 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
18190 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
18191 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
18192 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
18193 records.
18194
18195 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
18196 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
18197 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
18198 except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
18199 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18200 generic option, the router declines.
18201
18202 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
18203 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
18204 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
18205
18206 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18207 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18208 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
18209 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
18210 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
18211 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
18212
18213
18214 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
18215 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
18216 Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
18217 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
18218 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
18219 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
18220
18221 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
18222 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
18223 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
18224 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
18225 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
18226 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
18227 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
18228 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
18229 case routing fails.
18230
18231
18232 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
18233 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
18234 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
18235 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
18236 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
18237
18238 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
18239 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
18240
18241 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
18242 .ilist
18243 The domain does not exist in DNS
18244 .next
18245 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
18246 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
18247 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
18248 .next
18249 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
18250 .next
18251 MX record points to a non-existent host.
18252 .next
18253 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
18254 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
18255 .next
18256 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
18257 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
18258 .next
18259 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
18260 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
18261 .next
18262 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
18263 not be found in the MX records (see below)
18264 .endlist
18265
18266
18267
18268
18269 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
18270 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
18271 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
18272
18273 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
18274 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
18275 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
18276 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
18277 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
18278 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
18279 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18280
18281
18282 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
18283 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
18284 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
18285 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
18286 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
18287 required. For example,
18288 .code
18289 check_srv = smtp
18290 .endd
18291 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
18292 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
18293 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
18294 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
18295 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
18296 normal way.
18297
18298 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
18299 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
18300 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
18301 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
18302 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
18303 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
18304
18305 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
18306 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
18307 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
18308 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
18309 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
18310 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
18311 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
18312 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
18313
18314 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
18315 when there is a DNS lookup error.
18316
18317
18318
18319
18320 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18321 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
18322 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
18323 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
18324 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
18325 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
18326 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
18327 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
18328 also being queued.
18329
18330
18331 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18332 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
18333 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
18334 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
18335 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
18336 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
18337 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
18338 setting:
18339 .code
18340 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
18341 .endd
18342 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
18343 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
18344 the address record.
18345
18346
18347 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18348 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18349 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
18350 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18351
18352
18353
18354
18355 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
18356 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18357 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
18358 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
18359 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
18360 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
18361 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
18362 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
18363 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
18364 &'resolv.conf'&.
18365
18366
18367
18368 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
18369 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
18370 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
18371 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
18372 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
18373 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
18374 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
18375 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
18376 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
18377 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
18378 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
18379
18380 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
18381 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
18382 sense.
18383
18384 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
18385 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
18386 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
18387 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
18388 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
18389 header rewriting.
18390
18391
18392 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
18393 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
18394 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
18395 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
18396 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18397 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18398 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18399 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18400
18401 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18402 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
18403 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18404 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
18405 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
18406 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
18407 without processing them independently,
18408 provided the following conditions are met:
18409
18410 .ilist
18411 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
18412 &%headers_remove%&.
18413 .next
18414 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
18415 the domain.
18416 .endlist
18417
18418
18419
18420
18421 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
18422 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18423 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
18424 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
18425 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
18426 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
18427 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
18428 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
18429 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
18430 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
18431
18432 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
18433 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
18434 local wildcard.
18435
18436
18437
18438 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18439 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18440 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
18441 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18442
18443
18444
18445
18446 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
18447 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
18448 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
18449 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
18450 if
18451 .code
18452 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
18453 .endd
18454 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
18455 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
18456 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
18457 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
18458 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
18459 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
18460
18461
18462 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
18463 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
18464 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
18465 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
18466 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
18467
18468 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
18469 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
18470 such as that implied by
18471 .code
18472 domains = @mx_any
18473 .endd
18474 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
18475 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
18476 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
18477 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
18478
18479
18480
18481
18482
18483
18484
18485
18486
18487 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18488 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18489
18490 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
18491 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
18492 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
18493 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
18494 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
18495 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
18496 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
18497 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
18498 router handles the address
18499 .code
18500 root@[192.168.1.1]
18501 .endd
18502 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
18503 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
18504 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
18505 .code
18506 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
18507 .endd
18508 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
18509 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
18510
18511 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
18512 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
18513 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
18514 &%self%& option determines what happens.
18515
18516 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
18517 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
18518 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
18519 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
18520
18521
18522
18523 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18524 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18525
18526 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
18527 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
18528 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
18529 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
18530 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
18531 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
18532 must set
18533 .code
18534 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
18535 .endd
18536 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
18537
18538 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
18539 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
18540 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
18541 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
18542 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
18543 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
18544 must not be specified for it.
18545
18546 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
18547 .option hosts iplookup string unset
18548 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
18549 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
18550 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
18551 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
18552 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
18553
18554
18555 .option optional iplookup boolean false
18556 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
18557 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
18558 delivery to the address is deferred.
18559
18560
18561 .option port iplookup integer 0
18562 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
18563 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
18564 call.
18565
18566
18567 .option protocol iplookup string udp
18568 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
18569 protocols is to be used.
18570
18571
18572 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
18573 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
18574 default value is:
18575 .code
18576 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
18577 .endd
18578 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
18579 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
18580
18581
18582 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
18583 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
18584 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
18585 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
18586 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
18587 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
18588 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
18589 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
18590
18591
18592 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
18593 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
18594 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
18595 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
18596 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
18597 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
18598 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
18599 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
18600 following could be used:
18601 .code
18602 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
18603 reroute = $local_part@$1
18604 .endd
18605
18606 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
18607 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
18608 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
18609 call. It does not apply to UDP.
18610
18611
18612
18613
18614 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18615 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18616
18617 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
18618 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
18619 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
18620 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
18621 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
18622 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
18623 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
18624 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
18625 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
18626 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
18627
18628 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
18629 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
18630 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
18631 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
18632 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
18633 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
18634 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
18635
18636 .vindex "&$host$&"
18637 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
18638 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
18639 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
18640 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
18641 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
18642 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
18643 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
18644 text string.
18645
18646 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
18647 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
18648 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
18649 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
18650 below, following the list of private options.
18651
18652
18653 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
18654
18655 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
18656 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
18657
18658 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
18659 See &%host_find_failed%&.
18660
18661 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
18662 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
18663 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
18664 of the following values:
18665 .code
18666 decline
18667 defer
18668 fail
18669 freeze
18670 ignore
18671 pass
18672 .endd
18673 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
18674 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
18675 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
18676 &%pass_router%&),
18677 .oindex "&%more%&"
18678 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
18679 router only if &%more%& is true.
18680
18681 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
18682 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
18683 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
18684 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
18685
18686 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
18687 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
18688 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
18689
18690
18691 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
18692 .cindex "randomized host list"
18693 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
18694 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
18695 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
18696 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
18697 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
18698 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
18699 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
18700 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
18701
18702 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
18703 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
18704 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
18705 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
18706 .code
18707 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
18708 .endd
18709 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
18710 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
18711 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
18712 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
18713 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
18714
18715
18716 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
18717 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
18718 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
18719 example:
18720 .code
18721 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
18722 .endd
18723 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
18724 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
18725 deferred.
18726
18727
18728 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
18729 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
18730 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
18731 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
18732
18733
18734 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
18735 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
18736 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
18737 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
18738 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18739 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18740 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18741 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18742
18743 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18744 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
18745 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18746 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
18747 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
18748 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
18749 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
18750 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
18751
18752
18753
18754
18755 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
18756 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
18757 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
18758 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
18759 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18760 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
18761 .display
18762 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
18763 .endd
18764 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
18765 no options:
18766 .code
18767 route_list = \
18768 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
18769 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18770 .endd
18771 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
18772 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
18773 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
18774 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
18775 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
18776 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
18777 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
18778 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
18779 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
18780 in a &%route_list%&).
18781
18782 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
18783 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
18784 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
18785 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
18786
18787
18788
18789 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
18790 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
18791 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
18792 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
18793 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
18794 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
18795 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
18796 like this:
18797 .code
18798 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
18799 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18800 .endd
18801 This data can be accessed by setting
18802 .code
18803 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
18804 .endd
18805 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
18806 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
18807 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
18808 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
18809 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
18810
18811
18812
18813
18814 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
18815 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
18816 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
18817 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
18818 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
18819 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
18820 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18821
18822 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
18823 variables are set during its expansion:
18824
18825 .ilist
18826 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
18827 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
18828 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
18829 .code
18830 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
18831 .endd
18832 .next
18833 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
18834 .next
18835 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
18836
18837 .next
18838 .vindex "&$value$&"
18839 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
18840 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
18841 .code
18842 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
18843 .endd
18844 .endlist
18845
18846 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
18847 semicolon is the default route list separator.
18848
18849
18850
18851 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
18852 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
18853 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
18854 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
18855 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
18856 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
18857
18858 .ilist
18859 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
18860 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
18861 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
18862 .code
18863 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
18864 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
18865 .endd
18866 .next
18867 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
18868 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
18869 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
18870 number follows. For example:
18871 .code
18872 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
18873 .endd
18874 .endlist
18875
18876 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
18877 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
18878 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
18879 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
18880 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
18881 transport.
18882
18883 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
18884 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
18885 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
18886 records in the DNS. For example:
18887 .code
18888 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
18889 .endd
18890 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
18891 example:
18892 .code
18893 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
18894 .endd
18895 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
18896 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
18897 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
18898 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
18899 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
18900 happens is controlled by the
18901 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
18902 &%self%& option of the router.
18903
18904 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
18905 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
18906 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
18907 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
18908 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
18909 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
18910 defined by MX preferences.
18911
18912 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
18913 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
18914 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
18915
18916 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
18917 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
18918 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
18919 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
18920
18921 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
18922 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
18923 router.
18924
18925 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
18926 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
18927 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
18928
18929 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
18930 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
18931
18932
18933
18934 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
18935 The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
18936 present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
18937 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
18938 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
18939 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
18940 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
18941
18942 .ilist
18943 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
18944 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18945 .next
18946 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
18947 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18948 .next
18949 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
18950 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
18951 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
18952 .next
18953 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
18954 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
18955 timeout), delivery is deferred.
18956 .endlist
18957
18958 For example:
18959 .code
18960 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
18961 domain2 host4:host5
18962 .endd
18963 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
18964 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
18965 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
18966 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
18967 call.
18968
18969 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
18970 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
18971 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
18972 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
18973 function called.
18974
18975
18976
18977 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
18978 &%host_find_failed%& option.
18979
18980 .vindex "&$host$&"
18981 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
18982 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
18983
18984
18985
18986 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
18987 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
18988 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
18989
18990 .ilist
18991 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
18992 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
18993 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
18994 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
18995 .code
18996 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
18997 .endd
18998 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
18999 your first router something like this:
19000 .code
19001 smart_route:
19002 driver = manualroute
19003 domains = !+local_domains
19004 transport = remote_smtp
19005 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
19006 .endd
19007 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
19008 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
19009 they are tried in order
19010 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
19011 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
19012 .code
19013 smart_route:
19014 driver = manualroute
19015 transport = remote_smtp
19016 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
19017 .endd
19018 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
19019 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
19020 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
19021 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
19022 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
19023 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
19024 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
19025 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
19026
19027 .next
19028 .cindex "mail hub example"
19029 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
19030 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
19031 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
19032 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
19033 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
19034 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
19035 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
19036 lookup is easier to manage.
19037
19038 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
19039 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
19040 example:
19041 .code
19042 hub_route:
19043 driver = manualroute
19044 transport = remote_smtp
19045 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
19046 .endd
19047 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
19048 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
19049 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
19050 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
19051 domain can be used to find the host:
19052 .code
19053 through_firewall:
19054 driver = manualroute
19055 transport = remote_smtp
19056 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
19057 .endd
19058 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
19059 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
19060 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
19061 next router.
19062
19063 .next
19064 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
19065 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
19066 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
19067 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
19068 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
19069 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
19070 .code
19071 save_in_file:
19072 driver = manualroute
19073 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
19074 route_list = saved.domain.example
19075 .endd
19076 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
19077 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
19078 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
19079 .code
19080 save_in_file:
19081 driver = manualroute
19082 route_list = \
19083 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
19084 *.saved.domain2.example \
19085 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
19086 batch_pipe
19087 .endd
19088 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19089 .vindex "&$host$&"
19090 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
19091 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
19092 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
19093 the address if the lookup fails.
19094
19095 .next
19096 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
19097 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
19098 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
19099 one way it can be done:
19100 .code
19101 # Transport
19102 uucp:
19103 driver = pipe
19104 user = nobody
19105 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
19106 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
19107 return_fail_output = true
19108
19109 # Router
19110 uucphost:
19111 transport = uucp
19112 driver = manualroute
19113 route_data = \
19114 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
19115 .endd
19116 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
19117 .code
19118 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
19119 .endd
19120 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
19121 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
19122 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
19123 .endlist
19124 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
19125 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
19126
19127
19128
19129
19130
19131
19132
19133
19134 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19135 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19136
19137 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
19138 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
19139 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
19140 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
19141 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
19142 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
19143 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
19144 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
19145 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
19146 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
19147 options:
19148 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
19149
19150 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
19151 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
19152 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
19153 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
19154 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
19155
19156
19157 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
19158 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
19159 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
19160 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
19161 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
19162 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
19163
19164
19165 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
19166 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
19167 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
19168 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
19169 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
19170 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
19171 not set, a value for the gid also.
19172
19173 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
19174 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
19175 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
19176 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
19177 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
19178 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
19179 gid.
19180
19181
19182 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
19183 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
19184 before running the command.
19185
19186
19187 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
19188 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
19189 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
19190 timeout.
19191
19192
19193 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
19194 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
19195 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
19196 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
19197 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
19198
19199 .ilist
19200 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
19201 below).
19202 .next
19203 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
19204 &%no_more%& is set.
19205 .next
19206 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
19207 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
19208 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
19209 included in the SMTP response.
19210 .next
19211 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
19212 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
19213 included in any SMTP response.
19214 .next
19215 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
19216 .next
19217 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
19218 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
19219 .next
19220 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
19221 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
19222 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
19223 .endlist
19224
19225 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
19226 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
19227 the page):
19228 .code
19229 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
19230 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
19231 .endd
19232 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
19233 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
19234 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
19235 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
19236
19237 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
19238 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
19239 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
19240 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
19241 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
19242
19243 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
19244 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
19245 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
19246 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
19247 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
19248
19249 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19250 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
19251 variable. For example, this return line
19252 .code
19253 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
19254 .endd
19255 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
19256 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
19257 .ecindex IIDquerou1
19258 .ecindex IIDquerou2
19259
19260
19261
19262
19263 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19264 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19265
19266 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
19267 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
19268 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
19269 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
19270 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
19271 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
19272 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
19273 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
19274 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
19275 redirected in several different ways:
19276
19277 .ilist
19278 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
19279 independently.
19280 .next
19281 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
19282 .next
19283 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
19284 .next
19285 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
19286 .next
19287 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
19288 .next
19289 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
19290 .next
19291 It can be discarded.
19292 .endlist
19293
19294 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
19295 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
19296 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
19297 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
19298
19299 If success DSNs have been requested
19300 .cindex "DSN" "success"
19301 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
19302 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
19303
19304
19305
19306 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
19307 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
19308 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
19309 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
19310 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
19311 aliases, in a configuration like this:
19312 .code
19313 system_aliases:
19314 driver = redirect
19315 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
19316 .endd
19317 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
19318 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
19319 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
19320 cause delivery to be deferred.
19321
19322 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
19323 &_.forward_& files, like this:
19324 .code
19325 userforward:
19326 driver = redirect
19327 check_local_user
19328 file = $home/.forward
19329 no_verify
19330 .endd
19331 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
19332 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
19333 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
19334 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
19335 comments.
19336
19337
19338
19339 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
19340 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
19341 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
19342 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
19343
19344 .ilist
19345 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
19346 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
19347 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
19348 practice the router may not be able to operate.
19349 .next
19350 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
19351 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
19352 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
19353 saves some resources.
19354 .endlist
19355
19356
19357
19358
19359
19360
19361 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
19362 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19363 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19364 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
19365 can be interpreted in two different ways:
19366
19367 .ilist
19368 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
19369 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
19370 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
19371 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
19372 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
19373 document is intended for use by end users.
19374 .next
19375 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
19376 described in the next section.
19377 .endlist
19378
19379 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
19380 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
19381 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
19382 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
19383 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
19384
19385
19386
19387 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
19388 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
19389 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
19390 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
19391 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
19392 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
19393 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
19394 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
19395 commas or newlines.
19396 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
19397 quotes.
19398
19399 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
19400 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
19401 next newline character is ignored.
19402
19403 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
19404 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
19405 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
19406 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
19407 removed.
19408
19409 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19410 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
19411 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
19412 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
19413 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
19414 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
19415 setting:
19416 .code
19417 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
19418 .endd
19419
19420
19421 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
19422 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
19423 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
19424 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
19425 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
19426 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
19427 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
19428 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
19429 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
19430 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
19431 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
19432
19433 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
19434 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
19435 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
19436 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
19437 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
19438 .code
19439 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
19440 .endd
19441 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
19442 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
19443 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
19444 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
19445 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
19446 synonymously.
19447
19448 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
19449 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
19450 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
19451 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
19452 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
19453
19454 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
19455 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
19456 contains:
19457 .code
19458 Sam.Reman: spqr
19459 .endd
19460 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
19461 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
19462 this forward file:
19463 .code
19464 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19465 .endd
19466 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
19467 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
19468 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
19469 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
19470 should really contain
19471 .code
19472 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19473 .endd
19474 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
19475 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
19476 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
19477
19478
19479
19480 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
19481 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
19482 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
19483
19484 .ilist
19485 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
19486 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
19487 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
19488 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
19489 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
19490 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
19491 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
19492
19493 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
19494 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
19495 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
19496 in double quotes, for example:
19497 .code
19498 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
19499 .endd
19500 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
19501 quote just the command. An item such as
19502 .code
19503 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
19504 .endd
19505 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
19506
19507 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
19508 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
19509 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
19510 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
19511 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
19512 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
19513 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
19514 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
19515 an &%accept%& router.
19516
19517 .next
19518 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
19519 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
19520 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
19521 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
19522 .code
19523 /home/world/minbari
19524 .endd
19525 is treated as a file name, but
19526 .code
19527 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
19528 .endd
19529 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
19530 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
19531 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
19532 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
19533
19534 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
19535 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
19536
19537 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
19538 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
19539 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
19540 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
19541
19542 .next
19543 .cindex "included address list"
19544 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
19545 If an item is of the form
19546 .code
19547 :include:<path name>
19548 .endd
19549 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
19550 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
19551 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
19552 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
19553 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
19554 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
19555 .code
19556 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
19557 .endd
19558 It must be given as
19559 .code
19560 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
19561 .endd
19562 .next
19563 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
19564 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
19565 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
19566 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
19567 .cindex "black hole"
19568 .cindex "abandoning mail"
19569 &':blackhole:'& can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
19570 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
19571 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
19572
19573 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
19574 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
19575 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
19576 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
19577 &_/dev/null_&.
19578
19579 .next
19580 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
19581 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
19582 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
19583 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
19584 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
19585 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
19586 redirection items of the form
19587 .code
19588 :defer:
19589 :fail:
19590 .endd
19591 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
19592 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
19593 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
19594 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
19595 .code
19596 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
19597 .endd
19598 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
19599 of a
19600 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
19601 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
19602 default.
19603 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
19604 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
19605 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
19606
19607 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
19608 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
19609 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
19610 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
19611 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
19612 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
19613 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
19614 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
19615 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
19616 ignored.
19617
19618 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
19619 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
19620 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
19621 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
19622
19623 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
19624 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
19625 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
19626 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
19627 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
19628
19629 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
19630 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
19631 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
19632 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
19633 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
19634 rules still apply.
19635
19636 .next
19637 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
19638 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
19639 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
19640 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
19641 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
19642 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
19643 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
19644 .endlist
19645
19646
19647 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
19648 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
19649 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
19650 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
19651 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
19652 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
19653 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
19654 aliasing scheme of the type
19655 .code
19656 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
19657 localpart1: pipe
19658 localpart2: pipe
19659 .endd
19660 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
19661 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
19662 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
19663 such as
19664 .code
19665 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
19666 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
19667 .endd
19668 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
19669 the pipes are distinct.
19670
19671
19672
19673 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
19674 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
19675 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
19676 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
19677 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
19678 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
19679 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
19680 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
19681 can be used to avoid this.
19682
19683
19684 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
19685 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
19686 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
19687 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
19688 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
19689 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
19690 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
19691
19692
19693
19694 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
19695
19696 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
19697 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
19698
19699
19700 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
19701 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
19702 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
19703
19704
19705 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
19706 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
19707 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
19708 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
19709
19710
19711 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
19712 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
19713 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
19714 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
19715 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
19716 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
19717 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
19718
19719 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
19720 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
19721
19722
19723 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
19724 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
19725 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
19726 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
19727 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
19728
19729
19730
19731 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
19732 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
19733 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
19734 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
19735 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
19736 let ordinary users do.
19737
19738
19739
19740 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
19741 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
19742 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
19743 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
19744 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
19745 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
19746
19747 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
19748 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
19749 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
19750 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
19751 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
19752 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
19753 .code
19754 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
19755 .endd
19756 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
19757 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
19758 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
19759 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
19760 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
19761 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
19762 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
19763 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
19764
19765
19766 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
19767 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
19768 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
19769 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
19770 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
19771 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
19772 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
19773 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
19774
19775
19776
19777 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
19778 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
19779 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
19780 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
19781 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
19782 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
19783
19784
19785 .option data redirect string&!! unset
19786 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
19787 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
19788 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
19789 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
19790 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
19791
19792 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
19793 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
19794 terminated with newline characters. For example:
19795 .code
19796 data = #Exim filter\n\
19797 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
19798 .endd
19799 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
19800 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
19801 choice into a newline.
19802
19803
19804 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
19805 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
19806 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
19807 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
19808 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
19809
19810
19811 .option file redirect string&!! unset
19812 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
19813 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
19814 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
19815 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
19816 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
19817 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
19818 entirely of comments), the router declines.
19819
19820 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
19821 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
19822 runs a check on the containing directory,
19823 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
19824 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
19825 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
19826 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
19827 not, the router declines.
19828
19829
19830 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
19831 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
19832 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
19833 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
19834 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
19835 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
19836 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
19837
19838
19839 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
19840 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
19841 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
19842 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
19843 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
19844
19845
19846 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
19847 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
19848 redirection list.
19849
19850
19851 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
19852 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
19853 &%allow_filter%& is true.
19854
19855
19856
19857
19858 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
19859 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
19860 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
19861 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
19862 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
19863 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
19864 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
19865 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
19866 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
19867
19868
19869 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
19870 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
19871 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
19872 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
19873 functions.
19874
19875 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
19876 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
19877 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
19878 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
19879
19880 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
19881 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
19882 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
19883 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
19884 &_.forward_& files).
19885
19886
19887 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
19888 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19889 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
19890
19891
19892 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
19893 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
19894 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
19895 of the embedded Perl support.
19896
19897
19898 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
19899 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19900 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
19901
19902
19903 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
19904 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19905 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
19906
19907
19908 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
19909 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
19910 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
19911 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
19912 &%one_time%& is set.
19913
19914
19915 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
19916 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19917 to make use of &%run%& items.
19918
19919
19920 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
19921 If this option is true, items of the form
19922 .code
19923 :include:<path name>
19924 .endd
19925 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
19926
19927
19928 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
19929 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
19930 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
19931 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
19932 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
19933
19934
19935 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
19936 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
19937 &%allow_filter%& is true.
19938
19939
19940 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
19941 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
19942 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
19943 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
19944 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
19945
19946
19947
19948
19949 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
19950 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
19951 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
19952 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
19953 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
19954 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
19955 bounce may well quote the generated address.
19956
19957
19958 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
19959 .cindex "EACCES"
19960 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19961 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
19962 file did not exist.
19963
19964
19965 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
19966 .cindex "ENOTDIR"
19967 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19968 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
19969 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
19970
19971 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
19972 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
19973 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
19974 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
19975 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
19976 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
19977 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
19978 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
19979
19980
19981
19982 .option include_directory redirect string unset
19983 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
19984 redirection list must start with this directory.
19985
19986
19987 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
19988 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
19989 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
19990
19991
19992 .option one_time redirect boolean false
19993 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
19994 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
19995 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
19996 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
19997 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
19998 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
19999 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
20000 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
20001 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
20002 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
20003 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
20004 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
20005 before they subscribed.
20006
20007 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
20008 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
20009 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
20010 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
20011 attempt.
20012
20013 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
20014 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
20015 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
20016 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
20017
20018 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
20019 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
20020 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
20021
20022 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
20023 &%one_time%&.
20024
20025 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
20026 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
20027 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
20028 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
20029 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
20030 expansion.
20031
20032
20033 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
20034 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
20035 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
20036 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
20037 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
20038 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
20039 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
20040 See &%check_owner%& above.
20041
20042
20043 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
20044 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
20045 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
20046 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
20047
20048
20049 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
20050 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
20051 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
20052 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
20053 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
20054 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
20055 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
20056
20057
20058 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
20059 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
20060 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
20061 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
20062 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
20063 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
20064 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
20065 &$qualify_recipient$&.
20066
20067 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
20068 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
20069 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
20070 addresses.
20071
20072 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
20073 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
20074 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
20075 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
20076 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
20077 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
20078 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
20079 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
20080 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
20081 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
20082
20083
20084 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
20085 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
20086 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
20087 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
20088 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
20089 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
20090
20091
20092 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
20093 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
20094 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
20095 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
20096 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
20097 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
20098
20099
20100 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
20101 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
20102 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
20103 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
20104 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
20105
20106
20107 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
20108 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
20109 :subaddress part of an address.
20110
20111 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
20112 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
20113 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
20114 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
20115
20116
20117 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
20118 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
20119 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
20120 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
20121 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
20122 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
20123 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
20124
20125
20126
20127 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
20128 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
20129 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
20130 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
20131 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
20132 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
20133 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
20134 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
20135 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
20136 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
20137 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
20138 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
20139 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
20140 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
20141 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
20142 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
20143
20144 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
20145 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
20146 the following routers.
20147
20148 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
20149 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
20150 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
20151 so it is passed to the following routers.
20152
20153 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
20154 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
20155 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
20156 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
20157
20158 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
20159 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
20160 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
20161 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
20162 .code
20163 userforward:
20164 driver = redirect
20165 allow_filter
20166 check_local_user
20167 file = $home/.forward
20168 file_transport = address_file
20169 pipe_transport = address_pipe
20170 reply_transport = address_reply
20171 no_verify
20172 skip_syntax_errors
20173 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
20174 syntax_errors_text = \
20175 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
20176 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
20177 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
20178 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
20179 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
20180 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
20181 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
20182 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
20183 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
20184 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
20185 .endd
20186 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
20187 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
20188 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
20189 .code
20190 real_localuser:
20191 driver = accept
20192 check_local_user
20193 local_part_prefix = real-
20194 transport = local_delivery
20195 .endd
20196 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
20197 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
20198 .code
20199 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
20200 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
20201 .endd
20202
20203
20204 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
20205 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20206
20207
20208 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
20209 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20210 .ecindex IIDredrou1
20211 .ecindex IIDredrou2
20212
20213
20214
20215
20216
20217
20218 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20219 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20220
20221 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
20222 "Environment for local transports"
20223 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
20224 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment for local transports"
20225 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
20226 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
20227 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
20228 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
20229 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
20230
20231 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
20232 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
20233 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
20234 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
20235
20236 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
20237 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
20238 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
20239 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
20240 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
20241
20242
20243
20244 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
20245 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
20246 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
20247 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
20248 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
20249 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
20250 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
20251 time.
20252
20253 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
20254 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
20255 .code
20256 my_transport:
20257 driver = pipe
20258 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
20259 .endd
20260 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
20261 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
20262 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
20263 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
20264
20265
20266
20267
20268 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
20269 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
20270 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
20271 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
20272 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
20273 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
20274 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
20275 group (set by the transport). For example:
20276 .code
20277 # Routers ...
20278 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
20279 local_users:
20280 driver = accept
20281 check_local_user
20282 transport = group_delivery
20283
20284 # Transports ...
20285 # This transport overrides the group
20286 group_delivery:
20287 driver = appendfile
20288 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
20289 group = mail
20290 .endd
20291 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
20292 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
20293 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
20294 set.
20295
20296 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
20297 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
20298 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
20299 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
20300 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
20301 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
20302
20303 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
20304 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
20305 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
20306 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
20307 original gid is also used.
20308
20309 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
20310 following that is set is used:
20311
20312 .ilist
20313 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
20314 .next
20315 A &%group%& setting of the router;
20316 .next
20317 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
20318 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
20319 .next
20320 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
20321 .next
20322 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
20323 the uid is the creator's uid;
20324 .next
20325 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
20326 .endlist
20327
20328 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
20329 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
20330 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
20331 The first of the following that is set is used:
20332
20333 .ilist
20334 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
20335 .next
20336 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
20337 .next
20338 A &%user%& setting of the router;
20339 .next
20340 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
20341 .next
20342 The Exim uid.
20343 .endlist
20344
20345 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
20346 &%never_users%& list.
20347
20348
20349
20350
20351
20352 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
20353 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
20354 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
20355 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
20356 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
20357 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
20358 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
20359 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
20360 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
20361 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20362
20363 .ilist
20364 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
20365 .next
20366 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
20367 .next
20368 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
20369 .next
20370 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
20371 .endlist
20372
20373 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20374
20375 .ilist
20376 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
20377 .next
20378 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
20379 .endlist
20380
20381
20382 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
20383 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
20384 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
20385
20386
20387
20388 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
20389 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20390 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20391 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
20392 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
20393 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
20394 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
20395 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
20396 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
20397 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
20398 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
20399 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
20400 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
20401 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
20402
20403
20404
20405
20406
20407
20408
20409 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20410 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20411
20412 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
20413 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
20414 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
20415 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
20416 The following generic options apply to all transports:
20417
20418
20419 .option body_only transports boolean false
20420 .cindex "transport" "body only"
20421 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
20422 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
20423 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
20424 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
20425 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
20426 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
20427 automatically suppress them.
20428
20429
20430 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
20431 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
20432 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
20433 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
20434 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
20435 logged, and delivery is deferred.
20436
20437
20438 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
20439 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
20440 deliveries by the transport or for any
20441 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
20442 what you are doing.
20443
20444
20445 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
20446 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
20447 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
20448 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
20449 transport is run.
20450 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
20451 output, and Exim carries on processing.
20452 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
20453 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
20454 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
20455 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
20456 one.
20457 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
20458 transport and the router that called it.
20459
20460 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
20461 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
20462 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
20463 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
20464 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
20465 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
20466 safely be resent to other recipients.
20467
20468
20469 .option driver transports string unset
20470 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
20471 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
20472
20473
20474 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
20475 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
20476 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
20477 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
20478 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
20479 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
20480 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
20481 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
20482 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
20483 resent to other recipients.
20484
20485
20486 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
20487 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
20488 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
20489 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
20490 &%user%& (see below).
20491
20492
20493 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
20494 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
20495 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
20496 This option specifies a list of text headers,
20497 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
20498 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
20499 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
20500 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
20501 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
20502 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
20503 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
20504
20505 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
20506 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
20507
20508
20509 .option headers_only transports boolean false
20510 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
20511 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
20512 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
20513 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
20514 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
20515 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
20516 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
20517
20518
20519 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
20520 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
20521 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
20522 This option specifies a list of header names,
20523 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way);
20524 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
20525 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
20526 routers.
20527 Each list item is separately expanded.
20528 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
20529 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
20530 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
20531
20532 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
20533 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
20534
20535 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
20536 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
20537 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
20538
20539
20540
20541 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
20542 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
20543 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
20544 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
20545 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
20546 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
20547 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
20548 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
20549 example,
20550 .code
20551 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
20552 x@y w@z
20553 .endd
20554 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
20555 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
20556 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
20557 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
20558 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
20559 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
20560 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
20561 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
20562 change envelope recipients at this time.
20563
20564
20565 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
20566 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
20567 .vindex "&$home$&"
20568 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
20569 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
20570 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
20571 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
20572 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
20573 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
20574 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
20575 deferred.
20576
20577
20578 .option initgroups transports boolean false
20579 .cindex "additional groups"
20580 .cindex "groups" "additional"
20581 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
20582 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
20583 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
20584 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
20585
20586
20587 .new
20588 .option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
20589 .cindex limit "transport parallelism"
20590 .cindex transport "parallel processes"
20591 .cindex transport "concurrency limit"
20592 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
20593 If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
20594 it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
20595 The control does not apply to shadow transports.
20596
20597 .cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
20598 Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
20599 incremented whenever a transport process is beaing created. The record
20600 is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
20601 Obviously there is scope for
20602 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
20603 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
20604
20605 If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
20606 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
20607 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
20608 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
20609 are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
20610 .wen
20611
20612
20613 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
20614 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
20615 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
20616 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
20617 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
20618 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
20619 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
20620 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
20621 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
20622 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
20623 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
20624 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
20625 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
20626 delivered.
20627
20628
20629
20630 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
20631 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
20632 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
20633 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
20634 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
20635 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
20636 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
20637 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
20638 that contains
20639 .code
20640 local_part_prefix = *-
20641 .endd
20642 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
20643 is delivered with
20644 .code
20645 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
20646 .endd
20647 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
20648 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
20649 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
20650 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
20651 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
20652
20653
20654 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
20655 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
20656 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
20657 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
20658 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
20659 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
20660 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
20661 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
20662 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
20663
20664 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
20665 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
20666 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
20667 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
20668
20669 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
20670 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
20671 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
20672
20673
20674 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
20675 .cindex "envelope sender"
20676 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
20677 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
20678 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
20679 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
20680 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
20681 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
20682 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
20683 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
20684 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
20685
20686 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
20687 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
20688
20689 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
20690 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
20691 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
20692 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
20693 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
20694 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
20695 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
20696
20697 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
20698 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
20699 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
20700 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
20701 &%errors_to%& in a router.
20702
20703
20704
20705 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
20706 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
20707 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
20708 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
20709 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
20710 have easy access to it.
20711
20712 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
20713 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
20714 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
20715 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
20716 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
20717 recipients.
20718
20719
20720 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
20721 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
20722
20723
20724 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
20725 .cindex "shadow transport"
20726 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
20727 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
20728 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
20729
20730 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
20731 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
20732 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
20733 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
20734 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
20735 cause a log line to be written.
20736
20737 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
20738 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
20739 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
20740 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
20741 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
20742 of the form
20743 .code
20744 ST=<shadow transport name>
20745 .endd
20746 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
20747 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
20748 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
20749 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
20750 headers that some sites insist on.
20751
20752
20753 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
20754 .cindex "transport" "filter"
20755 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
20756 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
20757 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
20758 individual users or via a system filter.
20759 .new
20760 If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
20761 .wen
20762
20763 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
20764 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
20765 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
20766 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
20767 command must be specified as an absolute path.
20768
20769 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
20770 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
20771 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
20772 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
20773 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
20774 &(pipe)& transports.
20775
20776 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
20777 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
20778 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
20779 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
20780 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
20781
20782 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
20783 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
20784 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
20785 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
20786
20787 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
20788 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
20789 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
20790 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
20791 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
20792 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
20793
20794 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
20795 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
20796 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
20797 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
20798 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
20799 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
20800 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
20801 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
20802
20803 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20804 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
20805 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
20806 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
20807 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
20808 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
20809 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
20810 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
20811 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
20812 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
20813
20814 .vindex "&$host$&"
20815 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
20816 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
20817 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
20818 which the message is being sent. For example:
20819 .code
20820 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
20821 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
20822 .endd
20823
20824 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
20825 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
20826 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
20827 .ilist
20828 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
20829 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
20830 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
20831 example:
20832 .code
20833 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
20834 .endd
20835 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
20836 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
20837 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
20838 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
20839 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
20840 Exim tried to expand the first one.
20841 .next
20842 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
20843 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
20844 arguments. Consider this example:
20845 .code
20846 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
20847 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
20848 .endd
20849 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
20850 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
20851 .code
20852 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
20853 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
20854 .endd
20855 .endlist
20856
20857 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
20858 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
20859 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
20860 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
20861 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
20862 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
20863 bounced from a transport filter.
20864
20865 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
20866 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
20867 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
20868
20869
20870 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
20871 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
20872 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
20873 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
20874 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
20875 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
20876 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
20877 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
20878 becomes a temporary error.
20879
20880
20881 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
20882 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
20883 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
20884 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
20885 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
20886 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
20887 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
20888 option is not set.
20889
20890 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
20891 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
20892 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
20893
20894 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
20895 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
20896 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
20897 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
20898 retry data.
20899 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
20900 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
20901 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
20902
20903
20904
20905
20906
20907
20908 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20909 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20910
20911 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
20912 "Address batching"
20913 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
20914 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
20915 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
20916 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
20917 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
20918 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
20919 copy of the message is delivered each time.
20920
20921 .cindex "batched local delivery"
20922 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
20923 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
20924 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
20925 local transport, for example:
20926
20927 .ilist
20928 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
20929 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
20930 recipients saves space.
20931 .next
20932 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
20933 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
20934 .next
20935 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
20936 to a scanner program or
20937 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
20938 acceptable.
20939 .endlist
20940
20941 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
20942 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
20943 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
20944
20945 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
20946 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
20947 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
20948 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
20949 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
20950 to certain conditions:
20951
20952 .ilist
20953 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20954 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
20955 batching is possible.
20956 .next
20957 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20958 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
20959 addresses with the same domain are batched.
20960 .next
20961 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
20962 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
20963 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
20964 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
20965 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
20966 from taking place.
20967 .next
20968 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
20969 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
20970 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
20971 be the same.
20972 .endlist
20973
20974 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
20975 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
20976 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
20977 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
20978 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
20979 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
20980 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
20981 .code
20982 check_string = "."
20983 escape_string = ".."
20984 .endd
20985 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
20986 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
20987 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
20988
20989 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
20990 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
20991 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
20992 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
20993 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
20994 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
20995
20996 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
20997 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20998 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
20999 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
21000 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
21001 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
21002 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
21003 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
21004 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
21005
21006
21007
21008
21009 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21010 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21011
21012 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
21013 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
21014 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
21015 .cindex "directory creation"
21016 .cindex "creating directories"
21017 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
21018 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
21019 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
21020 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
21021 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
21022 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
21023 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
21024 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
21025 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
21026 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
21027
21028 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
21029 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
21030 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
21031 included.
21032
21033 .cindex "quota" "system"
21034 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
21035 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
21036 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
21037
21038 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
21039 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
21040 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
21041 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
21042
21043 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
21044 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
21045 private options.
21046
21047 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
21048 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
21049 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
21050 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
21051 option).
21052
21053
21054
21055 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
21056 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
21057 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
21058 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
21059 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
21060
21061 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
21062 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21063 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
21064 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
21065 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
21066 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
21067 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
21068 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
21069 operation. There are two cases:
21070
21071 .ilist
21072 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
21073 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
21074 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
21075 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
21076 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
21077 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
21078 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
21079 .next
21080 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
21081 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
21082 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
21083 .endlist
21084
21085
21086 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
21087 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
21088 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
21089 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
21090 form:
21091 .code
21092 save folder23
21093 .endd
21094 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
21095 .code
21096 require "fileinto";
21097 fileinto "folder23";
21098 .endd
21099 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
21100 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
21101 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
21102 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
21103 way of handling this requirement:
21104 .code
21105 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
21106 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
21107 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
21108 {$address_file} \
21109 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
21110 }} \
21111 }
21112 .endd
21113 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
21114 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
21115 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
21116
21117 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
21118 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
21119 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
21120 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
21121 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
21122 path to the transport.
21123
21124 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
21125 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
21126
21127
21128
21129
21130 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
21131 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
21132
21133
21134
21135 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
21136 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
21137 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
21138 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
21139 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
21140 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
21141 delivery is deferred.
21142
21143
21144 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
21145 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21146 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21147 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
21148 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
21149 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
21150 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
21151 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
21152
21153
21154 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
21155 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21156 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
21157 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
21158 file.
21159
21160
21161 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
21162 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21163
21164
21165 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
21166 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
21167 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
21168 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
21169 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
21170
21171
21172 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
21173 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
21174 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
21175 process is running.
21176
21177
21178 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
21179 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21180 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
21181 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
21182 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
21183 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
21184 contains is significant.
21185
21186 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
21187 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
21188 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
21189 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
21190 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
21191
21192 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
21193 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
21194 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
21195 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
21196 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
21197 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
21198 .code
21199 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21200 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
21201 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21202 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21203 .endd
21204 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
21205 .cindex "directory creation"
21206 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
21207 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
21208 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
21209
21210 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
21211 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
21212 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
21213 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
21214 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
21215
21216
21217
21218 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
21219 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
21220 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
21221 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
21222 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
21223 beneath.
21224
21225 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
21226 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
21227 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
21228 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
21229 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
21230 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
21231 &%file_must_exist%&.
21232
21233
21234 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
21235 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
21236 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
21237 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
21238
21239 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
21240 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
21241 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
21242 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
21243 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
21244
21245
21246 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
21247 .cindex "base62"
21248 .vindex "&$inode$&"
21249 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
21250 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
21251 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
21252 .code
21253 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
21254 .endd
21255 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
21256 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
21257 option.
21258
21259
21260 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
21261 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
21262 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
21263
21264
21265 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
21266 See &%check_string%& above.
21267
21268
21269 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
21270 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
21271 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
21272 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
21273 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
21274 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
21275 &%file%&.
21276
21277 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21278 .cindex "locking files"
21279 .cindex "lock files"
21280 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
21281 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
21282
21283 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
21284 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
21285 examples:
21286 .code
21287 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21288 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
21289 file = $home/inbox
21290 .endd
21291 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
21292 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
21293 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
21294 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
21295 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
21296 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
21297
21298
21299
21300 .option file_format appendfile string unset
21301 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
21302 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
21303 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
21304 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
21305 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
21306 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
21307 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
21308 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
21309 this added to it:
21310 .code
21311 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
21312 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
21313 .endd
21314 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
21315 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
21316 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
21317 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
21318 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
21319 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
21320 delivery is deferred.
21321
21322
21323 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
21324 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
21325 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
21326 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
21327
21328
21329 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
21330 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21331 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
21332 .cindex "locking files"
21333 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
21334 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
21335 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
21336 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
21337 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
21338 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
21339 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
21340 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
21341
21342 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
21343 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
21344 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
21345 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
21346
21347 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
21348 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
21349 retries is
21350 .code
21351 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
21352 .endd
21353 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
21354 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
21355 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
21356
21357 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
21358 local deliveries because of errors of the form
21359 .code
21360 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
21361 .endd
21362
21363 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
21364 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
21365 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
21366 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
21367
21368
21369 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
21370 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
21371 for details of locking.
21372
21373
21374 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
21375 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
21376 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
21377
21378
21379 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
21380 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
21381 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
21382
21383
21384 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
21385 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21386 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
21387 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
21388 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
21389
21390
21391 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
21392 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21393 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21394 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21395 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
21396 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
21397 external source that maintains the data.
21398
21399
21400 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
21401 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21402 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21403 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21404 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
21405 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
21406 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
21407 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
21408
21409
21410
21411 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
21412 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
21413 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
21414 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
21415 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
21416 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
21417 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
21418 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
21419 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
21420 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
21421
21422
21423 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
21424 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
21425 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
21426 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
21427 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
21428 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
21429 calculation. The default value is:
21430 .code
21431 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
21432 .endd
21433 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
21434 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
21435 &_Trash_&
21436 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
21437 .code
21438 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
21439 .endd
21440 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
21441 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
21442 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
21443 directly into that directory.
21444
21445
21446 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
21447 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
21448 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
21449
21450
21451 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
21452 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
21453 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
21454
21455
21456 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
21457 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
21458 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
21459 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
21460 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
21461 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
21462 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
21463 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
21464
21465 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
21466 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
21467 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
21468 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
21469 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
21470 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
21471 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
21472 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
21473 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
21474 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
21475
21476
21477 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
21478 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
21479 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
21480 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
21481 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
21482 below for further details.
21483
21484
21485 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
21486 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
21487 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
21488
21489
21490 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
21491 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
21492 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
21493
21494
21495 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
21496 .cindex "locking files"
21497 .cindex "file" "locking"
21498 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
21499 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
21500 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
21501 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
21502 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
21503 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
21504 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
21505
21506 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
21507 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
21508 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
21509 combination:
21510 .code
21511 mbx_format = true
21512 message_prefix =
21513 message_suffix =
21514 .endd
21515 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
21516 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
21517 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
21518 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
21519 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
21520 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
21521 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
21522 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
21523
21524 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
21525 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
21526 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
21527 append messages to it.
21528
21529
21530 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
21531 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21532 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
21533 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
21534 in which case it is:
21535 .code
21536 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
21537 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
21538 .endd
21539 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21540 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
21541
21542 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
21543 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
21544 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
21545 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
21546 setting
21547 .code
21548 message_suffix =
21549 .endd
21550 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21551 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
21552
21553 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
21554 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
21555 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
21556 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
21557 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
21558 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
21559 value, and this option is ignored.
21560
21561
21562 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
21563 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
21564 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
21565 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
21566 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
21567
21568
21569 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
21570 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
21571 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
21572 on users about incoming mail.
21573
21574
21575 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
21576 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
21577 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
21578 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
21579 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
21580 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
21581 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
21582 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
21583 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
21584
21585 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
21586 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
21587 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
21588
21589 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
21590 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
21591 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
21592 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
21593 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
21594 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
21595
21596 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
21597 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
21598 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
21599 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
21600 be handled.
21601
21602 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
21603
21604 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
21605 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
21606 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
21607 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
21608 system quota failures.
21609
21610 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
21611 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
21612 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
21613 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
21614 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
21615 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
21616 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
21617 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
21618 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
21619 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
21620
21621
21622 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
21623 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
21624 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
21625 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
21626 delivery directory.
21627
21628
21629 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
21630 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
21631 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
21632 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
21633 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
21634 &"no quota"&.
21635
21636
21637 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
21638 See &%quota%& above.
21639
21640
21641 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
21642 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
21643 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
21644 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
21645 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
21646 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
21647 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
21648
21649 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
21650 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
21651 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
21652 the file length to the file name. For example:
21653 .code
21654 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
21655 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
21656 .endd
21657 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
21658 number of lines in the message.
21659
21660 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
21661 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
21662 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
21663
21664 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
21665
21666
21667 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
21668 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
21669 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
21670 .code
21671 quota_warn_message = "\
21672 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
21673 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
21674 This message is automatically created \
21675 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
21676 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
21677 a warning threshold that is\n\
21678 set by the system administrator.\n"
21679 .endd
21680
21681
21682 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
21683 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
21684 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
21685 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21686 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
21687 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
21688 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
21689 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
21690 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
21691 sign. For example:
21692 .code
21693 quota = 10M
21694 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
21695 .endd
21696 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
21697 percent sign is ignored.
21698
21699 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
21700 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
21701 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
21702 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
21703 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
21704 &'From:'& line, the default is:
21705 .code
21706 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
21707 .endd
21708 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
21709 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
21710 option.
21711
21712 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
21713 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
21714 percentage.
21715
21716
21717 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
21718 .cindex "envelope sender"
21719 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
21720 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
21721 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
21722 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
21723 for details of batch SMTP.
21724
21725
21726 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
21727 .cindex "carriage return"
21728 .cindex "linefeed"
21729 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
21730 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
21731 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
21732 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
21733
21734 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
21735 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
21736 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
21737 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
21738 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
21739 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
21740
21741
21742 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
21743 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
21744 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
21745 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
21746 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
21747 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
21748
21749
21750 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
21751 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
21752 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
21753 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
21754 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
21755
21756 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
21757 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
21758 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
21759 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
21760
21761 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
21762 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
21763 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
21764 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
21765 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
21766 error.
21767
21768 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
21769 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
21770
21771
21772 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
21773 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
21774 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
21775 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
21776 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
21777 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
21778 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
21779
21780 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21781 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
21782 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
21783 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
21784 file corruption.
21785
21786 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
21787 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
21788 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
21789
21790
21791 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
21792 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
21793 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
21794 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
21795 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
21796 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
21797 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
21798 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
21799 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
21800
21801 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
21802 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
21803 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
21804 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
21805
21806
21807
21808
21809 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
21810 .cindex "appending to a file"
21811 .cindex "file" "appending"
21812 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
21813
21814 .ilist
21815 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
21816 return is given.
21817
21818 .next
21819 .cindex "directory creation"
21820 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
21821 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
21822 &%directory_mode%& option.
21823
21824 .next
21825 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
21826 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
21827 transport.
21828
21829 .next
21830 .cindex "file" "locking"
21831 .cindex "locking files"
21832 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21833 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
21834 reliably over NFS, as follows:
21835
21836 .olist
21837 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
21838 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
21839 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
21840 .next
21841 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
21842 .next
21843 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
21844 Unlink the hitching post name.
21845 .next
21846 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
21847 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
21848 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
21849 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
21850 .next
21851 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
21852 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
21853 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
21854 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
21855 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
21856 it before trying again.
21857 .endlist olist
21858
21859 .next
21860 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
21861 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
21862 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
21863
21864 .next
21865 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21866 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21867 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
21868 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
21869 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
21870 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
21871 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
21872 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
21873 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
21874 checked.
21875
21876 .next
21877 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
21878 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
21879 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
21880 delivery is deferred.
21881
21882 .next
21883 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
21884 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
21885 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
21886 permissions.
21887
21888 .next
21889 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
21890 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
21891 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
21892
21893 .next
21894 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
21895 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
21896 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
21897
21898 .next
21899 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
21900 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
21901 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
21902 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
21903 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
21904 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
21905 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
21906 that prevents link following.
21907
21908 .next
21909 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
21910 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
21911 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
21912 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
21913 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
21914
21915 .next
21916 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
21917
21918 .next
21919 .cindex "file" "locking"
21920 .cindex "locking files"
21921 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
21922 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
21923 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
21924 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
21925 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
21926 .code
21927 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
21928 .endd
21929 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
21930 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
21931 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
21932
21933 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
21934 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
21935 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
21936
21937 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
21938 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
21939 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
21940 delivery is deferred.
21941
21942 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
21943 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
21944 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
21945 immediately. It retries up to
21946 .code
21947 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
21948 .endd
21949 times (rounded up).
21950 .endlist
21951
21952 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
21953 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
21954
21955
21956 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
21957 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
21958 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21959 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
21960 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
21961 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
21962 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
21963 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
21964 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
21965 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
21966
21967 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
21968 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
21969 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
21970 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
21971 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
21972 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
21973 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
21974
21975 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
21976 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
21977 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
21978 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
21979
21980
21981 .cindex "maildir format"
21982 .cindex "mailstore format"
21983 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
21984 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
21985 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
21986 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
21987 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
21988
21989 .cindex "directory creation"
21990 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
21991 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
21992 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
21993 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
21994 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
21995 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
21996 deferred.
21997
21998
21999
22000 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
22001 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
22002 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
22003 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
22004 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
22005 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
22006 &_new_& subdirectory.
22007
22008 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
22009 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
22010 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
22011 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
22012 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
22013 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
22014 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
22015
22016 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
22017 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
22018 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
22019 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
22020 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
22021 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
22022 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
22023 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
22024
22025 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
22026 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
22027 folders. Consider this example:
22028 .code
22029 maildir_format = true
22030 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
22031 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
22032 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
22033 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
22034 .endd
22035 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
22036 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
22037 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
22038 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
22039 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
22040 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
22041
22042 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
22043 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
22044 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
22045 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
22046 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
22047
22048 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
22049 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
22050 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
22051
22052 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22053 .cindex "maildir++"
22054 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
22055 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
22056 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
22057 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
22058 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
22059 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
22060 amount of space used.
22061
22062 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
22063 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
22064 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
22065 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
22066 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
22067 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
22068
22069
22070
22071
22072 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
22073 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
22074 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
22075 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
22076 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
22077 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
22078
22079
22080 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
22081 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
22082 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
22083 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
22084 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
22085 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
22086 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
22087 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
22088 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
22089 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
22090 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
22091 backwards compatibility).
22092
22093 For one common implementation, you might set:
22094 .code
22095 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
22096 .endd
22097 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
22098
22099 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
22100 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
22101 &[stat()]& each message file.
22102
22103
22104 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
22105 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22106 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22107 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
22108 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
22109 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
22110 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
22111 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
22112 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
22113
22114 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
22115 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
22116 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
22117 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
22118 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
22119 need to know the quota.
22120
22121 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
22122 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
22123
22124 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
22125 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
22126 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
22127 details.
22128
22129
22130 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
22131 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
22132 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
22133 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
22134 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
22135 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
22136 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
22137 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
22138
22139 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
22140 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
22141 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
22142 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
22143 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
22144 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
22145
22146 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
22147 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
22148 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
22149 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
22150 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
22151 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
22152
22153 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
22154 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
22155 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
22156 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
22157
22158
22159 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
22160 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
22161 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
22162 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
22163 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
22164 .code
22165 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
22166 .endd
22167 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
22168 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
22169 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
22170 .ecindex IIDapptra1
22171 .ecindex IIDapptra2
22172
22173
22174
22175
22176
22177
22178 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22179 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22180
22181 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
22182 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
22183 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
22184 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
22185 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
22186 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
22187 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
22188 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
22189
22190 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
22191 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
22192 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
22193 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
22194 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
22195
22196
22197 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
22198 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
22199 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
22200 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
22201 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
22202
22203 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
22204 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
22205 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
22206 transport is run as a consequence of a
22207 &%mail%&
22208 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
22209 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
22210 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
22211 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
22212 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
22213 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
22214
22215 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
22216 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
22217 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
22218 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
22219
22220 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
22221 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
22222 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
22223 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
22224 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
22225 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
22226 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
22227
22228 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
22229 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
22230 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
22231 the transport defers.
22232 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
22233 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
22234
22235 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
22236 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
22237 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
22238 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
22239
22240 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22241 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
22242 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
22243 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
22244 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
22245 problems. They are just discarded.
22246
22247
22248
22249 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
22250 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
22251
22252 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
22253 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
22254 message when the message is specified by the transport.
22255
22256
22257 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
22258 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
22259 when the message is specified by the transport.
22260
22261
22262 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
22263 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
22264 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
22265 string comes first.
22266
22267
22268 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
22269 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
22270 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
22271
22272
22273 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
22274 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
22275 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
22276
22277
22278 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
22279 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
22280 specified by the transport.
22281
22282
22283 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
22284 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
22285 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
22286 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
22287
22288
22289 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
22290 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
22291 the message is specified by the transport.
22292
22293
22294 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
22295 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
22296 used.
22297
22298
22299 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
22300 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
22301 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
22302 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
22303 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
22304
22305
22306
22307 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
22308 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
22309 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
22310 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
22311
22312 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
22313 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
22314 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
22315 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
22316 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
22317 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
22318 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
22319 infinity.
22320
22321 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
22322 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
22323 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
22324 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
22325 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
22326
22327 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
22328 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
22329 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
22330 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
22331 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
22332 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
22333
22334
22335 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
22336 See &%once%& above.
22337
22338
22339 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
22340 See &%once%& above.
22341 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
22342
22343
22344 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
22345 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
22346 specified by the transport.
22347
22348
22349 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
22350 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
22351 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
22352 configuration option.
22353
22354
22355 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
22356 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
22357 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
22358 automatic responses. For example:
22359 .code
22360 subject = Re: $h_subject:
22361 .endd
22362 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
22363 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
22364 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
22365 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
22366 small.
22367
22368
22369
22370 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
22371 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
22372 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
22373 the text comes first.
22374
22375
22376 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
22377 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
22378 when the message is specified by the transport.
22379 .ecindex IIDauttra1
22380 .ecindex IIDauttra2
22381
22382
22383
22384
22385 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22386 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22387
22388 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
22389 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
22390 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
22391 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
22392 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
22393 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
22394 specified command
22395 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
22396 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
22397 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
22398 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
22399 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
22400 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
22401 .code
22402 TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
22403 .endd
22404 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
22405 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
22406 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
22407 as follows:
22408
22409 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
22410 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22411
22412
22413 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
22414 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
22415 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
22416 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
22417 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22418
22419
22420 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
22421 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
22422 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
22423 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
22424 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
22425 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
22426 LMTP protocol.
22427
22428 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
22429 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
22430 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
22431 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
22432 in its response to the LHLO command.
22433
22434 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
22435 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
22436 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
22437 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
22438
22439
22440 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
22441 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
22442 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
22443 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
22444 LMTP transport:
22445 .code
22446 lmtp:
22447 driver = lmtp
22448 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
22449 batch_max = 20
22450 user = exim
22451 .endd
22452 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
22453 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
22454
22455
22456
22457 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22458 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22459
22460 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
22461 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
22462 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
22463 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
22464 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
22465 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
22466 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
22467 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
22468 following ways:
22469
22470 .ilist
22471 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22472 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
22473 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
22474 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
22475 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
22476 .next
22477 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22478 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
22479 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
22480 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
22481 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
22482 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
22483 that are routed to the transport.
22484 .next
22485 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
22486 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
22487 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
22488 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
22489 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
22490 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
22491 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
22492 .endlist
22493
22494
22495 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
22496 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
22497 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
22498
22499 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
22500 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
22501 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
22502 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
22503 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
22504 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
22505 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
22506
22507
22508 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
22509 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
22510 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
22511 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
22512 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
22513 .new
22514 Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
22515 of "1" to enforce serialization.
22516 .wen
22517
22518
22519
22520
22521 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
22522 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
22523 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
22524 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
22525 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
22526 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
22527 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
22528 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
22529 &"local delivery failed"&.
22530
22531 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
22532 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
22533 will be sent as normal.
22534
22535 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
22536 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
22537 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
22538 apply in this case.
22539
22540 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
22541 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
22542 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
22543 a non-existent command may be the problem.
22544
22545 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
22546 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
22547 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
22548 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
22549 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
22550 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
22551 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
22552 &%temp_errors%&.
22553
22554
22555
22556 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
22557 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
22558 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
22559 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
22560 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
22561 run.
22562
22563 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
22564 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
22565 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
22566 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
22567
22568 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
22569 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
22570 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
22571 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
22572 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
22573 .code
22574 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
22575 .endd
22576 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
22577 arguments. You have to write
22578 .code
22579 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
22580 .endd
22581 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
22582 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
22583 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
22584 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
22585 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
22586 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
22587 example:
22588 .code
22589 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
22590 .endd
22591
22592 .cindex "transport" "filter"
22593 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22594 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22595 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
22596 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
22597 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
22598 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
22599 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
22600 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
22601 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
22602
22603 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, Special handling takes place
22604 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
22605 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
22606 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
22607 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
22608 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
22609 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
22610 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
22611
22612 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
22613 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
22614 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
22615 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
22616 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
22617 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
22618 control what is done with it.
22619
22620 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
22621 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
22622 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
22623 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
22624 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
22625 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
22626 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
22627 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
22628 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
22629 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
22630 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
22631
22632
22633
22634 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
22635 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
22636 .cindex "environment for pipe transport"
22637 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
22638 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
22639 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
22640 environment.
22641 .display
22642 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
22643 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
22644 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
22645 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
22646 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
22647 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
22648 &`LOGNAME `& see below
22649 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
22650 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
22651 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
22652 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
22653 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
22654 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
22655 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
22656 &`USER `& see below
22657 .endd
22658 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
22659 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
22660 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
22661 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
22662 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
22663 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
22664 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
22665
22666 .cindex "HOST"
22667 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
22668 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
22669 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
22670 the router.
22671
22672 .cindex "HOME"
22673 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
22674 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
22675 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
22676 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
22677
22678
22679 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
22680 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
22681
22682
22683
22684 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
22685 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
22686 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
22687 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
22688 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
22689 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
22690 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
22691 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
22692 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
22693 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
22694 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
22695 example, if
22696 .code
22697 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
22698 .endd
22699 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
22700 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
22701 &%use_shell%& is set.
22702
22703
22704 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
22705 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22706
22707
22708 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
22709 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
22710 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22711
22712
22713 .option check_string pipe string unset
22714 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
22715 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
22716 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
22717 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
22718 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
22719 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
22720 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
22721 ignored.
22722
22723
22724 .option command pipe string&!! unset
22725 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
22726 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
22727 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
22728 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
22729 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
22730 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
22731
22732
22733 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
22734 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
22735 .cindex "environment for &(pipe)& transport"
22736 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
22737 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
22738 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
22739 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
22740
22741
22742 .option escape_string pipe string unset
22743 See &%check_string%& above.
22744
22745
22746 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
22747 .cindex "exec failure"
22748 .cindex "failure of exec"
22749 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
22750 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
22751 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
22752 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
22753 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
22754
22755
22756 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
22757 .cindex "signal exit"
22758 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
22759 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
22760 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
22761 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
22762
22763
22764 .option force_command pipe boolean false
22765 .cindex "force command"
22766 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
22767 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
22768 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
22769 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
22770 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
22771 command. For example:
22772 .code
22773 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
22774 force_command
22775 .endd
22776
22777 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
22778 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
22779 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
22780
22781
22782 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
22783 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
22784 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
22785 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
22786 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
22787 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
22788
22789 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
22790 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
22791
22792
22793 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
22794 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
22795 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
22796 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
22797 and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
22798 written to the main log.
22799
22800
22801 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
22802 If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
22803 stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
22804 the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
22805 failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
22806 option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
22807 be set.
22808
22809
22810 .option log_output pipe boolean false
22811 If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
22812 stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
22813 the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
22814 exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
22815
22816
22817 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
22818 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
22819 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
22820 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
22821 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
22822 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
22823 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
22824 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
22825
22826
22827 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
22828 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22829 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
22830 .code
22831 message_prefix = \
22832 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
22833 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
22834 .endd
22835 .cindex "Cyrus"
22836 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
22837 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22838 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
22839 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
22840 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
22841 setting
22842 .code
22843 message_prefix =
22844 .endd
22845 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22846 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22847
22848
22849 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
22850 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22851 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
22852 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
22853 .code
22854 message_suffix =
22855 .endd
22856 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22857 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22858
22859
22860 .option path pipe string "see below"
22861 This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
22862 variable of the subprocess. The default is:
22863 .code
22864 /bin:/usr/bin
22865 .endd
22866 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
22867 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
22868 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
22869
22870
22871 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
22872 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
22873 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
22874 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
22875 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
22876 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
22877 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
22878 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
22879 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
22880
22881
22882 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
22883 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
22884 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
22885 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
22886 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
22887 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
22888 accept the message is used.
22889
22890
22891 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
22892 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
22893 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
22894 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
22895 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
22896 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
22897
22898
22899 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
22900 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
22901 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
22902 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
22903 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
22904 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
22905 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
22906
22907
22908
22909 .option return_output pipe boolean false
22910 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
22911 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
22912 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
22913 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
22914 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
22915 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
22916 of them may be set.
22917
22918
22919
22920 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
22921 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
22922 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
22923 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
22924 and &%return_output%& is not set,
22925 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
22926 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
22927 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
22928 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
22929 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
22930 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
22931 and 73, respectively.
22932
22933
22934 .option timeout pipe time 1h
22935 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
22936 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
22937 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
22938 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
22939 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
22940 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
22941
22942 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
22943 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
22944 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
22945 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
22946 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
22947 delivery to be deferred.
22948
22949 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
22950 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
22951
22952
22953 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
22954 .cindex "envelope sender"
22955 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
22956 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
22957 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
22958 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
22959 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
22960
22961 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
22962 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
22963 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
22964 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
22965 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
22966 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
22967 class database.
22968
22969
22970 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
22971 .cindex "carriage return"
22972 .cindex "linefeed"
22973 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22974 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22975 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
22976 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22977
22978 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
22979 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
22980 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
22981 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
22982 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22983
22984
22985 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
22986 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22987 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
22988 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
22989 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
22990 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
22991 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
22992 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
22993 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
22994 its &%-c%& option.
22995
22996
22997
22998 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
22999 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
23000 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
23001 .cindex "external local delivery"
23002 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
23003 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
23004 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
23005 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
23006 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
23007 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
23008 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
23009 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
23010 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
23011 configuration for &%procmail%&:
23012 .code
23013 # transport
23014 procmail_pipe:
23015 driver = pipe
23016 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
23017 return_path_add
23018 delivery_date_add
23019 envelope_to_add
23020 check_string = "From "
23021 escape_string = ">From "
23022 umask = 077
23023 user = $local_part
23024 group = mail
23025
23026 # router
23027 procmail:
23028 driver = accept
23029 check_local_user
23030 transport = procmail_pipe
23031 .endd
23032 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
23033 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
23034 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
23035 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
23036 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
23037 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
23038
23039 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
23040 .code
23041 IFS=" "
23042 .endd
23043 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
23044 use a shell to run pipe commands.
23045
23046 .cindex "Cyrus"
23047 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
23048 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
23049 .code
23050 # transport
23051 local_delivery_cyrus:
23052 driver = pipe
23053 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
23054 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
23055 user = cyrus
23056 group = mail
23057 return_output
23058 log_output
23059 message_prefix =
23060 message_suffix =
23061
23062 # router
23063 local_user_cyrus:
23064 driver = accept
23065 check_local_user
23066 local_part_suffix = .*
23067 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
23068 .endd
23069 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
23070 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
23071 sender.
23072 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
23073 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
23074
23075
23076 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23077 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23078
23079 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
23080 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
23081 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
23082 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
23083 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
23084 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
23085 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
23086 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
23087
23088
23089 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
23090 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
23091 two ways:
23092
23093 .ilist
23094 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
23095 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
23096 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
23097 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
23098 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
23099 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
23100 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
23101 .next
23102 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
23103 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
23104 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
23105 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
23106 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
23107 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
23108 process.
23109 .endlist
23110
23111
23112 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
23113 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
23114 no further messages are sent over that connection.
23115
23116
23117
23118 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
23119 .vindex "&$host$&"
23120 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23121 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
23122 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
23123 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
23124 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
23125 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
23126 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
23127 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
23128
23129
23130 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
23131 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
23132 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
23133 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
23134 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
23135 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
23136 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
23137 are the values that were set when the message was received.
23138 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
23139 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
23140 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
23141 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
23142 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
23143 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
23144
23145 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
23146 and will be removed in a future release.
23147
23148
23149 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
23150 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
23151 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
23152
23153
23154 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
23155 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
23156 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
23157 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
23158 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
23159 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
23160 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
23161 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
23162
23163 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
23164 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
23165 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23166 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
23167 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
23168 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
23169 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
23170 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
23171 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
23172
23173
23174 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
23175 .cindex "Cyrus"
23176 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
23177 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
23178 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
23179 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
23180 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
23181 ignored.
23182
23183 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
23184 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
23185 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
23186 particular connection.
23187
23188 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
23189 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
23190 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
23191 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
23192
23193 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
23194 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
23195 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
23196 .code
23197 authenticated_sender = $local_part
23198 .endd
23199 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
23200 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
23201
23202 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
23203 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
23204 value.
23205
23206
23207 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
23208 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
23209 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
23210 authenticated as a client.
23211
23212
23213 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
23214 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
23215 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
23216 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
23217
23218
23219 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
23220 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
23221 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
23222 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
23223 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
23224 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
23225 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
23226
23227
23228 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
23229 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
23230 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
23231 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23232 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
23233 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
23234 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
23235 option.
23236
23237
23238 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
23239 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
23240 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
23241 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
23242
23243
23244 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
23245 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
23246 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
23247 cutoff times.
23248
23249 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
23250 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
23251 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
23252 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
23253 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
23254 unhappy at this prospect, so...
23255
23256 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
23257 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
23258 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
23259 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
23260 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
23261 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
23262 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
23263 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
23264 to them.
23265
23266
23267 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
23268 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
23269 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
23270 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
23271 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
23272
23273
23274 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
23275 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
23276 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
23277 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
23278 details.
23279
23280
23281 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23282 .cindex "MX record" "security"
23283 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23284 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23285 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23286 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
23287 the dnssec request bit set.
23288 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23289
23290
23291
23292 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23293 .cindex "MX record" "security"
23294 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23295 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23296 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23297 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
23298 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
23299 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
23300 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23301
23302
23303
23304 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
23305 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
23306 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
23307 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
23308 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
23309 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
23310 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
23311
23312 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
23313 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
23314 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
23315 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
23316 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
23317
23318
23319 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
23320 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23321 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
23322 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
23323 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
23324 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23325 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23326 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
23327
23328 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
23329 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
23330 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
23331 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
23332 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
23333 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
23334
23335 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
23336 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
23337 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
23338 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
23339 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
23340
23341 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
23342 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
23343 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
23344 copy of the message is sent.
23345
23346 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
23347 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
23348 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
23349 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
23350 fails"& facility.
23351
23352
23353 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
23354 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
23355 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
23356 zero.
23357
23358 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
23359 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
23360 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
23361 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
23362 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
23363 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
23364
23365 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
23366 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
23367 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
23368 implementations of TLS.
23369
23370 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
23371 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
23372 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
23373 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
23374 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
23375 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
23376 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
23377 option is:
23378 .code
23379 $primary_hostname
23380 .endd
23381 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
23382 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
23383 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
23384 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
23385 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
23386 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
23387 interface address, you could use this:
23388 .code
23389 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
23390 {$primary_hostname}}
23391 .endd
23392 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
23393 callouts.
23394
23395 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
23396 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
23397 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
23398 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
23399 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
23400 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
23401
23402 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
23403 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
23404 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
23405 &%hosts_override%& is set.
23406
23407 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
23408 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
23409 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
23410 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23411 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23412 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
23413 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
23414
23415 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
23416 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
23417 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
23418 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
23419 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
23420 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
23421 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
23422 address are used.
23423
23424 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
23425 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
23426
23427
23428 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
23429 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
23430 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
23431 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
23432 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
23433 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
23434 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
23435 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
23436 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
23437 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
23438
23439
23440 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
23441 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
23442 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
23443 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
23444
23445
23446 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23447 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
23448 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
23449 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23450
23451 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23452 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
23453 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
23454 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
23455 to any host that matches this list.
23456
23457
23458 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
23459 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
23460 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
23461 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
23462 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
23463 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
23464 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
23465 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
23466
23467
23468 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
23469 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
23470 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
23471 why it exists.
23472
23473
23474
23475 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23476 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
23477 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23478 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
23479 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
23480 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
23481 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
23482 explanation of when this might be needed.
23483
23484
23485 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
23486 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
23487 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
23488 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
23489 &%fallback_hosts%&.
23490
23491
23492 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
23493 .cindex "randomized host list"
23494 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
23495 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
23496 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
23497 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
23498 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
23499 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
23500 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
23501 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
23502
23503 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
23504 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
23505 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
23506 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
23507 .code
23508 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
23509 .endd
23510 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
23511 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
23512 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
23513
23514 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
23515 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
23516 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
23517 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
23518 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
23519 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
23520 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
23521 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
23522 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
23523
23524
23525 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
23526 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23527 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
23528 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
23529 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
23530
23531 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
23532 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23533 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
23534 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
23535 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
23536
23537 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23538 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23539 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
23540 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23541 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
23542 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
23543
23544 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
23545 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
23546 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
23547 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
23548 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
23549 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
23550 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
23551
23552 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
23553 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
23554 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
23555 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
23556 for multi-recipient messages.
23557 The option can usually be left as default.
23558
23559 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
23560 .cindex "bind IP address"
23561 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
23562 .vindex "&$host$&"
23563 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23564 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
23565 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
23566 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
23567 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
23568 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
23569 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
23570 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
23571 unknown.
23572
23573 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
23574 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
23575 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
23576 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
23577 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
23578 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
23579 .code
23580 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
23581 .endd
23582 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
23583 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
23584 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
23585 interface to use if the host has more than one.
23586
23587
23588 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
23589 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
23590 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
23591 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
23592 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
23593 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
23594 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
23595 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
23596 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
23597 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
23598 unreachable hosts.
23599
23600
23601 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
23602 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23603 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
23604 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
23605 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
23606
23607 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
23608 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
23609 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
23610 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
23611 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
23612 permits this.
23613
23614
23615 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
23616 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23617 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
23618 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
23619 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
23620 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
23621 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
23622 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
23623
23624 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
23625 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
23626 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
23627
23628 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
23629 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
23630 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
23631 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
23632 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
23633 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
23634 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
23635 variable that contains an outgoing port.
23636
23637 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
23638 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
23639 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
23640 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
23641 is deferred.
23642
23643
23644
23645 .option protocol smtp string smtp
23646 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
23647 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
23648 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
23649 .vindex "&$port$&"
23650 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
23651 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
23652 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
23653 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
23654 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
23655
23656 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
23657 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
23658 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
23659 The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
23660
23661
23662 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
23663 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
23664 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
23665 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
23666 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
23667 addresses is not affected.
23668
23669 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
23670 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
23671 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
23672 Exim to use only the host name.
23673 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
23674
23675
23676 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
23677 .cindex "serializing connections"
23678 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
23679 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
23680 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
23681 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
23682 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
23683 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
23684 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
23685
23686 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
23687 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
23688 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
23689 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
23690 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
23691 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
23692
23693 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
23694 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
23695 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
23696 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
23697 are used for ETRN serialization.
23698
23699 .new
23700 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
23701 .wen
23702
23703
23704 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
23705 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
23706 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
23707 .cindex "size" "of message"
23708 .cindex "transport" "filter"
23709 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23710 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
23711 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
23712 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
23713 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
23714 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
23715 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
23716
23717 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
23718 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
23719
23720
23721 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
23722 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
23723 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
23724 .vindex "&$host$&"
23725 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23726 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
23727 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
23728 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
23729 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
23730 details of TLS.
23731
23732 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
23733 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
23734 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
23735 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
23736 client.
23737
23738
23739 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
23740 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
23741 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
23742 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
23743 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
23744
23745
23746 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
23747 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
23748 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
23749 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
23750 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
23751 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
23752 will fail.
23753
23754 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
23755
23756
23757 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
23758 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
23759 .vindex "&$host$&"
23760 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23761 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
23762 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
23763 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
23764 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23765 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
23766 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
23767 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23768
23769
23770 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
23771 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
23772 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
23773 .vindex "&$host$&"
23774 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23775 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
23776 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
23777 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
23778 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23779 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
23780 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
23781 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
23782 ciphers is a preference order.
23783
23784
23785
23786 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
23787 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
23788 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
23789 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
23790 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
23791 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
23792 certificate and private key for the session.
23793
23794 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
23795
23796 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
23797 TLS extensions.
23798
23799
23800
23801
23802 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
23803 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
23804 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
23805 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
23806 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
23807 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
23808 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
23809 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
23810 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
23811 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
23812 in clear.
23813
23814
23815 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
23816 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23817 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23818 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
23819 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
23820 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
23821 Note that unless the host is in this list
23822 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
23823 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
23824 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
23825 certificate verification succeeds.
23826
23827
23828 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
23829 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
23830 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23831 This option give a list of hosts for which,
23832 while verifying the server certificate,
23833 checks will be included on the host name
23834 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
23835 versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
23836 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
23837
23838 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
23839
23840
23841 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
23842 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23843 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23844 .vindex "&$host$&"
23845 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23846 The value of this option must be either the
23847 word "system"
23848 or the absolute path to
23849 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
23850 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
23851
23852 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
23853 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
23854 is taken as empty and an explicit location
23855 must be specified.
23856
23857 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
23858 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
23859
23860 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
23861 explicitly
23862 either by file or directory
23863 are added to those given by the system default location.
23864
23865 The values of &$host$& and
23866 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23867 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23868
23869 For back-compatibility,
23870 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
23871 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
23872 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
23873
23874
23875 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
23876 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23877 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23878 This option gives a list of hosts for which. on encrypted connections,
23879 certificate verification must succeed.
23880 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
23881 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
23882 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
23883
23884
23885
23886
23887 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
23888 "SECTvalhosmax"
23889 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
23890 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
23891 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
23892 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
23893 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
23894
23895
23896 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
23897 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
23898 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
23899 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
23900 retrying.
23901
23902 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
23903 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
23904 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
23905
23906 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
23907 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
23908 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
23909 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
23910 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
23911
23912 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
23913 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
23914 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
23915 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
23916 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
23917 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
23918 see below for an exception).
23919
23920 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
23921 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
23922 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
23923 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
23924 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
23925
23926 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
23927 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
23928 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
23929 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
23930 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
23931 reached their retry times.
23932
23933 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
23934 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
23935 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
23936 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
23937 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
23938 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
23939 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
23940 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
23941 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
23942 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
23943 reached.
23944
23945 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
23946 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
23947 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
23948 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
23949 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
23950 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
23951
23952 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
23953 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
23954 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
23955 possible IP addresses have been tried.
23956 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
23957 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
23958
23959
23960
23961
23962
23963 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23964 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23965
23966 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
23967 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
23968 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
23969 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
23970 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
23971 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
23972
23973 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
23974 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
23975 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
23976 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
23977 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
23978 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
23979 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
23980
23981 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
23982 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
23983 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
23984 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
23985
23986
23987 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
23988 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
23989 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
23990 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
23991
23992 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
23993 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
23994 facility; you do not have to use it.
23995
23996 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
23997 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
23998 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
23999 address to which it applies.
24000
24001 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
24002 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
24003 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
24004 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
24005 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
24006 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
24007 rules.
24008
24009 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
24010 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
24011 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
24012 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
24013
24014
24015 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
24016 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
24017 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
24018 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
24019 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
24020 discouraged.
24021
24022 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
24023 illustrated by these examples:
24024
24025 .ilist
24026 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
24027 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
24028 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
24029 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
24030 .next
24031 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
24032 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
24033 .endlist
24034
24035
24036
24037 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
24038 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
24039 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
24040 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
24041 message's processing.
24042
24043 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24044 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
24045 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
24046 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
24047 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
24048 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
24049 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
24050 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
24051 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
24052
24053 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24054 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24055 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
24056 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
24057 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
24058 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
24059 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
24060 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
24061 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
24062 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
24063
24064 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
24065 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
24066 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
24067 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
24068 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
24069 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
24070
24071 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
24072 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
24073 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
24074
24075 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
24076 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
24077 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
24078 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
24079 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
24080 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
24081 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
24082 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
24083 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
24084
24085 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
24086 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
24087 transport time.
24088
24089
24090
24091
24092 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
24093 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
24094 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
24095 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
24096 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
24097 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
24098 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
24099 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
24100 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
24101 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
24102 .code
24103 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
24104 .endd
24105 might produce the output
24106 .code
24107 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24108 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24109 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24110 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24111 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24112 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24113 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24114 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24115 .endd
24116 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
24117 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
24118 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
24119 set for a particular transport.
24120
24121
24122 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
24123 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
24124 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
24125 rules in the form
24126 .display
24127 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
24128 .endd
24129 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
24130 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
24131 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
24132 any colons must be doubled, of course).
24133
24134 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
24135 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
24136 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
24137 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
24138 ignored.
24139
24140 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
24141 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
24142 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
24143
24144 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
24145 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
24146 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
24147 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
24148 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
24149 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
24150 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
24151
24152 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24153 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24154 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
24155 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
24156 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
24157 .code
24158 *@* ${lookup ...
24159 .endd
24160 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
24161 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24162
24163
24164 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
24165 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
24166 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
24167 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
24168 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
24169 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
24170 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
24171 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
24172 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
24173
24174 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
24175 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
24176 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
24177
24178 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
24179 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
24180 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
24181 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
24182 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
24183 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
24184 of pattern they are set as follows:
24185
24186 .ilist
24187 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
24188 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
24189 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
24190 pattern
24191 .code
24192 *queen@*.fict.example
24193 .endd
24194 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
24195 .code
24196 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
24197 $1 = hearts-
24198 $2 = wonderland
24199 .endd
24200 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
24201 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
24202
24203 .next
24204 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
24205 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
24206 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
24207 rewriting rule of the form
24208 .display
24209 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
24210 .endd
24211 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
24212 .code
24213 $1 = foo
24214 $2 = bar
24215 $3 = baz.example
24216 .endd
24217 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
24218 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
24219 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
24220 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
24221 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
24222 .endlist
24223
24224
24225 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
24226 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
24227 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
24228 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
24229 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
24230 .code
24231 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
24232 .endd
24233 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
24234 &'From:'& headers.
24235
24236 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24237 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24238 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
24239 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
24240 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24241 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
24242 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
24243 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
24244 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
24245 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
24246 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
24247 entry written to the panic log.
24248
24249
24250
24251 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
24252 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
24253
24254 .ilist
24255 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
24256 c, f, h, r, s, t.
24257 .next
24258 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
24259 .next
24260 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
24261 .endlist
24262
24263 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
24264 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
24265
24266
24267
24268 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
24269 "SECID154"
24270 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
24271 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
24272 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
24273 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
24274 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
24275 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
24276 .display
24277 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
24278 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
24279 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
24280 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
24281 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
24282 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
24283 &`h`& rewrite all headers
24284 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
24285 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
24286 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
24287 .endd
24288 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
24289 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
24290 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
24291
24292 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
24293 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
24294
24295
24296 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
24297 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
24298 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
24299 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
24300 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
24301 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
24302 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
24303 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
24304 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
24305
24306 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24307 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24308 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
24309 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
24310 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
24311 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
24312 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
24313 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
24314
24315
24316 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
24317 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
24318 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
24319 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
24320
24321 .ilist
24322 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
24323 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
24324 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
24325 .next
24326 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
24327 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
24328 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
24329 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
24330 .next
24331 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
24332 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
24333 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
24334 .next
24335 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
24336 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
24337 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
24338 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
24339 .code
24340 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
24341 .endd
24342 into
24343 .code
24344 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
24345 .endd
24346 .cindex "RFC 2047"
24347 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
24348 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
24349 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
24350 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
24351 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
24352 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
24353 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
24354 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which defaults to ISO-8859-1.
24355
24356 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
24357 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
24358 .endlist
24359
24360
24361 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
24362 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
24363 .code
24364 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
24365 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
24366 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
24367 .endd
24368 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
24369 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
24370 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
24371 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
24372 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
24373 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
24374 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
24375 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
24376
24377 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
24378 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
24379 .code
24380 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
24381 .endd
24382 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
24383 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
24384
24385 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
24386 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
24387 messages that originate outside the local host:
24388 .code
24389 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
24390 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
24391 .endd
24392 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
24393 space.
24394
24395 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
24396 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
24397 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
24398 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
24399 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
24400 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
24401 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
24402 components. For example, the rule
24403 .code
24404 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
24405 .endd
24406 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
24407 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
24408 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
24409 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
24410 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
24411 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
24412 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
24413 .ecindex IIDaddrew
24414
24415
24416
24417
24418
24419 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24420 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24421
24422 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
24423 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
24424 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
24425 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
24426 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
24427 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
24428 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
24429 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
24430 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
24431 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
24432 address, domain and error.
24433
24434 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
24435 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
24436 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
24437 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
24438 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
24439 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
24440 log selector is set, the message
24441 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
24442 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
24443 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
24444 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
24445
24446 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
24447 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
24448 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
24449 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
24450 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
24451 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
24452 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
24453 domain are maintained independently.
24454
24455 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
24456 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
24457 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
24458 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
24459 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
24460 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
24461 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
24462 the local address is reached.
24463
24464 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
24465 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
24466 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
24467 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
24468 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
24469
24470 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
24471 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
24472 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
24473 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
24474 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
24475 messages that it should now be retaining.
24476
24477
24478
24479 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
24480 .cindex "retry" "rules"
24481 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
24482 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
24483 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
24484 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
24485 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
24486 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
24487 message's sender, respectively.
24488
24489
24490 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
24491 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
24492 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
24493 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
24494 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
24495 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
24496 example,
24497 .code
24498 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24499 .endd
24500 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
24501 whereas
24502 .code
24503 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24504 .endd
24505 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
24506 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
24507 part.
24508
24509 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
24510 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
24511 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
24512 expressions work in address lists.
24513 .display
24514 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
24515 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
24516 .endd
24517
24518
24519 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
24520 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
24521 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
24522 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
24523 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
24524 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
24525 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
24526 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
24527 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
24528
24529 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
24530 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
24531 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
24532 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
24533 local transports).
24534
24535 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
24536 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
24537 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
24538 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
24539 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
24540 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
24541 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
24542 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
24543 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
24544 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
24545 commands.
24546
24547
24548
24549 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
24550 "SECID160"
24551 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
24552 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
24553 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
24554 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
24555 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
24556 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
24557 .code
24558 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
24559 MX 6 p.q.r.example
24560 MX 7 m.n.o.example
24561 .endd
24562 and the retry rules are
24563 .code
24564 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
24565 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
24566 .endd
24567 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
24568 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
24569 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
24570 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
24571 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
24572 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
24573
24574 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
24575 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
24576 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
24577 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
24578
24579 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
24580 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
24581 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
24582 .code
24583 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
24584 .endd
24585 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
24586 textual form of the IP address.
24587
24588 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
24589 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
24590 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
24591 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
24592
24593 .vlist
24594 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
24595 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
24596 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
24597
24598 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
24599 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
24600 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
24601
24602 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
24603 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
24604
24605 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
24606 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
24607 .endlist
24608
24609 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
24610 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
24611 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
24612 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
24613 retry rule of this form:
24614 .code
24615 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
24616 .endd
24617 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
24618 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
24619
24620 .vlist
24621 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
24622 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
24623 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
24624 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
24625
24626 .vitem &%lookup%&
24627 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
24628 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
24629 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
24630 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
24631 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
24632
24633 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
24634 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
24635
24636 .vitem &%refused_A%&
24637 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
24638
24639 .vitem &%refused%&
24640 A connection was refused.
24641
24642 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
24643 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
24644
24645 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
24646 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
24647
24648 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
24649 A connection attempt timed out.
24650
24651 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
24652 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
24653 obtained from an MX record.
24654
24655 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
24656 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
24657 obtained from an MX record.
24658
24659 .vitem &%timeout%&
24660 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
24661
24662 .vitem &%tls_required%&
24663 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
24664 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
24665 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
24666
24667 .vitem &%quota%&
24668 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
24669 transport.
24670
24671 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
24672 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
24673 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
24674 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
24675 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
24676 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
24677 for four days.
24678 .endlist
24679
24680 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
24681 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
24682 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
24683 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
24684 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
24685 heuristic rules:
24686
24687 .ilist
24688 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
24689 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
24690 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
24691 .next
24692 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
24693 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
24694 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
24695 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
24696 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
24697 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
24698 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
24699 .next
24700 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
24701 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
24702 .endlist
24703
24704 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
24705 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
24706 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
24707 error).
24708
24709
24710
24711 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
24712 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
24713 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
24714 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
24715 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
24716 form:
24717 .display
24718 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
24719 .endd
24720 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
24721 .code
24722 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
24723 .endd
24724 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
24725 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
24726 For example:
24727 .code
24728 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
24729 .endd
24730 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
24731 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
24732 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
24733 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
24734 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
24735
24736 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
24737 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
24738 .code
24739 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
24740 .endd
24741 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
24742 list is never matched.
24743
24744
24745
24746
24747
24748 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
24749 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
24750 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
24751 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
24752 .display
24753 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
24754 .endd
24755 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
24756 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
24757 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
24758 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
24759 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
24760
24761 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
24762 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
24763 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
24764 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
24765 The available algorithms are:
24766
24767 .ilist
24768 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
24769 the interval.
24770 .next
24771 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
24772 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
24773 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
24774 .next
24775 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
24776 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
24777 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
24778 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
24779 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
24780 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
24781 queue processing times.
24782 .endlist
24783
24784 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
24785 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
24786 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
24787 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
24788 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
24789 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
24790 interval is found. The main configuration variable
24791 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
24792 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
24793 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
24794 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
24795 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
24796
24797 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
24798 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
24799 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
24800 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
24801 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
24802 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
24803 time.
24804
24805 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
24806 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
24807 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
24808 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
24809 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
24810 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
24811 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
24812 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
24813 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
24814 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
24815 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
24816 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
24817
24818 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
24819 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
24820 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
24821 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
24822 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
24823 deliveries that have been deferred.
24824
24825
24826 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
24827 Here are some example retry rules:
24828 .code
24829 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
24830 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
24831 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
24832 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24833 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
24834 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
24835 .endd
24836 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
24837 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
24838 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
24839 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
24840 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
24841 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
24842 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
24843 days.
24844
24845 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
24846 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
24847 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
24848 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
24849 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
24850
24851 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
24852 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
24853 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
24854 were not obtained from an MX record.
24855
24856 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
24857 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
24858 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
24859 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
24860 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
24861
24862
24863
24864 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
24865 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
24866 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
24867 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
24868 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
24869 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
24870 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
24871 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
24872 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
24873 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
24874 failing for the first time.
24875
24876 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
24877 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
24878 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
24879 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
24880
24881 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
24882 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
24883 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
24884
24885
24886
24887
24888 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
24889 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
24890 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
24891 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
24892 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
24893 default retry rule:
24894 .code
24895 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
24896 .endd
24897 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
24898 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
24899 failure for the recipient address that counts.
24900
24901 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
24902 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
24903 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
24904 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
24905 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
24906
24907 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
24908 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
24909 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
24910
24911 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
24912 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
24913 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
24914 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
24915 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
24916 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
24917 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
24918 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
24919
24920 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
24921 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
24922 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
24923 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
24924 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
24925 notice.
24926
24927 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
24928 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
24929 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
24930 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
24931 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
24932 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
24933 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
24934 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
24935 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
24936 true.
24937
24938 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
24939 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
24940 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
24941 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
24942 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
24943 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
24944 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
24945 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
24946 reached.
24947
24948 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
24949 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
24950 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
24951 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
24952 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
24953 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
24954 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
24955 time out the address.
24956
24957 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
24958 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
24959 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
24960 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
24961 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
24962 considered immediately.
24963 .ecindex IIDretconf1
24964 .ecindex IIDregconf2
24965
24966
24967
24968
24969
24970
24971 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24972 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24973
24974 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
24975 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
24976 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
24977 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
24978 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
24979 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
24980 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
24981 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
24982 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
24983 other.
24984
24985 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
24986 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
24987
24988 .ilist
24989 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
24990 the client's EHLO command.
24991 .next
24992 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
24993 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
24994 .next
24995 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
24996 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
24997 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
24998 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
24999 with the AUTH command.
25000 .next
25001 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
25002 .next
25003 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
25004 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
25005 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
25006 connection.
25007 .next
25008 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
25009 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
25010 unauthenticated connection.
25011 .endlist
25012
25013 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
25014 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
25015 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
25016 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
25017 .display
25018 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
25019 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
25020 &`Connected to server.example.`&
25021 &`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
25022 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
25023 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
25024 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
25025 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
25026 &`250-PIPELINING`&
25027 &`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
25028 &`250 HELP`&
25029 .endd
25030 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
25031 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
25032 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
25033 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
25034 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
25035 included by setting
25036 .code
25037 AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
25038 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
25039 AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
25040 AUTH_GSASL=yes
25041 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
25042 AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
25043 AUTH_SPA=yes
25044 AUTH_TLS=yes
25045 .endd
25046 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
25047 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
25048 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
25049 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
25050 work via a socket interface.
25051 The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
25052 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
25053 The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
25054 supporting setting a server keytab.
25055 The sixth can be configured to support
25056 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
25057 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
25058 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
25059 The eighth is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
25060 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
25061
25062 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
25063 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
25064 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
25065 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
25066 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
25067 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
25068 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
25069
25070 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
25071 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
25072 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
25073 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
25074 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
25075 both sets of options, is required. For example:
25076 .code
25077 cram:
25078 driver = cram_md5
25079 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25080 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
25081 client_name = ph10
25082 client_secret = secret2
25083 .endd
25084 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
25085 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
25086
25087 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
25088 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
25089 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
25090 in Exim.
25091
25092 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
25093 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
25094 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
25095 authenticating data.
25096
25097 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
25098 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
25099 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
25100 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
25101 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
25102 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
25103 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
25104 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
25105 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
25106 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
25107 choose to honour.
25108
25109 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
25110 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
25111 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
25112 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
25113
25114
25115
25116 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
25117 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
25118 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
25119
25120 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25121 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
25122 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
25123 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
25124 encrypted by a setting such as:
25125 .code
25126 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
25127 .endd
25128
25129
25130 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25131 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
25132 result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
25133 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
25134
25135
25136 .option driver authenticators string unset
25137 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
25138 authenticators is to be used.
25139
25140
25141 .option public_name authenticators string unset
25142 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
25143 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
25144 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
25145 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
25146 defaults to the driver's instance name.
25147
25148
25149 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25150 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
25151 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
25152 mechanism is not advertised.
25153 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
25154 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
25155 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
25156
25157
25158 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25159 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
25160 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
25161 for details.
25162
25163 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
25164 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
25165
25166 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
25167 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
25168 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
25169 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
25170 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
25171 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
25172 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25173 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
25174 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
25175 the error text.
25176
25177
25178 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
25179 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
25180 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
25181 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
25182 out the values of variables.
25183 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
25184 output, and Exim carries on processing.
25185
25186
25187 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25188 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25189 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
25190 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
25191 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
25192 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
25193 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
25194 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
25195 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
25196
25197
25198 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25199 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
25200 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
25201 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
25202 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
25203 remembered for later use.
25204 How it is used is described in the following section.
25205
25206
25207
25208
25209
25210 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
25211 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
25212 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
25213 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
25214 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
25215 message:
25216
25217 .ilist
25218 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
25219 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
25220 .next
25221 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
25222 .next
25223 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
25224 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
25225 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
25226 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
25227 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
25228 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
25229 given for the MAIL command.
25230 .next
25231 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
25232 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
25233 authenticated.
25234 .next
25235 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
25236 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
25237 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
25238 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
25239 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
25240 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
25241 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
25242 message.
25243 .endlist
25244
25245
25246 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
25247 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
25248 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
25249 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
25250
25251 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
25252 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
25253 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
25254 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
25255 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
25256 ACL is run.
25257
25258
25259
25260 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
25261 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
25262 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
25263 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
25264 conditions:
25265
25266 .ilist
25267 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
25268 .next
25269 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
25270 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
25271 .endlist
25272
25273 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
25274 the mechanisms are advertised.
25275
25276 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
25277 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
25278 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
25279 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
25280 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
25281 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
25282 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
25283 .code
25284 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
25285 .endd
25286 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
25287
25288 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
25289 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
25290 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
25291 such as:
25292 .code
25293 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
25294 .endd
25295 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
25296 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
25297 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
25298
25299 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
25300 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
25301 command. This is the case if
25302
25303 .ilist
25304 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
25305 .next
25306 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
25307 .next
25308 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
25309 server authenticators.
25310 .endlist
25311
25312
25313 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
25314 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
25315 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
25316
25317 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
25318 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
25319 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
25320 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
25321 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
25322 rejected with a 504 error.
25323
25324 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
25325 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
25326 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
25327 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
25328 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
25329 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
25330 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
25331 no successful authentication.
25332
25333
25334
25335
25336 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
25337 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
25338 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
25339 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
25340 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
25341 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
25342 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
25343 script:
25344 .code
25345 use MIME::Base64;
25346 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
25347 .endd
25348 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
25349 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
25350 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
25351 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
25352 command line to run this script on such data might be
25353 .code
25354 encode '\0user\0password'
25355 .endd
25356 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
25357 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
25358 whose code value is zero.
25359
25360 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
25361 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
25362 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
25363 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
25364
25365 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
25366 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
25367 example, a command such as
25368 .code
25369 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
25370 .endd
25371 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
25372
25373 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
25374 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
25375 .code
25376 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
25377 .endd
25378 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
25379 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
25380 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
25381 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
25382
25383
25384
25385 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
25386 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
25387 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
25388 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
25389 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
25390 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
25391
25392 .ilist
25393 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
25394 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
25395 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
25396 of the authenticator.
25397 .next
25398 .vindex "&$host$&"
25399 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25400 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
25401 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
25402 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
25403 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
25404 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
25405 delivery to be deferred.
25406 .next
25407 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
25408 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
25409 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
25410 usual way.
25411 .next
25412 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
25413 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
25414 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
25415 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
25416 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
25417 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
25418 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
25419 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
25420 deliver the message unauthenticated.
25421 .endlist
25422
25423 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
25424 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
25425 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
25426 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
25427 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
25428 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
25429 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
25430 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
25431 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
25432 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
25433 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
25434 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
25435 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
25436
25437
25438
25439
25440
25441
25442 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25443 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25444
25445 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
25446 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
25447 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
25448 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
25449 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
25450 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
25451 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
25452 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
25453 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
25454 connections as you do for login accounts.
25455
25456 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
25457 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
25458 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
25459
25460 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25461 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
25462 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
25463
25464 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
25465 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
25466 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
25467 given.
25468
25469 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
25470 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25471 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25472 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
25473 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25474 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
25475 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25476
25477 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
25478 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
25479 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
25480 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
25481 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
25482 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
25483 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
25484
25485 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
25486 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
25487 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
25488 string expansions that also use them for other things.
25489
25490 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
25491 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
25492 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
25493
25494 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25495 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
25496 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
25497 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
25498 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
25499 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25500 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
25501 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
25502 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
25503 string as the error text
25504
25505 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
25506 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
25507 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
25508
25509
25510
25511 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
25512 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
25513 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
25514 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25515 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
25516 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
25517 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
25518 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
25519
25520 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
25521 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
25522 configured as follows:
25523 .code
25524 fixed_plain:
25525 driver = plaintext
25526 public_name = PLAIN
25527 server_prompts = :
25528 server_condition = \
25529 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
25530 server_set_id = $auth2
25531 .endd
25532 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
25533 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
25534 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
25535 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
25536
25537 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
25538 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
25539 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
25540 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
25541 .code
25542 250-AUTH PLAIN
25543 .endd
25544 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
25545 .code
25546 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
25547 .endd
25548 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
25549 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
25550 .code
25551 AUTH PLAIN
25552 .endd
25553 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
25554 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
25555
25556 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
25557 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
25558 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
25559 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
25560 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
25561
25562 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
25563 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
25564 authenticating clients it could make sense.
25565
25566 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
25567 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
25568 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
25569 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
25570 This is an incorrect example:
25571 .code
25572 server_condition = \
25573 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
25574 .endd
25575 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
25576 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
25577 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
25578 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
25579 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
25580 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
25581 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
25582 .code
25583 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
25584 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
25585 .endd
25586 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
25587 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
25588 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
25589 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
25590 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
25591
25592
25593 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
25594 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
25595 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
25596 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
25597 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
25598 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
25599 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
25600 .code
25601 fixed_login:
25602 driver = plaintext
25603 public_name = LOGIN
25604 server_prompts = User Name : Password
25605 server_condition = \
25606 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
25607 server_set_id = $auth1
25608 .endd
25609 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
25610 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
25611 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
25612 strings are used to obtain two data items.
25613
25614 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
25615 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
25616 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
25617 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
25618 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
25619 .code
25620 login:
25621 driver = plaintext
25622 public_name = LOGIN
25623 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
25624 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
25625 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
25626 ldapauth{\
25627 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
25628 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
25629 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
25630 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
25631 .endd
25632 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
25633 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
25634 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
25635 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
25636 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
25637 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
25638 uninterpreted string.
25639
25640
25641 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
25642 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
25643 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
25644 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
25645 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
25646 &<<SECTexpcond>>&.
25647
25648
25649
25650
25651 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
25652 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
25653 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
25654
25655 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
25656 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
25657 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
25658 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
25659 usual.
25660
25661 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
25662 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
25663 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
25664 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
25665 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
25666 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
25667 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
25668 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
25669 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
25670 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
25671 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
25672 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
25673
25674 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
25675 splitting takes priority and happens first.
25676
25677 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
25678 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
25679 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
25680 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
25681 the string.
25682
25683 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
25684 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
25685 .code
25686 fixed_plain:
25687 driver = plaintext
25688 public_name = PLAIN
25689 client_send = ^username^mysecret
25690 .endd
25691 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
25692 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
25693 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
25694 .code
25695 fixed_login:
25696 driver = plaintext
25697 public_name = LOGIN
25698 client_send = : username : mysecret
25699 .endd
25700 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
25701 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
25702 prompts.
25703 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
25704 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
25705
25706
25707
25708
25709 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25710 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25711
25712 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
25713 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
25714 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
25715 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
25716 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
25717 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
25718 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
25719 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
25720 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
25721 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
25722 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
25723 available in plain text at either end.
25724
25725
25726 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
25727 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
25728 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
25729 authenticator as a server:
25730
25731 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
25732 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
25733 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
25734 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
25735 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
25736 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
25737 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
25738 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
25739 returned to the client.
25740
25741 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
25742 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
25743 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
25744 numeric variables for other things.
25745
25746 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
25747 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
25748 user name, authentication fails.
25749 .code
25750 fixed_cram:
25751 driver = cram_md5
25752 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25753 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
25754 server_set_id = $auth1
25755 .endd
25756 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25757 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
25758 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
25759 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
25760 .code
25761 lookup_cram:
25762 driver = cram_md5
25763 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25764 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
25765 {$value}fail}
25766 server_set_id = $auth1
25767 .endd
25768 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
25769 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
25770
25771 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
25772 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
25773 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
25774 realm, with:
25775 .code
25776 cyrusless_crammd5:
25777 driver = cram_md5
25778 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25779 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
25780 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
25781 server_set_id = $auth1
25782 .endd
25783
25784 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
25785 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
25786 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
25787
25788
25789
25790 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
25791 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
25792 computing the response to the server's challenge.
25793
25794
25795 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
25796 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
25797 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
25798
25799
25800 .vindex "&$host$&"
25801 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25802 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
25803 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
25804 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
25805 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
25806 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
25807 send the message to the current server.
25808
25809 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
25810 strings, is:
25811 .code
25812 fixed_cram:
25813 driver = cram_md5
25814 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25815 client_name = ph10
25816 client_secret = secret
25817 .endd
25818 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
25819 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
25820
25821
25822
25823 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25824 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25825
25826 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
25827 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
25828 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
25829 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
25830 .cindex "Kerberos"
25831 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
25832 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
25833
25834 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
25835 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
25836 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
25837 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
25838 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
25839
25840 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
25841 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
25842 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
25843 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
25844
25845 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
25846 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
25847 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
25848 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
25849 depending on the driver you are using.
25850
25851 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
25852 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
25853 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
25854 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
25855 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
25856 implementation.
25857
25858 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
25859 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
25860 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
25861 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
25862 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
25863 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
25864 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
25865 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
25866
25867
25868 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
25869 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
25870 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
25871 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
25872 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
25873 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
25874 things.
25875
25876
25877 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
25878 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
25879 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
25880 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
25881
25882
25883 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
25884 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
25885 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
25886 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
25887 example:
25888 .code
25889 sasl:
25890 driver = cyrus_sasl
25891 public_name = X-ANYTHING
25892 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
25893 server_set_id = $auth1
25894 .endd
25895
25896 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
25897 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
25898
25899
25900 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
25901 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
25902
25903
25904 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
25905 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
25906 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
25907 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
25908 .code
25909 sasl_cram_md5:
25910 driver = cyrus_sasl
25911 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25912 server_set_id = $auth1
25913
25914 sasl_plain:
25915 driver = cyrus_sasl
25916 public_name = PLAIN
25917 server_set_id = $auth2
25918 .endd
25919 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
25920 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
25921 but it is present in many binary distributions.
25922 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
25923 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
25924
25925
25926
25927
25928 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25929 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25930 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
25931 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
25932 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
25933 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
25934 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
25935 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
25936 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
25937 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
25938 authenticator only. There is only one option:
25939
25940 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
25941
25942 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
25943 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
25944 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
25945 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
25946 .code
25947 dovecot_plain:
25948 driver = dovecot
25949 public_name = PLAIN
25950 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
25951 server_set_id = $auth1
25952
25953 dovecot_ntlm:
25954 driver = dovecot
25955 public_name = NTLM
25956 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
25957 server_set_id = $auth1
25958 .endd
25959 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
25960 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
25961 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
25962 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
25963 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
25964 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
25965 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
25966 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
25967
25968
25969 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25970 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25971 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
25972 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
25973 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
25974 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
25975 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
25976 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
25977 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
25978 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
25979 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
25980 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
25981 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
25982 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
25983 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
25984 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
25985 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
25986 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
25987 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
25988 without code changes in Exim.
25989
25990
25991 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
25992 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
25993 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
25994 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
25995 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
25996 context.
25997
25998 This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
25999 as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
26000 see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
26001
26002 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
26003 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
26004 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
26005
26006 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
26007 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
26008 of Exim may switch the default to be true.
26009
26010
26011 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
26012 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26013 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26014 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26015
26016
26017 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
26018 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26019 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26020 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26021 example:
26022 .code
26023 sasl:
26024 driver = gsasl
26025 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26026 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26027 server_set_id = $auth1
26028 .endd
26029
26030
26031 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
26032 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
26033 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
26034 the password itself.
26035
26036 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
26037 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
26038 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
26039 if available, else the empty string.
26040 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
26041 else the empty string.
26042
26043 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
26044
26045 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
26046 option to be simply "true".
26047
26048
26049 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
26050 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26051 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26052
26053
26054 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
26055 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26056 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26057 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26058
26059
26060 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
26061 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26062 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26063 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26064
26065
26066 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
26067 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26068 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26069
26070
26071 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
26072 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26073 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
26074 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
26075
26076 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
26077 meanings for these variables:
26078
26079 .ilist
26080 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
26081 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
26082 .next
26083 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
26084 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
26085 .next
26086 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
26087 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
26088 .endlist
26089
26090 On a per-mechanism basis:
26091
26092 .ilist
26093 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26094 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
26095 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26096 .next
26097 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26098 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
26099 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26100 .next
26101 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26102 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
26103 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
26104 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26105 .endlist
26106
26107 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
26108 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
26109 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
26110
26111
26112 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
26113 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
26114 .code
26115 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
26116 driver = gsasl
26117 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26118 server_realm = imap.example.org
26119 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
26120 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26121 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
26122 server_condition = yes
26123 .endd
26124
26125
26126 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26127 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26128
26129 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
26130 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
26131 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
26132 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26133 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
26134 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
26135 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
26136 reliably.
26137
26138 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
26139 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
26140 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
26141 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26142
26143 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
26144 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
26145 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
26146 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
26147
26148 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
26149 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
26150 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
26151 from the keytab.
26152
26153
26154 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
26155 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
26156 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
26157 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
26158
26159 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
26160 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
26161 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
26162 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
26163
26164 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26165 .ilist
26166 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
26167 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
26168 .next
26169 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
26170 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
26171 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
26172 GSS Display Name.
26173 .endlist
26174
26175
26176 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26177 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26178
26179 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
26180 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
26181 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
26182 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
26183 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
26184 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
26185 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
26186 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
26187 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
26188 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
26189 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
26190 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
26191 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
26192 follows:
26193
26194 .ilist
26195 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
26196 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
26197 .next
26198 The server sends back a challenge.
26199 .next
26200 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
26201 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
26202 .endlist
26203
26204 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
26205
26206
26207
26208 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
26209 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
26210 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
26211
26212 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
26213 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
26214 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
26215 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
26216 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
26217 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
26218 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
26219 for other things. For example:
26220 .code
26221 spa:
26222 driver = spa
26223 public_name = NTLM
26224 server_password = \
26225 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
26226 .endd
26227 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
26228 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
26229
26230
26231
26232
26233
26234 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
26235 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
26236 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
26237
26238
26239
26240 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
26241 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
26242
26243
26244 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
26245 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
26246
26247
26248 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
26249 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
26250 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
26251 &'msn.com'&:
26252 .code
26253 msn:
26254 driver = spa
26255 public_name = MSN
26256 client_username = msn/msn_username
26257 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
26258 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
26259 .endd
26260 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
26261 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
26262
26263
26264
26265
26266
26267 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26268 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26269
26270 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
26271 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
26272 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
26273 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
26274 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
26275 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
26276 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
26277 authentication based on client certificates.
26278
26279 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
26280 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
26281 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
26282 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
26283 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
26284 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
26285
26286 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
26287 for which it must have been requested via the
26288 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
26289 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
26290
26291 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
26292 run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
26293 and can authenticate the connection.
26294 If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
26295
26296 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
26297
26298
26299 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
26300 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
26301
26302 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
26303 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
26304 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
26305 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
26306 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
26307 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
26308
26309 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
26310 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
26311 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
26312
26313 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
26314
26315
26316 Example:
26317 .code
26318 tls:
26319 driver = tls
26320 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
26321 {$tls_in_peercert}}
26322 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth1} \
26323 {!= {0} \
26324 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
26325 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
26326 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
26327 } } } }
26328 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
26329 .endd
26330 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
26331 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
26332
26333
26334 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
26335 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
26336 a connect- or helo-ACL.
26337
26338
26339
26340 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26341 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26342
26343 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
26344 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
26345 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
26346 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
26347 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
26348 .cindex "OpenSSL"
26349 .cindex "GnuTLS"
26350 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
26351 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
26352 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
26353 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
26354 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
26355 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
26356 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
26357 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
26358 certificates are used.
26359
26360 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
26361 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
26362 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
26363 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
26364 between them is encrypted.
26365
26366 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
26367 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
26368 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
26369 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
26370 encryption state.
26371
26372 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
26373 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
26374 in order to get TLS to work.
26375
26376
26377
26378 .section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
26379 "SECID284"
26380 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
26381 .cindex "smtps protocol"
26382 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
26383 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
26384 Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
26385 SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
26386 waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
26387 port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
26388 allocated for this purpose.
26389
26390 This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
26391 still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
26392 the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
26393 numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
26394 .code
26395 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
26396 .endd
26397 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
26398 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
26399 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
26400 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
26401 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
26402 defined elsewhere.
26403
26404 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
26405 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
26406
26407
26408
26409
26410
26411
26412 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
26413 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
26414 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
26415 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
26416 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
26417 .code
26418 USE_GNUTLS=yes
26419 .endd
26420 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
26421 .code
26422 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
26423 .endd
26424 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
26425 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
26426
26427 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
26428
26429 .ilist
26430 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
26431 cannot be the path of a directory
26432 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
26433 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
26434 .next
26435 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
26436 .next
26437 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
26438 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
26439 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
26440 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
26441 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
26442 .next
26443 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
26444 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
26445 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
26446 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
26447 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
26448 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
26449 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
26450 option).
26451 .next
26452 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
26453 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
26454 .next
26455 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
26456 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
26457 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
26458 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
26459 .next
26460 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
26461 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
26462 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
26463 implementation, then patches are welcome.
26464 .endlist
26465
26466
26467 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
26468 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
26469 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
26470 but not the chosen filename.
26471 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
26472 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
26473
26474 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
26475 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
26476 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
26477 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
26478 of bits requested.
26479 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
26480 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
26481 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
26482 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
26483 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
26484 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
26485 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
26486
26487 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
26488 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
26489 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
26490 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
26491 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
26492
26493 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
26494 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
26495 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
26496 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
26497 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
26498 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
26499
26500 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
26501 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
26502 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
26503
26504 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
26505 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
26506 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
26507 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
26508 .code
26509 # ls
26510 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
26511 # rm -f new-params
26512 # touch new-params
26513 # chown exim:exim new-params
26514 # chmod 0600 new-params
26515 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
26516 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
26517 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
26518 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
26519 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
26520 # chmod 0400 new-params
26521 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
26522 .endd
26523 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
26524 stalling is removed.
26525
26526 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
26527 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
26528 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
26529 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
26530 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
26531 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
26532 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
26533 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
26534 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
26535 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
26536 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
26537
26538 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
26539 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
26540 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
26541 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
26542
26543 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
26544 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
26545 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
26546 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
26547 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
26548
26549
26550 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
26551 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
26552 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
26553 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
26554 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
26555 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
26556 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
26557 directly to this function call.
26558 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
26559 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
26560 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
26561 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
26562
26563 .ilist
26564 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
26565 .next
26566 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
26567 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
26568 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
26569 SSL v3 algorithms.
26570 .next
26571 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
26572 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
26573 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
26574 algorithms.
26575 .endlist
26576
26577 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
26578 &`-`& or &`+`&.
26579 .ilist
26580 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
26581 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
26582 stated.
26583 .next
26584 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
26585 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
26586 .next
26587 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
26588 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
26589 .endlist
26590
26591 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
26592 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
26593 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
26594 not be moved to the end of the list.
26595 .endlist
26596
26597 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
26598 string:
26599 .code
26600 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
26601 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
26602 .endd
26603
26604 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
26605 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
26606 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
26607 choice of clients used:
26608 .code
26609 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
26610 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
26611 {DEFAULT}\
26612 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
26613 .endd
26614
26615
26616
26617 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
26618 "SECTreqciphgnu"
26619 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
26620 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
26621 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
26622 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
26623 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
26624 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
26625 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
26626 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
26627 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
26628 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
26629
26630 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
26631 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
26632
26633 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
26634 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
26635 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
26636 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
26637 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
26638 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
26639
26640 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
26641 "Priority strings". This is online as
26642 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
26643 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
26644 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
26645 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string, then the example code)
26646 on that site can be used to test a given string.
26647
26648 For example:
26649 .code
26650 # Disable older versions of protocols
26651 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
26652 .endd
26653
26654 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
26655 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
26656 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
26657
26658 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
26659 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
26660 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
26661 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
26662 used:
26663 .code
26664 # GnuTLS variant
26665 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
26666 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
26667 {SECURE128}}
26668 .endd
26669
26670
26671 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
26672 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
26673 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
26674 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
26675 but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
26676 that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
26677 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available, and also it is
26678 sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
26679
26680 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
26681 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
26682 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
26683 with the error
26684 .code
26685 554 Security failure
26686 .endd
26687 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
26688 rejected with a 554 error code.
26689
26690 To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set &%tls_advertise_hosts%& to
26691 match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to * to match all hosts.
26692 However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
26693 without some further configuration at the server end.
26694
26695 It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
26696 encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
26697 .code
26698 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
26699 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
26700 .endd
26701 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
26702 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
26703 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
26704 that goes with it. These files need to be
26705 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
26706 always be given as full path names.
26707 The key must not be password-protected.
26708 They can be the same file if both the
26709 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
26710 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
26711 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
26712 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
26713 the server's certificate.
26714
26715 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
26716 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
26717 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
26718
26719 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
26720 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
26721 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
26722 transport.
26723
26724 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
26725 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
26726 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
26727 .code
26728 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
26729 .endd
26730 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
26731 with the parameters contained in the file.
26732 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
26733 available:
26734 .code
26735 tls_dhparam = none
26736 .endd
26737 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
26738 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
26739 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
26740 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
26741
26742 See the command
26743 .code
26744 openssl dhparam
26745 .endd
26746 for a way of generating file data.
26747
26748 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
26749 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
26750 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
26751 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
26752 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
26753
26754 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
26755 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
26756 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
26757 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
26758 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
26759 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
26760 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
26761 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
26762 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
26763
26764 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
26765 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
26766 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
26767 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
26768 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
26769 documentation for more details.
26770
26771 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
26772 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
26773
26774
26775 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
26776 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
26777 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
26778 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
26779 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
26780 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
26781 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
26782 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
26783 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
26784 expected certificates.
26785 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
26786 an explicit file or,
26787 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
26788 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
26789
26790 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
26791 directory is used
26792 (OpenSSL only),
26793 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
26794 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
26795 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
26796 .code
26797 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
26798 .endd
26799 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
26800
26801 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
26802 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
26803 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
26804 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
26805 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
26806 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
26807 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
26808 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
26809 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
26810 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
26811
26812 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
26813 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
26814 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
26815 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
26816
26817 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
26818 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
26819 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
26820 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
26821 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
26822 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
26823
26824
26825 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
26826 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
26827 .cindex "revocation list"
26828 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
26829 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
26830 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
26831 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
26832 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
26833 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
26834 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
26835 CRL in PEM format.
26836 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
26837 file from every certificate authority they know of.
26838
26839 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
26840 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
26841 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
26842 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
26843 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
26844 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
26845
26846 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
26847 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
26848 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
26849 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
26850
26851 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
26852 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
26853 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
26854 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
26855 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
26856 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
26857 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
26858 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
26859
26860 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
26861 .new
26862 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
26863 .wen
26864 support for OCSP stapling is included.
26865
26866 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
26867 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
26868 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
26869 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
26870 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
26871
26872 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
26873 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
26874 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
26875 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
26876 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
26877 next connection.
26878
26879 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
26880 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
26881 ignored.
26882
26883 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
26884 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
26885 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
26886 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
26887 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
26888 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
26889
26890 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
26891 not any of the chain from CA to it.
26892
26893 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
26894
26895 .code
26896 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
26897 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
26898 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
26899
26900 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
26901 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
26902 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
26903 .endd
26904
26905
26906
26907
26908 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
26909 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
26910 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
26911 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
26912 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
26913 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
26914 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
26915 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
26916 within the &(smtp)& transport.
26917
26918 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
26919 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
26920 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
26921 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
26922 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
26923
26924 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
26925 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
26926 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
26927 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
26928 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
26929 usual way.
26930
26931 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
26932 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
26933 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
26934 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
26935 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
26936 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
26937 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
26938 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
26939 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
26940 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
26941 unencrypted.
26942
26943 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
26944 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
26945 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
26946 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
26947
26948 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
26949 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
26950 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
26951 a file or,
26952 depending on library version, a directory,
26953 must name a file or,
26954 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory.
26955 The client verifies the server's certificate
26956 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
26957 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
26958 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
26959 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
26960
26961 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
26962 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
26963 or need not succeed respectively.
26964
26965 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
26966 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
26967 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
26968 value is empty.
26969 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
26970 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
26971 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
26972 otherwise.
26973
26974 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
26975 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
26976 for OCSP to be relevant.
26977
26978 If
26979 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
26980 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
26981 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
26982 alternative hosts, if any.
26983
26984 &*Note*&:
26985 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
26986 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
26987 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
26988 client.
26989
26990 .vindex "&$host$&"
26991 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26992 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
26993 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
26994 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
26995 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
26996
26997 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
26998 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
26999 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
27000 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
27001 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
27002 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
27003 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
27004 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
27005 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
27006 outgoing connection.
27007
27008
27009
27010 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
27011 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
27012 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
27013 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
27014 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
27015 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
27016 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
27017 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
27018 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
27019 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
27020 for this session.
27021
27022 This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
27023 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
27024 address.
27025
27026 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
27027 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
27028 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
27029 be of limited use in that environment.
27030
27031 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
27032 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
27033 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
27034 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
27035 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
27036
27037 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
27038 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
27039 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
27040 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
27041 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
27042
27043 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
27044 received from a client.
27045 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
27046
27047 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
27048 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
27049 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
27050
27051 .ilist
27052 .vindex "&%tls_certificate%&"
27053 &%tls_certificate%&
27054 .next
27055 .vindex "&%tls_crl%&"
27056 &%tls_crl%&
27057 .next
27058 .vindex "&%tls_privatekey%&"
27059 &%tls_privatekey%&
27060 .next
27061 .vindex "&%tls_verify_certificates%&"
27062 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
27063 .next
27064 .vindex "&%tls_ocsp_file%&"
27065 &%tls_ocsp_file%&
27066 .endlist
27067
27068 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
27069 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
27070 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_sni$& is
27071 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
27072
27073 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
27074 are re-expanded.
27075
27076 When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
27077 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
27078 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
27079 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
27080
27081 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
27082 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
27083 built, then you have SNI support).
27084
27085
27086
27087 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
27088 "SECTmulmessam"
27089 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
27090 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
27091 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
27092 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
27093 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
27094 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
27095 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
27096 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
27097 session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
27098 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
27099 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
27100
27101 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
27102 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
27103 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
27104 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
27105 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
27106 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
27107 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
27108 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
27109 and delay other deliveries to that host.
27110
27111 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
27112 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
27113 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
27114 information is recorded.
27115
27116 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
27117 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
27118 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
27119
27120
27121
27122
27123 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
27124 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
27125 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
27126 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
27127 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
27128 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
27129 to Apache, currently at
27130 .display
27131 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
27132 .endd
27133 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
27134 links to further files.
27135 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
27136 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
27137 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
27138 .display
27139 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
27140 .endd
27141
27142
27143 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
27144 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
27145 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
27146 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
27147 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
27148 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
27149 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
27150 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
27151 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
27152 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
27153 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
27154 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
27155 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
27156
27157 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
27158 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
27159 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
27160 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
27161
27162
27163
27164 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
27165 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
27166 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
27167 with OpenSSL, like this:
27168 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
27169 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
27170 .code
27171 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
27172 -days 9999 -nodes
27173 .endd
27174 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
27175 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
27176 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
27177 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
27178 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
27179 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
27180 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
27181
27182 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
27183 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
27184 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
27185 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
27186 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
27187 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
27188 . ==== -pdp, 2012
27189 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
27190 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
27191 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
27192 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
27193 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
27194 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
27195 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
27196 be a sensible resolution).
27197
27198 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
27199 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
27200 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
27201
27202 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
27203 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
27204 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
27205 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
27206 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
27207 signed with that self-signed certificate.
27208
27209 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
27210 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
27211 Open-source PKI book, available online at
27212 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
27213 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
27214 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
27215
27216
27217
27218 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27219 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27220
27221 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
27222 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
27223 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
27224 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
27225 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
27226 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
27227 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
27228 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
27229 one very small ACL:
27230 .code
27231 begin acl
27232 small_acl:
27233 accept hosts = one.host.only
27234 .endd
27235 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
27236 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
27237
27238 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
27239 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
27240 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
27241 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
27242 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
27243 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
27244 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
27245 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
27246
27247
27248 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
27249 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
27250 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
27251 The host &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a service for checking your
27252 relaying configuration (see section &<<SECTcheralcon>>& for more details).
27253
27254
27255
27256 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
27257 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
27258 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
27259 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
27260 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
27261 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
27262 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
27263 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
27264 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
27265 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
27266 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
27267 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
27268 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
27269 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
27270 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
27271 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
27272 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
27273 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
27274 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
27275 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
27276
27277 .table2 140pt
27278 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
27279 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
27280 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
27281 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
27282 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
27283 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
27284 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
27285 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
27286 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
27287 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
27288 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
27289 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
27290 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
27291 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
27292 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
27293 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
27294 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
27295 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
27296 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
27297 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
27298 .endtable
27299
27300 For example, if you set
27301 .code
27302 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
27303 .endd
27304 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
27305 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
27306 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
27307 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
27308 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
27309 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
27310 testing as possible at RCPT time.
27311
27312
27313 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
27314 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
27315 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
27316 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
27317 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
27318 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
27319 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
27320 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
27321 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
27322 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
27323 in any of these ACLs.
27324
27325 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
27326 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
27327 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
27328 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
27329 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
27330 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
27331 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
27332 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
27333 .code
27334 control = suppress_local_fixups
27335 .endd
27336 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
27337 run, it is too late.
27338
27339 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27340 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27341
27342 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
27343 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
27344 temporary error for these kinds of message.
27345
27346
27347 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
27348 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
27349 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
27350 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
27351 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
27352 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
27353 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
27354 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
27355 &%smtp_banner%& option.
27356
27357
27358 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
27359 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
27360 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
27361 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
27362 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
27363 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
27364 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
27365 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
27366 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
27367
27368 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
27369 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
27370 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
27371 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
27372 an EHLO response.
27373
27374
27375 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
27376 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
27377 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
27378 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
27379 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
27380 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
27381 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
27382 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
27383 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
27384 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
27385
27386 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
27387 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
27388 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
27389 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
27390 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
27391 associated with the DATA command.
27392
27393 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
27394 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
27395 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
27396 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
27397 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
27398 your resources.
27399
27400 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
27401 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
27402 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
27403 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
27404
27405 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
27406 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
27407 enabled (which is the default).
27408
27409 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
27410 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
27411 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
27412
27413 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27414
27415 For details on the operation of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
27416
27417
27418 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
27419 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27420 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27421
27422 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27423
27424
27425 .section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
27426 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
27427 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
27428 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
27429 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
27430 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
27431 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
27432 has been accepted.
27433
27434 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
27435 has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
27436 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
27437 The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
27438 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
27439 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
27440 for some or all recipients.
27441
27442 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
27443 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
27444 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
27445 .new
27446 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
27447 for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
27448 is &"yes"&.
27449 .wen
27450 Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
27451 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
27452 will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
27453
27454 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
27455 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
27456
27457 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27458 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
27459 the feature was not requested by the client.
27460
27461 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
27462 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
27463 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
27464 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
27465 does not in fact control any access.
27466 For this reason, it may only accept
27467 or warn as its final result.
27468
27469 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
27470 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
27471 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
27472 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
27473
27474 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
27475 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
27476
27477 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
27478 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
27479 response to QUIT.
27480
27481 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
27482 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
27483 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
27484 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
27485 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
27486
27487
27488 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
27489 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
27490 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
27491 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
27492 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
27493 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
27494 situation even worse.
27495
27496 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
27497 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
27498 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
27499 and &%warn%&.
27500
27501 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
27502 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
27503 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
27504 connection. The possible values are:
27505 .table2
27506 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
27507 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
27508 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
27509 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
27510 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
27511 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
27512 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
27513 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
27514 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
27515 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
27516 .endtable
27517 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
27518 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
27519 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
27520 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
27521 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
27522 used.
27523
27524
27525 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
27526 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
27527 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
27528 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
27529 .code
27530 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
27531 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
27532 .endd
27533 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
27534 providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
27535 non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
27536 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
27537 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
27538
27539 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
27540 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
27541 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
27542
27543 .ilist
27544 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
27545 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
27546 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
27547 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
27548 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
27549 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
27550 .code
27551 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
27552 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
27553 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
27554 .endd
27555 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
27556 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
27557 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
27558 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
27559 .next
27560 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
27561 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
27562 matches the string.
27563 .next
27564 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
27565 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
27566 want to have something like
27567 .code
27568 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
27569 .endd
27570 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
27571 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
27572 .endlist
27573
27574
27575
27576
27577 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
27578 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
27579 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
27580 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
27581 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
27582 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
27583 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
27584 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
27585 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
27586
27587 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
27588 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
27589 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
27590
27591
27592 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
27593 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
27594 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
27595 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
27596
27597 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
27598 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
27599 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
27600 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
27601 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
27602 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
27603 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
27604
27605
27606 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
27607 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
27608 recipients; it may create new recipients.
27609
27610
27611
27612 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
27613 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
27614 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
27615 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
27616 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
27617 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
27618
27619 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
27620 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
27621 used to accept or reject anything.
27622
27623 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
27624 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
27625 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
27626 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
27627
27628 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
27629 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
27630 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
27631 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
27632 configuration file.
27633
27634
27635
27636
27637 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
27638 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
27639 .vindex &$domain$&
27640 .vindex &$local_part$&
27641 .vindex &$sender_address$&
27642 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
27643 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
27644 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
27645 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
27646 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
27647 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
27648 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
27649 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
27650
27651 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
27652 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
27653 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
27654 how it is used.
27655
27656 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
27657 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
27658 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
27659 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
27660 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
27661 received).
27662
27663 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
27664 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
27665 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
27666 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
27667 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
27668 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
27669 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
27670 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
27671
27672
27673
27674
27675
27676 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
27677 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
27678 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
27679 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
27680 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
27681 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
27682 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
27683 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
27684 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
27685 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
27686 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
27687 unencrypted connections.
27688 .code
27689 acl_check_auth:
27690 accept encrypted = *
27691 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
27692 {CRAM-MD5}}
27693 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
27694 .endd
27695 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
27696 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
27697 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
27698 option to do this.)
27699
27700
27701
27702 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
27703 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
27704 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
27705 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
27706 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
27707 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
27708 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
27709
27710 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
27711 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
27712 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
27713 example:
27714 .code
27715 deny dnslists = list1.example
27716 dnslists = list2.example
27717 .endd
27718 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
27719 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
27720 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
27721 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
27722 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
27723
27724
27725 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
27726 The ACL verbs are as follows:
27727
27728 .ilist
27729 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
27730 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
27731 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
27732 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
27733 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
27734 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
27735 check a RCPT command:
27736 .code
27737 accept domains = +local_domains
27738 endpass
27739 verify = recipient
27740 .endd
27741 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
27742 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
27743 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
27744 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
27745 &%endpass%&.
27746
27747 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
27748 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
27749 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
27750 configuration.
27751
27752 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
27753 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
27754 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
27755 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
27756 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
27757 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
27758 .display
27759 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
27760 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
27761 .endd
27762 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
27763 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
27764 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
27765
27766 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
27767 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
27768 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
27769 of &%endpass%&.
27770
27771
27772 .next
27773 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
27774 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
27775 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
27776 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
27777 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
27778 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
27779 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
27780
27781
27782 .next
27783 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
27784 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
27785 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
27786 example,
27787 .code
27788 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27789 .endd
27790 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
27791
27792
27793 .next
27794 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
27795 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
27796 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
27797 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
27798 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
27799 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
27800 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
27801 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
27802 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
27803
27804 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
27805 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
27806 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
27807
27808
27809 .next
27810 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
27811 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
27812 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
27813 .code
27814 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
27815 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
27816 .endd
27817 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
27818 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
27819
27820 .next
27821 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
27822 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
27823 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
27824 example, when checking a RCPT command,
27825 .code
27826 require message = Sender did not verify
27827 verify = sender
27828 .endd
27829 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
27830 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
27831 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
27832 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
27833
27834 .next
27835 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
27836 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
27837 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
27838 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
27839 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
27840 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
27841 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
27842
27843 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
27844 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
27845 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
27846 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
27847 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
27848
27849 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
27850 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
27851 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
27852 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
27853 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
27854 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
27855 onwards.
27856
27857
27858 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27859 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
27860 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
27861 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
27862 .code
27863 warn !verify = sender
27864 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
27865 .endd
27866 .endlist
27867
27868 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
27869
27870 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
27871 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
27872 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
27873 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
27874 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
27875
27876
27877
27878 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
27879 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
27880 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
27881 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
27882 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
27883 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
27884 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
27885 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
27886 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
27887 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
27888 .ilist
27889 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
27890 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
27891 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
27892 on the same SMTP connection.
27893 .next
27894 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
27895 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
27896 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
27897 .endlist
27898
27899 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
27900 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
27901 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
27902 .code
27903 accept hosts = whatever
27904 set acl_m4 = some value
27905 accept authenticated = *
27906 set acl_c_auth = yes
27907 .endd
27908 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
27909 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
27910 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
27911
27912 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
27913 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
27914 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
27915 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
27916 error is generated.
27917
27918 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
27919 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
27920
27921
27922 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
27923 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
27924 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
27925 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
27926 .code
27927 deny domains = *.dom.example
27928 !verify = recipient
27929 .endd
27930 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
27931 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
27932 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
27933 two statements are equivalent:
27934 .code
27935 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
27936 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
27937 .endd
27938 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
27939 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
27940
27941 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
27942 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
27943 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
27944 .code
27945 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
27946 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
27947 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
27948 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
27949 .endd
27950 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
27951 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
27952 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
27953 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
27954 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
27955 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
27956 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
27957
27958 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
27959 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
27960 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
27961 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
27962 message is handled.
27963
27964 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
27965 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
27966 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
27967 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
27968 .code
27969 require message = Can't verify sender
27970 verify = sender
27971 message = Can't verify recipient
27972 verify = recipient
27973 message = This message cannot be used
27974 .endd
27975 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
27976 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
27977 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
27978 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
27979 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
27980 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
27981
27982 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
27983 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
27984 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
27985 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
27986 .code
27987 deny hosts = ...
27988 !senders = *@my.domain.example
27989 message = Invalid sender from client host
27990 .endd
27991 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
27992 by which time Exim has set up the message.
27993
27994
27995
27996 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
27997 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
27998 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
27999
28000 .vlist
28001 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28002 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
28003 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
28004 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
28005
28006 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28007 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
28008 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
28009 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
28010 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
28011 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
28012 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
28013 write rather ugly lines like this:
28014 .display
28015 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
28016 .endd
28017 Instead, all you need is
28018 .display
28019 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
28020 .endd
28021
28022 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28023 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
28024 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
28025 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
28026 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
28027 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
28028 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
28029 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
28030
28031 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
28032 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
28033 in several different ways. For example:
28034
28035 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
28036 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
28037 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
28038 . ==== way.
28039
28040 .ilist
28041 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
28042 .code
28043 accept ...some conditions
28044 control = queue_only
28045 .endd
28046 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
28047 other words, when the conditions are all true.
28048
28049 .next
28050 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
28051 .code
28052 accept ...some conditions...
28053 control = queue_only
28054 ...some more conditions...
28055 .endd
28056 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
28057 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
28058 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
28059 to be relevant.
28060
28061 .next
28062 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
28063 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
28064 example:
28065 .code
28066 warn ...some conditions...
28067 control = freeze
28068 accept ...
28069 .endd
28070 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
28071 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
28072 log entry.
28073
28074 .next
28075 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
28076 &%require%& verb. For example:
28077 .code
28078 require control = no_multiline_responses
28079 .endd
28080 .endlist
28081
28082 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
28083 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
28084 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
28085 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
28086 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
28087 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
28088 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
28089 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
28090 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
28091
28092 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
28093 example:
28094 .code
28095 deny ...some conditions...
28096 delay = 30s
28097 .endd
28098 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
28099 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
28100 .code
28101 deny delay = 30s
28102 ...some conditions...
28103 .endd
28104 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
28105 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
28106 .code
28107 warn ...some conditions...
28108 delay = 2m
28109 control = freeze
28110 accept ...
28111 .endd
28112
28113 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
28114 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
28115 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
28116 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
28117 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
28118 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
28119 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
28120
28121
28122 .vitem &*endpass*&
28123 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
28124 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
28125 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
28126 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
28127 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
28128 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
28129 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
28130
28131
28132 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28133 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
28134 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
28135 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
28136 .code
28137 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
28138 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
28139 .endd
28140 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
28141 example:
28142 .display
28143 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
28144 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
28145 .endd
28146 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
28147 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
28148 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
28149 message.
28150
28151 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
28152 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
28153 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
28154 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
28155 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
28156 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
28157 ignored.
28158
28159 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28160 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
28161 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
28162 error message.
28163
28164 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
28165 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
28166 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
28167 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
28168 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
28169 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
28170
28171 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
28172 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
28173 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
28174 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
28175 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
28176 logging rejections.
28177
28178
28179 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
28180 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
28181 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
28182 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
28183 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
28184 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
28185 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
28186 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
28187 .display
28188 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
28189 &` log_reject_target =`&
28190 .endd
28191 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
28192 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
28193 current ACL.
28194
28195
28196 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28197 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
28198 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
28199 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
28200 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
28201 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
28202 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
28203 ACLs. For example:
28204 .display
28205 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
28206 &` control = freeze`&
28207 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
28208 .endd
28209 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
28210 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
28211 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
28212 example:
28213 .code
28214 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
28215 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
28216 .endd
28217
28218
28219 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28220 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
28221 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
28222 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
28223 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
28224 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
28225 &%accept%& for details.)
28226
28227 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
28228 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
28229 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
28230 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
28231 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
28232 .code
28233 require message = Host not recognized
28234 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
28235 .endd
28236 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
28237 processed.)
28238
28239 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
28240 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
28241 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
28242 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
28243 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
28244 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
28245 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
28246 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
28247 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
28248 EHLO options.
28249
28250 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
28251 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
28252 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
28253 .code
28254 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
28255 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
28256 .endd
28257 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
28258 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
28259 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
28260 2&'xx'&.
28261
28262 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
28263 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
28264
28265 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
28266 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
28267 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
28268 response.
28269
28270 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28271 For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
28272 stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
28273
28274 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
28275 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
28276 However, the original message is available in the variable
28277 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
28278 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
28279 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
28280 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
28281
28282 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
28283 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
28284 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
28285 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
28286 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
28287 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
28288 effect.
28289
28290
28291 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28292 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
28293 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
28294 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
28295
28296
28297 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
28298 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
28299 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
28300 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
28301
28302
28303 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
28304 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
28305 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
28306 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
28307 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
28308 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
28309 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
28310 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
28311 when:
28312 .code
28313 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
28314 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
28315 .endd
28316 .endlist
28317
28318
28319
28320
28321 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
28322 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
28323 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
28324
28325 .vlist
28326 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
28327 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
28328 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
28329 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
28330 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
28331 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
28332 not work without it. For example:
28333 .code
28334 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
28335 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
28336 .endd
28337 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
28338 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
28339 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
28340 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
28341 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
28342
28343
28344 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
28345 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
28346 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
28347 .cindex "case of local parts"
28348 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
28349 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
28350 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
28351 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
28352 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
28353 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
28354 is encountered.
28355
28356 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
28357 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
28358 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
28359 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
28360 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
28361
28362 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
28363 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
28364 spam score:
28365 .code
28366 warn control = caseful_local_part
28367 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
28368 $acl_m4 + \
28369 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
28370 }
28371 control = caselower_local_part
28372 .endd
28373 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
28374 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
28375
28376
28377 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery*&
28378 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
28379 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
28380 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
28381
28382 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
28383 If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
28384 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
28385 is used for all recipients of the message,
28386 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
28387 and data is copied from one to the other.
28388
28389 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
28390 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
28391 If a recipient-verify callout connection is subsequently
28392 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
28393 any subsequent recipients and the data,
28394 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
28395
28396 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
28397 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
28398 Note also that headers cannot be
28399 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
28400 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
28401
28402 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
28403 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
28404 before the entire message has been received from the source.
28405 It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR option in use.
28406
28407 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
28408 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
28409 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
28410 usual fashion. If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
28411 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
28412 before the acceptance "<=" line.
28413
28414 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
28415 (possibly faked)
28416 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
28417
28418
28419 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
28420 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
28421 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
28422 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
28423 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile, by default called
28424 &'debuglog'&. The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
28425 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
28426 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
28427 option. Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
28428 contexts):
28429 .code
28430 control = debug
28431 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
28432 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
28433 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
28434 .endd
28435
28436
28437 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
28438 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
28439 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
28440 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
28441 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
28442
28443
28444 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
28445 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
28446 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
28447 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
28448 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
28449 strings or to numeric value.
28450 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
28451 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
28452 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
28453
28454 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
28455 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
28456 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
28457 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
28458 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
28459
28460
28461 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
28462 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
28463 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
28464 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
28465 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
28466 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
28467 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
28468 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
28469
28470 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
28471 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
28472 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
28473 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
28474 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
28475 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
28476 work with.
28477
28478
28479 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
28480 .cindex "fake defer"
28481 .cindex "defer, fake"
28482 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
28483 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
28484 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
28485 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
28486 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
28487
28488 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
28489 .cindex "fake rejection"
28490 .cindex "rejection, fake"
28491 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
28492 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
28493 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
28494 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
28495 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
28496 the same SMTP connection.
28497
28498 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
28499 message is supplied, the following is used:
28500 .code
28501 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
28502 550-kept for evaluation.
28503 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
28504 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
28505 .endd
28506 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
28507
28508 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
28509 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
28510 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
28511 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
28512 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
28513 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
28514 SMTP connection.
28515
28516 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
28517 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
28518 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
28519 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
28520
28521 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
28522 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
28523 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
28524 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
28525 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
28526 disables such output flushing.
28527
28528 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
28529 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
28530 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
28531 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
28532 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
28533 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
28534
28535 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
28536 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
28537 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
28538 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
28539 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
28540 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
28541 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
28542 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
28543 to be useful in production.
28544
28545 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
28546 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
28547 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
28548 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
28549 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
28550
28551 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
28552 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
28553 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
28554 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
28555 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
28556 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
28557
28558 .ilist
28559 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
28560 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
28561 verification failed"&) is sent.
28562 .next
28563 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
28564 line is output.
28565 .endlist
28566
28567 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
28568 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
28569
28570 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
28571 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
28572 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
28573 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
28574 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
28575 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
28576 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
28577
28578 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
28579 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
28580 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
28581 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
28582 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
28583 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
28584 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
28585 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
28586 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
28587 same SMTP connection.
28588
28589 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
28590 .cindex "message" "submission"
28591 .cindex "submission mode"
28592 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
28593 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
28594 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
28595 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
28596 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
28597 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
28598 late (the message has already been created).
28599
28600 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
28601 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
28602 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
28603 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
28604 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
28605
28606 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
28607 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
28608 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
28609 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
28610 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
28611
28612 .ilist
28613 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
28614 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
28615 .next
28616 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
28617 .next
28618 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
28619 .endlist ilist
28620
28621 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
28622 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
28623 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
28624 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
28625 data is read.
28626
28627 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
28628 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
28629 .endlist vlist
28630
28631
28632 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
28633 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
28634
28635 .ilist
28636 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
28637 .next
28638 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
28639 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
28640 .next
28641 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
28642 .next
28643 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
28644 .endlist
28645
28646
28647
28648 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
28649 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
28650 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
28651 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
28652 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
28653 to an incoming message, as in this example:
28654 .code
28655 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28656 dialup.mail-abuse.org
28657 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
28658 .endd
28659 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
28660 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
28661 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
28662 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
28663 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
28664 RCPT ACL).
28665
28666 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
28667 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for messages delivered by cutthrough routing.
28668
28669 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
28670 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
28671 contains one or more newlines that
28672 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
28673 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
28674 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
28675
28676 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
28677 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
28678 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
28679 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
28680 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
28681 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
28682 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
28683 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
28684 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
28685 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
28686 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
28687
28688 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
28689 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
28690 of message headers
28691 until they are added to the
28692 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
28693 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
28694 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
28695 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
28696 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
28697 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
28698 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
28699
28700 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
28701
28702 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
28703 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
28704 .display
28705 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
28706 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
28707
28708 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
28709 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
28710 .endd
28711 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
28712 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
28713 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
28714 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
28715 honoured.
28716
28717 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
28718 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
28719 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
28720 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
28721 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
28722 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
28723 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
28724 specifications.
28725
28726 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
28727 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
28728 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
28729 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
28730 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
28731
28732 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
28733 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
28734 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
28735 to be a header name first.) For example:
28736 .code
28737 warn add_header = \
28738 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
28739 .endd
28740 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
28741 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
28742 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
28743 up in reverse order.
28744
28745 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
28746 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
28747 system filter or in a router or transport.
28748
28749
28750
28751 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
28752 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
28753 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
28754 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
28755 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
28756 from an incoming message, as in this example:
28757 .code
28758 warn message = Remove internal headers
28759 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
28760 .endd
28761 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
28762 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
28763 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
28764 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
28765 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
28766 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
28767
28768 Headers will not be removed to the message if the modifier is used in
28769 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for messages delivered by cutthrough routing.
28770
28771 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
28772 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
28773 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
28774 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
28775 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
28776 .code
28777 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
28778 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
28779 warn message = Remove internal headers
28780 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
28781 .endd
28782 Removed header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
28783 They are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
28784 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor is removing
28785 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
28786 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
28787 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
28788 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
28789 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
28790 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
28791 would have been removed.
28792
28793 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
28794 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
28795 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
28796 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
28797 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
28798 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
28799 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
28800 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
28801 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
28802
28803 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
28804 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
28805 .display
28806 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
28807 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
28808
28809 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
28810 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
28811 .endd
28812 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
28813 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
28814 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
28815 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
28816 are honoured.
28817
28818 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
28819 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
28820 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
28821
28822
28823
28824
28825 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
28826 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
28827 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
28828 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
28829 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
28830 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28831
28832 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
28833 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
28834 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
28835 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
28836 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
28837 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
28838 The conditions are as follows:
28839
28840
28841 .vlist
28842 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
28843 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
28844 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
28845 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
28846 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
28847 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
28848 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
28849 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
28850 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
28851 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
28852 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
28853 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
28854
28855 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
28856 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
28857 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
28858 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
28859 The name and values are expanded separately.
28860 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
28861 will act as argument separators.
28862
28863 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
28864 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
28865 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
28866 conditions are tested.
28867
28868 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
28869 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
28870 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
28871 for different local users or different local domains.
28872
28873 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
28874 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
28875 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
28876 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
28877 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
28878 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
28879 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
28880 .code
28881 authenticated = *
28882 .endd
28883
28884 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
28885 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
28886 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
28887 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
28888 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
28889 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
28890 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
28891 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
28892 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
28893 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
28894 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
28895 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
28896 negative.
28897
28898 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
28899 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
28900 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28901 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
28902 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
28903 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
28904 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
28905 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28906
28907 .vitem &*demime&~=&~*&<&'extension&~list'&>
28908 .cindex "&%demime%& ACL condition"
28909 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28910 content-scanning extension. Its use is described in section
28911 &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
28912
28913 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
28914 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
28915 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
28916 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
28917 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
28918 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
28919 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
28920 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
28921 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
28922 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
28923
28924 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
28925 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
28926 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
28927 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
28928 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
28929 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
28930 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
28931 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
28932 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
28933 &%domains%& test.
28934
28935 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
28936 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
28937
28938
28939 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
28940 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
28941 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
28942 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
28943 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
28944 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
28945 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
28946 .code
28947 encrypted = *
28948 .endd
28949
28950
28951 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
28952 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
28953 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
28954 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
28955 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
28956 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
28957 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
28958 .code
28959 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
28960 .endd
28961 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
28962 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
28963 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
28964
28965 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
28966 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
28967 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
28968 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
28969 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
28970 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
28971
28972 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
28973 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
28974 .code
28975 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
28976 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
28977 .endd
28978 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
28979 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
28980 statement can then check the IP address.
28981
28982 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
28983 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
28984 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
28985 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
28986 .code
28987 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
28988 message = $host_data
28989 .endd
28990 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
28991
28992 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
28993 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
28994 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
28995 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
28996 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
28997 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
28998 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
28999 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
29000 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
29001 the next &%local_parts%& test.
29002
29003 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
29004 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
29005 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
29006 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
29007 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29008 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
29009 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29010
29011 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
29012 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
29013 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
29014 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29015 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
29016 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
29017 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
29018 &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29019
29020 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
29021 .cindex "rate limiting"
29022 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
29023 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
29024
29025 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
29026 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
29027 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
29028 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
29029 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
29030 recipient address against a list of recipients.
29031
29032 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
29033 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
29034 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
29035 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29036 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
29037 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
29038 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29039
29040 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
29041 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
29042 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
29043 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
29044 .vindex "&$domain$&"
29045 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
29046 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
29047 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
29048 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
29049 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
29050 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
29051 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
29052 influence the sender checking.
29053
29054 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
29055 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
29056
29057 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
29058 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
29059 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
29060 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
29061 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
29062 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
29063 .code
29064 senders = :
29065 .endd
29066 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
29067 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
29068
29069 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
29070 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
29071 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
29072 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29073 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
29074 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29075
29076 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
29077 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29078 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
29079 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
29080 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
29081 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
29082 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
29083 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
29084 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
29085 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
29086
29087 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
29088 .cindex "CSA verification"
29089 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
29090 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
29091 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
29092
29093 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
29094 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29095 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
29096 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
29097 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
29098 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29099 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29100 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
29101 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
29102 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
29103
29104 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
29105 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
29106 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
29107
29108 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
29109 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29110 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
29111 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
29112 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
29113 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
29114 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29115 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29116 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
29117 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
29118 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
29119 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
29120 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
29121 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
29122 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
29123
29124 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
29125 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
29126 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
29127 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
29128 .code
29129 deny senders = :
29130 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
29131 !verify = header_sender
29132 .endd
29133
29134 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
29135 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29136 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
29137 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
29138 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
29139 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29140 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29141 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
29142 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
29143 and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
29144 Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
29145 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
29146 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
29147 appropriate.
29148
29149 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
29150 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
29151 .code
29152 To: @
29153 .endd
29154 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
29155 common as they used to be.
29156
29157 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
29158 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29159 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
29160 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
29161 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
29162 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
29163 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
29164 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
29165 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
29166 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
29167 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
29168 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
29169 independently of this condition.
29170
29171 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
29172 option), this condition is always true.
29173
29174
29175 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
29176 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
29177 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
29178 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
29179 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
29180 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
29181 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
29182 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
29183 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
29184
29185 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
29186 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
29187
29188
29189 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
29190 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29191 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
29192 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
29193 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
29194 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
29195 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
29196 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
29197 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
29198 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
29199 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
29200 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
29201 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
29202 value for the child address.
29203
29204 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
29205 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29206 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
29207 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
29208 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
29209 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
29210 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
29211 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
29212 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
29213 original IP address.
29214
29215 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
29216 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
29217
29218 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
29219 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
29220
29221 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
29222 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29223 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
29224 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
29225 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
29226 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
29227 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
29228 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
29229 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
29230
29231 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
29232 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
29233 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
29234 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
29235 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
29236 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
29237 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
29238
29239 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
29240 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
29241 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
29242
29243 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
29244 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29245 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
29246 verified as a sender.
29247 .endlist
29248
29249
29250
29251 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
29252 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
29253 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
29254 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
29255 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
29256 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
29257 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
29258 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
29259 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
29260 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
29261 .code
29262 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
29263 dialups.mail-abuse.org
29264 .endd
29265 the following records are looked up:
29266 .code
29267 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29268 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
29269 .endd
29270 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
29271 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
29272 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
29273 use two separate conditions:
29274 .code
29275 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29276 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
29277 .endd
29278 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
29279 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
29280 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
29281 processed.
29282
29283 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
29284 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
29285 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
29286 following special items in the list:
29287 .display
29288 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
29289 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
29290 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
29291 .endd
29292 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
29293 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
29294 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
29295 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
29296 .code
29297 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
29298 .endd
29299 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
29300 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
29301 .code
29302 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29303 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
29304 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
29305 .endd
29306 .cindex cacheing "of dns lookup"
29307 .cindex DNS TTL
29308 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
29309 .new
29310 (but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
29311 .wen
29312 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
29313 connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
29314 Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
29315 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
29316
29317
29318
29319 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
29320 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
29321 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
29322 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
29323 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
29324 .code
29325 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
29326 .endd
29327 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
29328 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
29329 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
29330 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
29331
29332
29333
29334
29335 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
29336 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
29337 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
29338 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
29339 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
29340 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
29341 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
29342 .code
29343 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
29344 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
29345 .endd
29346 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
29347 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
29348 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
29349 up by this example is
29350 .code
29351 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
29352 .endd
29353 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
29354 addresses. For example:
29355 .code
29356 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29357 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
29358 .endd
29359 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
29360 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
29361
29362
29363
29364
29365 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
29366 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
29367 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
29368 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
29369 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
29370 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
29371 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
29372 either to double the separators like this:
29373 .code
29374 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
29375 .endd
29376 or to change the separator character, like this:
29377 .code
29378 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
29379 .endd
29380 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
29381 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
29382 occurs. Consider this condition:
29383 .code
29384 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
29385 .endd
29386 The DNS lookups that occur are:
29387 .code
29388 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
29389 a.domain.black.list.tld
29390 .endd
29391 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
29392 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
29393 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
29394 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
29395 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
29396 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
29397 error for a previous item.
29398
29399 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
29400 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
29401 .code
29402 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
29403 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
29404 .endd
29405 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
29406 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
29407 .code
29408 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
29409 $sender_address_domain \
29410 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
29411 see $dnslist_text.
29412 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
29413 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
29414 $sender_address_domain} }} }
29415 .endd
29416 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
29417 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
29418 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
29419 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
29420 .code
29421 dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
29422 .endd
29423 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
29424 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
29425
29426 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
29427 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
29428
29429
29430
29431
29432 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
29433 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
29434 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
29435 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
29436 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
29437 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
29438 .display
29439 127.1.0.1 RBL
29440 127.1.0.2 DUL
29441 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
29442 127.1.0.4 RSS
29443 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
29444 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
29445 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
29446 .endd
29447 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
29448 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
29449 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
29450
29451
29452 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
29453 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
29454 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
29455 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
29456 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
29457 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
29458 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
29459 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
29460 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
29461 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
29462 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
29463 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
29464 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
29465 cases, for example:
29466 .code
29467 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
29468 .endd
29469 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
29470 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
29471 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
29472 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
29473 .code
29474 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
29475 .endd
29476 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
29477 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
29478
29479 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
29480 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
29481 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
29482 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
29483 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
29484 information.
29485
29486 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
29487 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
29488 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
29489 .code
29490 deny hosts = !+local_networks
29491 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
29492 at $dnslist_domain
29493 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
29494 .endd
29495
29496
29497
29498 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
29499 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
29500 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
29501 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
29502 For example,
29503 .code
29504 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
29505 .endd
29506 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
29507 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
29508 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
29509 describes how multiple records are handled.
29510
29511 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
29512 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
29513 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
29514 .code
29515 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29516 .endd
29517 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
29518 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
29519 first. For example:
29520 .code
29521 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
29522 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
29523 .endd
29524
29525 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
29526 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
29527 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
29528 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
29529 tested. For example:
29530 .code
29531 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
29532 .endd
29533 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
29534 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
29535 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
29536 .code
29537 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
29538 .endd
29539 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
29540 an odd number.
29541
29542
29543
29544 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
29545 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
29546 condition. Whereas
29547 .code
29548 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29549 .endd
29550 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
29551 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
29552 .code
29553 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29554 .endd
29555 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
29556 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
29557 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
29558 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
29559
29560 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
29561 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
29562
29563 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
29564 previous example is precisely equivalent to
29565 .code
29566 deny dnslists = a.b.c
29567 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29568 .endd
29569 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
29570 Consider this example:
29571 .code
29572 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29573 list.dsbl.org : \
29574 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
29575 relays.ordb.org
29576 .endd
29577 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
29578 .code
29579 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29580 list.dsbl.org
29581 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
29582 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
29583 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
29584 .endd
29585 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
29586
29587
29588
29589
29590 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
29591 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
29592 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
29593 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
29594 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
29595 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
29596 .code
29597 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
29598 .endd
29599 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
29600 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
29601 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
29602 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
29603 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
29604 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
29605
29606 .ilist
29607 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
29608 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
29609 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
29610 .next
29611 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
29612 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
29613 changed to:
29614 .code
29615 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
29616 .endd
29617 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29618 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
29619 .code
29620 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
29621 .endd
29622 for the condition to be true.
29623 .endlist
29624
29625 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
29626 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
29627 .ilist
29628 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
29629 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
29630 .code
29631 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
29632 .endd
29633 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29634 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
29635 .next
29636 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
29637 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
29638 .code
29639 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
29640 .endd
29641 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29642 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
29643 .code
29644 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
29645 .endd
29646 for the condition to be false.
29647 .endlist
29648 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
29649 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
29650
29651
29652
29653
29654 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
29655 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
29656 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
29657 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
29658 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
29659 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
29660 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
29661 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
29662 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
29663 lists.
29664
29665 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
29666 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
29667 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
29668 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
29669 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
29670 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
29671 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
29672 .code
29673 reject message = \
29674 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
29675 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
29676 dnslists = \
29677 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
29678 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
29679 .endd
29680 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
29681 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
29682 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
29683 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
29684 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
29685 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
29686
29687 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
29688 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
29689 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
29690 .code
29691 reject dnslists = \
29692 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
29693 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
29694 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
29695 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
29696 .endd
29697 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
29698 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
29699 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
29700
29701
29702
29703 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
29704 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
29705 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
29706 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
29707 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
29708 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
29709 .code
29710 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
29711 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29712 .endd
29713 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
29714 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
29715 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
29716 .code
29717 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
29718 .endd
29719 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
29720 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
29721
29722 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
29723 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
29724 .code
29725 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
29726 dnslists = some.list.example
29727 .endd
29728
29729 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
29730 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
29731 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
29732 .code
29733 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
29734 .endd
29735
29736 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
29737 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
29738 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
29739 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
29740 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
29741 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
29742 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
29743 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
29744 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
29745 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
29746 .display
29747 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
29748 .endd
29749 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
29750 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
29751
29752 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
29753 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
29754 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
29755 of &'p'&.
29756
29757 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
29758 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
29759 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
29760 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
29761 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
29762 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
29763 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
29764 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
29765 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
29766
29767 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
29768 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
29769 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
29770 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
29771
29772 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
29773 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
29774 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
29775 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
29776 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
29777 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
29778 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
29779 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
29780 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
29781 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
29782
29783 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
29784 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
29785 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
29786 ACL.
29787
29788 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
29789 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
29790 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
29791 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
29792 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
29793 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
29794
29795 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
29796 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
29797 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
29798 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
29799 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
29800 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
29801 the &%count=%& option.
29802
29803
29804 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
29805 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
29806 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
29807 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
29808 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
29809
29810 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
29811 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
29812 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
29813 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
29814
29815 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
29816 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
29817 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
29818 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
29819 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
29820 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
29821 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
29822
29823 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
29824 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
29825 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
29826 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
29827 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
29828 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
29829 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
29830
29831 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
29832 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
29833 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
29834 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
29835 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
29836
29837 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
29838 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
29839 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
29840 multiple different commands.
29841
29842 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
29843 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
29844 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
29845 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
29846 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
29847
29848 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
29849
29850
29851 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
29852 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
29853 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
29854 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
29855 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
29856
29857 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
29858 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
29859
29860 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
29861 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
29862 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
29863 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
29864 new rate.
29865 .code
29866 acl_check_connect:
29867 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
29868 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
29869 (max $sender_rate_limit)
29870 # ...
29871 acl_check_mail:
29872 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
29873 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
29874 (max $sender_rate_limit)
29875 .endd
29876
29877 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
29878 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
29879 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
29880 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
29881 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
29882 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
29883 checks.
29884
29885 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
29886 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
29887 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
29888 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
29889 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
29890
29891
29892 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
29893 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
29894 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
29895 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
29896 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
29897 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
29898 rest of the ACL.
29899
29900 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
29901 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
29902 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
29903 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
29904 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
29905 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
29906 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
29907 For example, it does not prevent a sender with an over-aggressive retry rate
29908 from getting any email through.
29909
29910 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
29911 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
29912 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
29913 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
29914 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
29915 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
29916 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
29917 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
29918 .code
29919 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
29920 .endd
29921
29922
29923 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
29924 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
29925 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
29926 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
29927 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
29928 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
29929 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
29930 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
29931 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
29932
29933 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
29934 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
29935 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
29936 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
29937 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
29938 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
29939
29940 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
29941 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
29942 rate.
29943
29944 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
29945 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
29946 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
29947 required increases with larger limits.
29948
29949 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
29950 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
29951 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
29952 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
29953 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
29954 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
29955 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
29956 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
29957 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
29958 as intended.
29959
29960
29961 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
29962 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
29963 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
29964 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
29965 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
29966 message. For example:
29967 .code
29968 # Log all senders' rates
29969 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
29970 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
29971
29972 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
29973 # at the decimal point.
29974 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
29975 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
29976 $sender_rate_limit }s
29977
29978 # Keep authenticated users under control
29979 deny authenticated = *
29980 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
29981
29982 # System-wide rate limit
29983 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
29984 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
29985
29986 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
29987 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
29988 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
29989 messages per $sender_rate_period
29990 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
29991 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
29992 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
29993 .endd
29994 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
29995 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
29996 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
29997 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
29998 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
29999 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
30000 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
30001
30002
30003
30004 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
30005 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
30006 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
30007 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
30008 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
30009 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
30010 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
30011 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
30012 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
30013 .code
30014 verify = sender/callout
30015 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
30016 .endd
30017 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
30018 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
30019 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
30020 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
30021 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
30022 The available options are as follows:
30023
30024 .ilist
30025 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
30026 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
30027 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
30028 .next
30029 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
30030 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
30031 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
30032 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
30033 .next
30034 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
30035 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
30036 .next
30037 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
30038 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
30039 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
30040 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
30041 .endlist
30042
30043 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
30044 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
30045 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
30046 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30047 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
30048 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
30049 coding like this:
30050 .code
30051 warn !verify = sender
30052 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
30053 .endd
30054 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
30055 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
30056 verification failure.
30057
30058 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
30059 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
30060
30061 .ilist
30062 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
30063 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
30064 .next
30065 &%route%&: Routing failed.
30066 .next
30067 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
30068 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
30069 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
30070 .next
30071 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
30072 .next
30073 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
30074 .endlist
30075
30076 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
30077 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
30078
30079
30080
30081
30082 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
30083 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
30084 .cindex "callout" "verification"
30085 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
30086 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
30087 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
30088 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
30089 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
30090 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
30091 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
30092 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
30093 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
30094 sender's domain.
30095
30096 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
30097 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
30098 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
30099 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
30100 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
30101 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
30102
30103 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
30104 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
30105 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
30106 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
30107 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
30108
30109 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
30110 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
30111 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
30112 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
30113 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
30114 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
30115 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
30116 supplies a host list.
30117 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
30118
30119 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
30120 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
30121 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
30122 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
30123 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
30124 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
30125 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
30126
30127 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
30128 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
30129 following SMTP commands are sent:
30130 .display
30131 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
30132 &`MAIL FROM:<>`&
30133 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
30134 &`QUIT`&
30135 .endd
30136 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
30137 set to &"lmtp"&.
30138
30139 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
30140 settings.
30141
30142 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
30143 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
30144 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
30145 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
30146 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
30147 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
30148
30149 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
30150 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
30151 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
30152 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
30153 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
30154
30155 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
30156 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
30157 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
30158 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
30159 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
30160
30161
30162
30163
30164 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
30165 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
30166 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
30167 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
30168 .code
30169 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
30170 .endd
30171 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
30172 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
30173 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
30174
30175
30176 .vlist
30177 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
30178 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
30179 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
30180 For example:
30181 .code
30182 verify = sender/callout=5s
30183 .endd
30184 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
30185 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
30186 the &%connect%& parameter.
30187
30188
30189 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
30190 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
30191 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
30192 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
30193 .code
30194 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
30195 .endd
30196 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
30197
30198 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
30199 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
30200 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
30201 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
30202 updated in this circumstance.
30203
30204 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
30205 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
30206 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
30207 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
30208 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
30209 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
30210
30211
30212 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
30213 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
30214 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
30215 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
30216 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
30217 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
30218 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
30219 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
30220 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
30221 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
30222 .code
30223 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
30224 .endd
30225 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
30226
30227
30228 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
30229 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
30230 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
30231 For example:
30232 .code
30233 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
30234 .endd
30235 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
30236 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
30237 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
30238 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
30239 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
30240
30241
30242 .vitem &*no_cache*&
30243 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
30244 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
30245 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
30246
30247 .vitem &*postmaster*&
30248 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
30249 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
30250 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
30251 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
30252 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
30253 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
30254 made, until the cache record expires.
30255
30256 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
30257 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
30258 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
30259 For example:
30260 .code
30261 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
30262 .endd
30263 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
30264 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
30265 .code
30266 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
30267 .endd
30268 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
30269 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
30270 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
30271 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
30272
30273
30274 .vitem &*random*&
30275 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
30276 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
30277 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
30278 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
30279 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
30280 .code
30281 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
30282 .endd
30283 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
30284 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
30285 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
30286 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
30287 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
30288
30289 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
30290 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
30291 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
30292 .code
30293 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
30294 .endd
30295 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
30296 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
30297 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
30298 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
30299 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
30300
30301 .vitem &*use_sender*&
30302 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
30303 .code
30304 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
30305 .endd
30306 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
30307 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
30308 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
30309 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
30310 usefulness of callout caching.
30311 .endlist
30312
30313 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
30314 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
30315 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
30316 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
30317 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
30318 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
30319 these circumstances.
30320
30321 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
30322 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
30323 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
30324 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
30325 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
30326 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
30327 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
30328
30329 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
30330 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
30331 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
30332 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
30333
30334
30335
30336
30337 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
30338 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
30339 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
30340 .cindex "caching" "callout"
30341 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
30342 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
30343 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
30344 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
30345 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
30346 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
30347
30348 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
30349 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
30350 is not available.
30351
30352 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
30353 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
30354 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
30355
30356 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
30357 commands up to and including
30358 .code
30359 MAIL FROM:<>
30360 .endd
30361 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
30362 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
30363 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
30364 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
30365 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
30366 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
30367 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
30368
30369 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
30370 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
30371 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
30372 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
30373 will eventually be noticed.
30374
30375 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
30376 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
30377 behaviour will be the same.
30378
30379
30380
30381 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
30382 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
30383 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
30384 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
30385 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
30386 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
30387 you might see:
30388 .code
30389 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
30390 250 OK
30391 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
30392 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
30393 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
30394 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
30395 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
30396 550 Sender verification failed
30397 .endd
30398 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
30399 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
30400 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
30401 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
30402 example:
30403 .code
30404 verify = sender/no_details
30405 .endd
30406
30407 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
30408 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
30409 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
30410 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
30411 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
30412 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
30413 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
30414
30415 .ilist
30416 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
30417 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
30418 verification also fails.
30419 .next
30420 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
30421 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
30422 .endlist
30423
30424 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
30425 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
30426 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
30427 .code
30428 A.Wol: aw123
30429 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
30430 .endd
30431 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
30432 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
30433 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
30434 verification to succeed.
30435
30436 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
30437 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
30438 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
30439 option. For example:
30440 .code
30441 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
30442 .endd
30443 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
30444 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
30445
30446 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
30447 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
30448 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
30449 address and a report is output for each of them.
30450
30451
30452
30453 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
30454 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
30455 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
30456 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
30457 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
30458 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
30459 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
30460 .code
30461 verify = csa
30462 .endd
30463 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
30464 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
30465 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
30466 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
30467 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
30468 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
30469
30470 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
30471 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
30472 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
30473 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
30474
30475 .ilist
30476 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
30477 .next
30478 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
30479 .next
30480 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
30481 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
30482 .next
30483 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
30484 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
30485 .endlist
30486
30487 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
30488 use for the DNS query. The default is:
30489 .code
30490 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
30491 .endd
30492 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
30493 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
30494 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
30495 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
30496 meaningful to say:
30497 .code
30498 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
30499 .endd
30500 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
30501 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
30502 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
30503
30504 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
30505 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
30506 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
30507 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
30508 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
30509 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
30510 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
30511 of legitimate HELO domains.
30512
30513 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
30514 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
30515 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
30516 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
30517 lookup such as:
30518 .code
30519 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
30520 .endd
30521 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
30522 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
30523 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
30524
30525
30526
30527
30528 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
30529 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
30530 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
30531 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
30532 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
30533 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
30534 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
30535 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
30536
30537 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
30538 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
30539 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
30540 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
30541 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
30542 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
30543 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
30544
30545 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
30546 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
30547 like this:
30548 .code
30549 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
30550 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
30551 }{$value}}
30552 .endd
30553 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
30554 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
30555 use this:
30556 .code
30557 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
30558 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
30559 senders = :
30560 recipients = +batv_senders
30561
30562 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
30563 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
30564 senders = :
30565 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
30566 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
30567 !condition = $prvscheck_result
30568 .endd
30569 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
30570 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
30571 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
30572 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
30573 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
30574
30575 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
30576 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
30577 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
30578 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
30579 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
30580 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
30581 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
30582
30583 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
30584 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
30585 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
30586 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
30587 .code
30588 batv_redirect:
30589 driver = redirect
30590 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
30591 .endd
30592 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
30593 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
30594 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
30595 local addresses.
30596
30597 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
30598 can be used:
30599 .code
30600 external_smtp_batv:
30601 driver = smtp
30602 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
30603 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
30604 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
30605 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
30606 {$value}fail}}}
30607 .endd
30608 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
30609
30610
30611
30612 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
30613 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
30614 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
30615 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
30616 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
30617 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
30618 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
30619 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
30620 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
30621 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
30622
30623 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
30624 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
30625 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
30626 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
30627 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
30628 same host is fulfilling both functions,
30629 . ///
30630 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
30631 . ///
30632 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
30633 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
30634 system to arbitrary domains.
30635
30636
30637 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
30638 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
30639 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
30640 example, suppose you want to do the following:
30641
30642 .ilist
30643 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
30644 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
30645 &'my.dom2.example'&.
30646 .next
30647 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
30648 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
30649 .next
30650 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
30651 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
30652 .endlist
30653
30654
30655 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
30656 .code
30657 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
30658 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
30659 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
30660 .endd
30661 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
30662 command:
30663 .code
30664 acl_check_rcpt:
30665 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
30666 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
30667 .endd
30668 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
30669 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
30670 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
30671 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
30672 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
30673 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
30674 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
30675
30676
30677
30678 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
30679 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
30680 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
30681 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
30682 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
30683
30684 For specifically testing for unwanted relaying, the host
30685 &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a useful service. If you telnet to this
30686 host from the host on which Exim is running, using the normal telnet port, you
30687 will see a normal telnet connection message and then quite a long delay. Be
30688 patient. The remote host is making an SMTP connection back to your host, and
30689 trying a number of common probes to test for open relay vulnerability. The
30690 results of the tests will eventually appear on your terminal.
30691 .ecindex IIDacl
30692
30693
30694
30695 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30696 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30697
30698 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
30699 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
30700 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
30701 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
30702 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
30703 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
30704 specification.
30705
30706 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
30707 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
30708 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
30709 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
30710 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
30711
30712 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
30713 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
30714 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
30715
30716 .ilist
30717 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
30718 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
30719 .next
30720 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
30721 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
30722 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
30723 .next
30724 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
30725 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
30726 .next
30727 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
30728 conditions.
30729 .next
30730 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
30731 .endlist
30732
30733 There is another content-scanning configuration option for &_Local/Makefile_&,
30734 called WITH_OLD_DEMIME. If this is set, the old, deprecated &%demime%& ACL
30735 condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
30736
30737 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
30738 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
30739 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
30740 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
30741 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
30742 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
30743
30744 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
30745 temporarily created in a file called:
30746 .display
30747 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
30748 .endd
30749 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
30750 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
30751 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
30752 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
30753 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
30754 .code
30755 control = no_mbox_unspool
30756 .endd
30757 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
30758 same directory by default.
30759
30760
30761
30762 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
30763 .cindex "virus scanning"
30764 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
30765 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
30766 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
30767 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
30768 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
30769 in memory and thus are much faster.
30770
30771 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
30772 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
30773
30774 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
30775 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
30776 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
30777 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
30778 .display
30779 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
30780 .endd
30781 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
30782 .code
30783 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
30784 .endd
30785 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
30786 before use.
30787 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
30788 The following scanner types are supported in this release:
30789
30790 .vlist
30791 .vitem &%avast%&
30792 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
30793 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
30794 Security (currently at version 1.1.7).
30795 You can get a trial version at &url(http://www.avast.com) or for Linux
30796 at &url(http://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
30797 This scanner type takes one option,
30798 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
30799 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
30800 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
30801 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
30802 Any further options are given, on separate lines,
30803 to the daemon as options before the main scan command.
30804 For example:
30805 .code
30806 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
30807 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
30808 .endd
30809 If you omit the argument, the default path
30810 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
30811 is used.
30812 If you use a remote host,
30813 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
30814 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
30815 For information about available commands and their options you may use
30816 .code
30817 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
30818 FLAGS
30819 SENSITIVITY
30820 PACK
30821 .endd
30822
30823
30824 .vitem &%aveserver%&
30825 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
30826 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
30827 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
30828 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
30829 example:
30830 .code
30831 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
30832 .endd
30833
30834
30835 .vitem &%clamd%&
30836 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
30837 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
30838 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
30839 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
30840 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
30841
30842 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
30843 a UNIX socket specification,
30844 a TCP socket specification,
30845 or a (global) option.
30846
30847 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
30848 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
30849 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
30850 and the second a port number,
30851 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
30852 These per-server options are supported:
30853 .code
30854 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
30855 .endd
30856
30857 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
30858 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
30859
30860 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
30861
30862 Examples:
30863 .code
30864 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
30865 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
30866 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
30867 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
30868 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
30869 .endd
30870 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
30871 &`local`&
30872 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
30873 to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
30874 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
30875 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
30876 There is an option WITH_OLD_CLAMAV_STREAM in &_src/EDITME_& available, should
30877 you be running a version of ClamAV prior to 0.95.
30878
30879 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
30880 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
30881 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
30882 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
30883 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
30884 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
30885 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
30886 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
30887 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
30888 .code
30889 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
30890 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
30891 (Connection refused)
30892 .endd
30893
30894 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
30895 contributing the code for this scanner.
30896
30897 .vitem &%cmdline%&
30898 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
30899 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
30900 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
30901 type takes 3 mandatory options:
30902
30903 .olist
30904 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
30905 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
30906
30907 .next
30908 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
30909 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
30910 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
30911 the &"trigger"& expression.
30912
30913 .next
30914 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
30915 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
30916 &"name"& expression.
30917 .endlist olist
30918
30919 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
30920 .code
30921 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
30922 .endd
30923 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
30924 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
30925 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
30926 configuration setting:
30927 .code
30928 av_scanner = cmdline:\
30929 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
30930 found in file:'(.+)'
30931 .endd
30932 .vitem &%drweb%&
30933 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
30934 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface
30935 takes one option,
30936 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
30937 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
30938 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
30939 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
30940 For example:
30941 .code
30942 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
30943 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
30944 .endd
30945 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
30946 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
30947
30948 .vitem &%f-protd%&
30949 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
30950 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
30951 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
30952 (or port-range).
30953 For example:
30954 .code
30955 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
30956 .endd
30957 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
30958
30959 .vitem &%fsecure%&
30960 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
30961 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
30962 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
30963 .code
30964 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
30965 .endd
30966 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
30967 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
30968
30969 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
30970 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
30971 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
30972 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
30973 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
30974 For example:
30975 .code
30976 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
30977 .endd
30978 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
30979
30980 .vitem &%mksd%&
30981 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
30982 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
30983 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
30984 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
30985 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
30986 provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
30987 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
30988 .code
30989 av_scanner = mksd:2
30990 .endd
30991 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
30992
30993 .vitem &%sock%&
30994 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
30995 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
30996 running on the local machine.
30997 There are four options:
30998 an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
30999 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
31000 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
31001 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
31002 an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
31003 For example:
31004 .code
31005 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)\$
31006 .endd
31007 Default for the socket specifier is &_/tmp/malware.sock_&.
31008 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_&.
31009 Both regular-expressions are required.
31010
31011 .vitem &%sophie%&
31012 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
31013 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
31014 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
31015 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
31016 client communication. For example:
31017 .code
31018 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
31019 .endd
31020 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
31021 the option.
31022 .endlist
31023
31024 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
31025 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
31026 ACL.
31027
31028 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
31029 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
31030 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
31031 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
31032 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
31033 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
31034 message.
31035
31036 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
31037 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
31038 The first element can then be one of
31039
31040 .ilist
31041 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
31042 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
31043 recommended usage.
31044 .next
31045 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
31046 the condition fails immediately.
31047 .next
31048 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
31049 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
31050 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
31051 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
31052 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way).
31053 .endlist
31054
31055 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
31056 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
31057 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
31058
31059 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
31060 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
31061 For example:
31062 .code
31063 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
31064 .endd
31065 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
31066
31067 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
31068 When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
31069 is set to record the actual address used.
31070
31071 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
31072 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
31073 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
31074 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
31075 logging data.
31076
31077 If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
31078 use the &%demime%& condition (see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&) before the
31079 &%malware%& condition.
31080
31081 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
31082 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
31083
31084 Here is a very simple scanning example:
31085 .code
31086 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31087 demime = *
31088 malware = *
31089 .endd
31090 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
31091 .code
31092 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31093 demime = *
31094 malware = */defer_ok
31095 .endd
31096 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
31097 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
31098 .code
31099 av_scanner = $acl_m0
31100 .endd
31101 in the main Exim configuration.
31102 .code
31103 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31104 set acl_m0 = sophie
31105 malware = *
31106
31107 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31108 set acl_m0 = aveserver
31109 malware = *
31110 .endd
31111
31112
31113 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
31114 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
31115 .cindex "spam scanning"
31116 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
31117 .cindex "Rspamd"
31118 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
31119 score and a report for the message.
31120 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
31121
31122 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
31123 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
31124 &url(http://spamassassin.apache.org) and &url(http://www.rspamd.com)
31125
31126 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
31127 .code
31128 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
31129 .endd
31130 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
31131 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
31132 nicely, however.
31133
31134 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
31135 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
31136 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
31137 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
31138 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
31139 configuration as follows (example):
31140 .code
31141 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
31142 .endd
31143
31144 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
31145 on TCP port 11333)
31146 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
31147 .code
31148 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
31149 .endd
31150
31151 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
31152 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
31153 file name instead of an address/port pair:
31154 .code
31155 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
31156 .endd
31157 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
31158 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
31159 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
31160 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way):
31161 .code
31162 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
31163 192.168.2.11 783 : \
31164 192.168.2.12 783
31165 .endd
31166 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
31167 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
31168 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
31169 condition defers.
31170
31171 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
31172 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
31173 and changeable in the usual way.
31174
31175 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
31176 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
31177 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
31178 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
31179
31180 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
31181 are options.
31182 The supported options are:
31183 .code
31184 pri=<priority> Selection priority
31185 weight=<value> Selection bias
31186 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
31187 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
31188 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
31189 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
31190 .endd
31191
31192 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
31193 higher values being tried first.
31194 The default priority is 1.
31195
31196 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
31197 Within a priority set
31198 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
31199 The default value for selection bias is 1.
31200
31201 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
31202 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
31203 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
31204 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
31205
31206 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
31207 are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
31208
31209 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
31210 The default value is two minutes.
31211
31212 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
31213 a failed connect is made.
31214 The default is to not retry.
31215
31216 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
31217 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
31218 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
31219 expansion.
31220
31221 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
31222 When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
31223 is set to record the actual address used.
31224
31225 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
31226 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
31227 .code
31228 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31229 spam = joe
31230 .endd
31231 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
31232 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
31233 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
31234 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
31235 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
31236 right-hand side.
31237
31238 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
31239 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
31240 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
31241 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
31242 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
31243 are not set.
31244 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
31245 (e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
31246 after the first),
31247 or the use of PRDR,
31248 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
31249 are needed to use this feature.
31250
31251 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
31252 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
31253 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
31254
31255
31256 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
31257 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
31258 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
31259 example:
31260 .code
31261 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31262 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
31263 spam = nobody
31264 .endd
31265
31266 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
31267 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
31268 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
31269 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
31270
31271 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
31272 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
31273 variables.
31274 Except for &$spam_report$&,
31275 these variables are saved with the received message so are
31276 available for use at delivery time.
31277
31278 .vlist
31279 .vitem &$spam_score$&
31280 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
31281 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
31282
31283 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
31284 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
31285 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
31286 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
31287 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
31288
31289 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
31290 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
31291 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
31292 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
31293 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
31294 spam bar is 50 characters.
31295
31296 .vitem &$spam_report$&
31297 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
31298 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
31299 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
31300
31301 .vitem &$spam_action$&
31302 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
31303 spam score versus threshold.
31304 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
31305
31306 .endlist
31307
31308 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
31309 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
31310 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
31311
31312 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
31313 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
31314 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
31315 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
31316 spam condition, like this:
31317 .code
31318 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31319 spam = joe/defer_ok
31320 .endd
31321 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
31322
31323 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
31324 condition:
31325 .code
31326 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
31327 warn spam = nobody:true
31328 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
31329 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
31330
31331 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
31332 # is over threshold
31333 warn spam = nobody
31334 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
31335
31336 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
31337 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
31338 spam = nobody:true
31339 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
31340 .endd
31341
31342
31343
31344 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
31345 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
31346 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
31347 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
31348 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
31349 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
31350 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
31351 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
31352 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
31353 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
31354 cases.
31355
31356 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
31357 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
31358 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
31359 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
31360 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
31361 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
31362 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
31363
31364 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
31365 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
31366 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
31367 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
31368 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
31369
31370 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
31371 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
31372 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
31373 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
31374 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
31375 syntax is:
31376 .display
31377 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
31378 .endd
31379 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
31380 the value can be:
31381
31382 .olist
31383 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
31384 .next
31385 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
31386 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
31387 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
31388 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
31389 .next
31390 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
31391 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
31392 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
31393 the full path and file name.
31394 .next
31395 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
31396 filename, and the default path is then used.
31397 .endlist
31398 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
31399 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
31400 a file with its original, proposed filename using
31401 .code
31402 decode = $mime_filename
31403 .endd
31404 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
31405 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
31406 automatically unlinked.
31407
31408 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
31409 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
31410 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
31411 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
31412 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
31413
31414 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
31415 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
31416 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
31417
31418 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
31419 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
31420 available in the MIME ACL:
31421
31422 .vlist
31423 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
31424 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
31425 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
31426 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
31427 contains the empty string.
31428
31429 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
31430 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
31431 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
31432 .code
31433 us-ascii
31434 gb2312 (Chinese)
31435 iso-8859-1
31436 .endd
31437 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
31438 case-insensitively.
31439
31440 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
31441 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
31442 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
31443 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
31444 only used for display purposes.
31445
31446 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
31447 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
31448 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
31449
31450 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
31451 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
31452 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
31453
31454 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
31455 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
31456 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
31457 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
31458 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
31459
31460 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
31461 This variable contains the normalized content of the
31462 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
31463 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
31464
31465 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
31466 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
31467 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
31468 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
31469 .code
31470 text/plain
31471 text/html
31472 application/octet-stream
31473 image/jpeg
31474 audio/midi
31475 .endd
31476 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
31477 empty string.
31478
31479 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
31480 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
31481 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
31482 containing the decoded data.
31483 .endlist
31484
31485 .cindex "RFC 2047"
31486 .vlist
31487 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
31488 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
31489 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
31490 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
31491 RFC2047
31492 or RFC2231
31493 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
31494 If no filename was
31495 found, this variable contains the empty string.
31496
31497 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
31498 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
31499 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
31500 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
31501
31502 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
31503 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
31504 follows:
31505
31506 .olist
31507 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
31508
31509 .next
31510 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
31511 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
31512
31513 .next
31514 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
31515 and the rest are attachments.
31516
31517 .next
31518 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
31519 .endlist olist
31520
31521 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
31522 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
31523 coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
31524 .code
31525 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
31526 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
31527 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
31528 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
31529 .endd
31530 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
31531 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
31532 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
31533 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
31534 want to carry out specific actions on them.
31535
31536 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
31537 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
31538 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
31539 decoding is fully recursive.
31540
31541 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
31542 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
31543 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
31544 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
31545 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
31546 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
31547 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
31548 .endlist
31549
31550
31551
31552 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
31553 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
31554 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
31555 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
31556 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
31557
31558 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
31559 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
31560 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
31561 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
31562 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
31563
31564 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
31565 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
31566 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
31567 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
31568 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
31569 32K characters are checked.
31570
31571 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
31572 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
31573 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
31574 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
31575 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
31576 .code
31577 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
31578 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
31579 .endd
31580 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
31581 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
31582 matching regular expression.
31583 The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
31584 are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
31585
31586 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
31587 CPU-intensive.
31588
31589
31590
31591
31592 .section "The demime condition" "SECTdemimecond"
31593 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME checking"
31594 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
31595 The &%demime%& ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
31596 extension blocking. It is usable only in the DATA and non-SMTP ACLs. The
31597 &%demime%& condition uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
31598 ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
31599 condition is deprecated and kept only for backward compatibility. You must set
31600 the WITH_OLD_DEMIME option in &_Local/Makefile_& at build time to be able to
31601 use the &%demime%& condition.
31602
31603 The &%demime%& condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
31604 errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
31605 against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
31606 parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
31607 scanning, it is recommended that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
31608 antivirus (&%malware%&) condition.
31609
31610 On the right-hand side of the &%demime%& condition you can pass a
31611 colon-separated list of file extensions that it should match against. For
31612 example:
31613 .code
31614 deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
31615 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
31616 .endd
31617 If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
31618 false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, &"disk
31619 full"&), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
31620 the condition is on a &%warn%& verb).
31621
31622 The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
31623 conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, &"false"&, or
31624 zero (&"0"&), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
31625
31626 The &%demime%& condition set the following variables:
31627
31628 .vlist
31629 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
31630 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
31631 When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
31632 severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
31633 severe the error (the current maximum value is 3). If this variable is unset or
31634 zero, no error occurred.
31635
31636 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
31637 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
31638 When &$demime_errorlevel$& is greater than zero, this variable contains a
31639 human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
31640 .endlist
31641
31642 .vlist
31643 .vitem &$found_extension$&
31644 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
31645 When the &%demime%& condition is true, this variable contains the file
31646 extension it found.
31647 .endlist
31648
31649 Both &$demime_errorlevel$& and &$demime_reason$& are set by the first call of
31650 the &%demime%& condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
31651
31652 If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the &%demime%&
31653 condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass &"*"& as the
31654 right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
31655 facility:
31656 .code
31657 # Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
31658 deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
31659 demime = *
31660 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
31661
31662 # Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
31663 # Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
31664 deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
31665 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
31666
31667 # Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
31668 # examine them and eventually thaw them.
31669 deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
31670 demime = exe:doc
31671 control = freeze
31672 .endd
31673 .ecindex IIDcosca
31674
31675
31676
31677
31678 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31679 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31680
31681 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
31682 "Local scan function"
31683 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
31684 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
31685 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
31686 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
31687 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
31688
31689 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
31690 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
31691 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
31692 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
31693 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
31694
31695 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
31696 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
31697 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
31698 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
31699
31700 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
31701 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
31702 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
31703 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
31704
31705 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
31706 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
31707 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
31708 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
31709 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
31710 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
31711 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
31712 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
31713 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
31714
31715
31716
31717 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
31718 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
31719 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
31720 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
31721 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
31722 directory, so you might set
31723 .code
31724 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
31725 .endd
31726 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
31727 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
31728 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
31729 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
31730 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
31731 _src/local_scan.c_.
31732
31733 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
31734 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
31735 .code
31736 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
31737 .endd
31738 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
31739
31740
31741
31742
31743 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
31744 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
31745 You must include this line near the start of your code:
31746 .code
31747 #include "local_scan.h"
31748 .endd
31749 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
31750 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
31751 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
31752 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
31753 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
31754 strings and pointers to character strings:
31755 .code
31756 #define CS (char *)
31757 #define CCS (const char *)
31758 #define CSS (char **)
31759 #define US (unsigned char *)
31760 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
31761 #define USS (unsigned char **)
31762 .endd
31763 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
31764 .code
31765 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
31766 .endd
31767 The arguments are as follows:
31768
31769 .ilist
31770 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
31771 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
31772 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
31773
31774 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
31775 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
31776 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
31777 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
31778 case this changes in some future version.
31779 .next
31780 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
31781 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
31782 .endlist
31783
31784 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
31785
31786 .vlist
31787 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
31788 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
31789 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
31790 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
31791 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
31792 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
31793
31794 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
31795 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
31796 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
31797
31798 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
31799 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
31800 queued without immediate delivery.
31801
31802 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
31803 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
31804 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
31805 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
31806 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
31807 used.
31808
31809 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
31810 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
31811 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
31812 problem"& is used.
31813
31814 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
31815 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
31816 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
31817 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
31818 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
31819 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
31820 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
31821
31822 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
31823 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
31824 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
31825 .endlist
31826
31827 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
31828 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
31829 &%-oe%& command line options.
31830
31831
31832
31833 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
31834 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
31835 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
31836 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
31837 want to do this, you must have the line
31838 .code
31839 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
31840 .endd
31841 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
31842 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
31843 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
31844 to define them.
31845
31846 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
31847 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
31848 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
31849 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
31850 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
31851 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
31852 .code
31853 static int my_integer_option = 42;
31854 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
31855
31856 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
31857 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
31858 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
31859 };
31860
31861 int local_scan_options_count =
31862 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
31863 .endd
31864 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
31865 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
31866 .code
31867 begin local_scan
31868 my_integer = 99
31869 my_string = some string of text...
31870 .endd
31871 The available types of option data are as follows:
31872
31873 .vlist
31874 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
31875 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
31876 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
31877 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
31878 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
31879 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
31880 values.)
31881
31882 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
31883 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
31884 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
31885 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
31886
31887 .vitem &*opt_int*&
31888 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
31889 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
31890 Exim.
31891
31892 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
31893 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
31894 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
31895 printed with the suffix K or M.
31896
31897 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
31898 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
31899 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
31900 always output in octal.
31901
31902 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
31903 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
31904 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
31905
31906 .vitem &*opt_time*&
31907 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
31908 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
31909 .endlist
31910
31911 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
31912 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
31913
31914
31915
31916 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
31917 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
31918 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
31919 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
31920 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
31921 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
31922 C variables are as follows:
31923
31924 .vlist
31925 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
31926 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
31927
31928 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
31929 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
31930
31931 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
31932 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
31933 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
31934 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
31935
31936 .ilist
31937 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
31938 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
31939 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
31940
31941 .next
31942 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
31943 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
31944 of debugging bits.
31945 .endlist ilist
31946
31947 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
31948 selected, you should use code like this:
31949 .code
31950 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
31951 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
31952 .endd
31953 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
31954 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
31955 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
31956
31957 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
31958 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
31959 discussed below.
31960
31961 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
31962 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
31963
31964 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
31965 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
31966
31967 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
31968 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
31969 &%-bh%& command line option.
31970
31971 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
31972 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
31973 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
31974
31975 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
31976 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
31977 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
31978 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
31979
31980 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
31981 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
31982 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
31983
31984 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
31985 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
31986
31987 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
31988 The number of accepted recipients.
31989
31990 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
31991 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
31992 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
31993 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
31994 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
31995 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
31996 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
31997 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
31998 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
31999 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
32000 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
32001 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
32002
32003 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
32004 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
32005
32006 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
32007 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
32008 locally-submitted messages.
32009
32010 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
32011 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
32012 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
32013
32014 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
32015 The name of the sending host, if known.
32016
32017 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
32018 The port on the sending host.
32019
32020 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
32021 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
32022
32023 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
32024 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
32025
32026 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
32027 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
32028 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
32029 .endlist
32030
32031
32032 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
32033 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
32034 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
32035 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
32036 their type to *.
32037
32038
32039 .vlist
32040 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
32041 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
32042
32043 .vitem &*int&~type*&
32044 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
32045 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
32046 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
32047 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
32048 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
32049 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
32050
32051 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
32052 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
32053 internal newlines.
32054
32055 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
32056 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
32057 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
32058 .endlist
32059
32060
32061
32062 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
32063 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
32064
32065 .vlist
32066 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
32067 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
32068
32069 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
32070 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
32071 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
32072 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
32073
32074 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
32075 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
32076 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
32077 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
32078 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
32079 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
32080 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
32081 is NULL for all recipients.
32082 .endlist
32083
32084
32085
32086 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
32087 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
32088 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
32089 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
32090 release:
32091
32092 .vlist
32093 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
32094 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
32095
32096 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
32097 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
32098 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
32099 for the process in &%newumask%&.
32100
32101 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
32102 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
32103 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
32104 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
32105 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
32106
32107 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
32108
32109 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
32110 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
32111 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
32112 return value is as follows:
32113
32114 .ilist
32115 >= 0
32116
32117 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
32118 ending status.
32119
32120 .next
32121 < 0 and > &--256
32122
32123 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
32124 signal number.
32125
32126 .next
32127 &--256
32128
32129 The process timed out.
32130 .next
32131 &--257
32132
32133 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
32134 .endlist
32135
32136 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
32137 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
32138 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
32139 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
32140 forks a subprocess that is running
32141 .code
32142 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
32143 .endd
32144 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
32145 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
32146 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
32147 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
32148
32149 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
32150 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
32151 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
32152 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
32153
32154
32155 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
32156 *sender_authentication)*&
32157 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
32158 that it runs is:
32159 .display
32160 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
32161 .endd
32162 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
32163
32164
32165 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
32166 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
32167 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
32168 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
32169 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
32170 .code
32171 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
32172 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
32173 .endd
32174
32175 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
32176 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
32177 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
32178 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
32179 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
32180 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
32181 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
32182 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
32183
32184 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
32185 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
32186 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
32187 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
32188 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
32189 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
32190
32191 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
32192 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
32193 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
32194 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
32195
32196 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
32197 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
32198 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
32199 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
32200 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
32201 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
32202 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
32203 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
32204 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
32205 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
32206 .code
32207 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
32208 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
32209 .endd
32210 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
32211 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
32212
32213
32214 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
32215 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
32216 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
32217 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
32218 match the specification, the function does nothing.
32219
32220
32221 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
32222 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
32223 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
32224 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
32225 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
32226 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
32227 .code
32228 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
32229 .endd
32230 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
32231 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
32232 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
32233 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
32234 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
32235 zero-terminated.
32236
32237 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
32238 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
32239 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
32240 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
32241 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
32242 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
32243 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
32244 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
32245
32246 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
32247 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
32248 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
32249 .display
32250 &`OK `& match succeeded
32251 &`FAIL `& match failed
32252 &`DEFER `& match deferred
32253 .endd
32254 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
32255 inability to contact a database.
32256
32257 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
32258 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
32259 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
32260 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
32261 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
32262
32263 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
32264 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
32265 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
32266 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
32267 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
32268
32269 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
32270 uschar&~*list)*&"
32271 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
32272 expected to be
32273 .code
32274 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
32275 .endd
32276 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
32277 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
32278 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
32279 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
32280 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
32281 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
32282 failed.
32283
32284 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
32285 *format,&~...)*&"
32286 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
32287 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
32288 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
32289 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
32290 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
32291 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
32292
32293
32294 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
32295 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
32296 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
32297 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
32298
32299 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
32300 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
32301 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
32302 value afterwards. For example:
32303 .code
32304 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
32305 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
32306 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
32307 .endd
32308
32309 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
32310 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
32311 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
32312 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
32313 address.
32314 .endlist
32315
32316
32317 .cindex "RFC 2047"
32318 .vlist
32319 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
32320 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
32321 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
32322 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
32323 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
32324 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
32325 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
32326 binary string is returned with an error message.
32327
32328 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
32329 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
32330 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
32331
32332 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
32333 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
32334 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
32335 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
32336 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
32337
32338 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
32339 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
32340 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
32341
32342 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
32343 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
32344 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
32345 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
32346 with translation.
32347
32348
32349 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
32350 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
32351 below.
32352
32353 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
32354 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
32355 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
32356 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
32357 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
32358 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
32359 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
32360 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
32361 is involved.
32362
32363 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
32364 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
32365
32366 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
32367 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
32368 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
32369 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
32370 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
32371 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
32372 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
32373 .code
32374 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
32375 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
32376 .endd
32377 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
32378 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
32379 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
32380 multiple output lines.
32381
32382 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
32383 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
32384 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
32385 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
32386 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
32387 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
32388 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
32389 is an error.
32390
32391 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
32392 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
32393 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
32394 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
32395
32396 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
32397 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
32398 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
32399
32400 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
32401 See below.
32402
32403 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
32404 See below.
32405
32406 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
32407 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
32408 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
32409 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
32410 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
32411 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
32412 more discussion.
32413 .endlist
32414
32415
32416
32417 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
32418 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
32419 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
32420 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
32421 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
32422 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
32423 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
32424 terminates.
32425
32426 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
32427 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
32428 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
32429 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
32430
32431 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
32432 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
32433 .code
32434 store_pool = POOL_PERM
32435 .endd
32436 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
32437 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
32438 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
32439 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
32440
32441 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
32442 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
32443 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
32444 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
32445 &%store_pool%&.
32446 .ecindex IIDlosca
32447
32448
32449
32450
32451 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32452 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32453
32454 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
32455 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
32456 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
32457 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
32458 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
32459 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
32460 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
32461 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
32462
32463 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
32464 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
32465 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
32466 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
32467 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
32468
32469 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
32470 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
32471 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
32472 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
32473 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
32474 prevent it happening on retries.
32475
32476 .vindex "&$domain$&"
32477 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
32478 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
32479 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
32480 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
32481 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
32482 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
32483 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
32484
32485
32486 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
32487 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
32488 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
32489 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
32490 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
32491 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
32492 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
32493 .code
32494 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
32495 system_filter_user = exim
32496 .endd
32497 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
32498 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
32499 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
32500 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
32501 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
32502 by the &%reply%& command.
32503
32504
32505 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
32506 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
32507 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
32508 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
32509
32510 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
32511 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
32512
32513
32514
32515 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
32516 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
32517 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
32518 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
32519 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
32520 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
32521 they cause errors.
32522
32523 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
32524 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
32525 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
32526 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
32527 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
32528 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
32529 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
32530
32531 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
32532 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
32533 succeed, it will not be tried again.
32534 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
32535 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
32536
32537 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
32538 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
32539 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
32540 to which users' filter files can refer.
32541
32542
32543
32544 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
32545 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
32546 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
32547 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
32548 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
32549
32550
32551
32552 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
32553 .cindex "freezing messages"
32554 .cindex "message" "freezing"
32555 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
32556 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
32557 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
32558 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
32559 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
32560 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
32561 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
32562 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
32563 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
32564 .code
32565 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
32566 .endd
32567 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
32568
32569 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
32570 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
32571 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
32572 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
32573 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
32574 run.
32575
32576 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
32577 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
32578 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
32579 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
32580
32581 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
32582 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
32583 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
32584 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
32585 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
32586 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
32587 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
32588 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
32589 message. For example:
32590 .code
32591 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
32592 because it contains attachments that we are \
32593 not prepared to receive."
32594 .endd
32595
32596 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
32597 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
32598 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
32599 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
32600 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
32601 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
32602 use, for example
32603 .code
32604 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
32605 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
32606 .endd
32607 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
32608 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
32609 generated by the filter.
32610
32611 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
32612 &%defer%&,
32613 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
32614 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
32615 as
32616 .code
32617 mail ...
32618 freeze
32619 .endd
32620 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
32621 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
32622 take place.
32623
32624
32625
32626 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
32627 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
32628 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
32629 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
32630 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
32631 .code
32632 headers add <string>
32633 headers remove <string>
32634 .endd
32635 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
32636 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
32637 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
32638 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
32639 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
32640
32641 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
32642 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
32643 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
32644 example:
32645 .code
32646 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
32647 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
32648 X-header-2: ...."
32649 .endd
32650 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
32651 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
32652 space after input continuations is ignored.
32653
32654 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
32655 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
32656 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
32657 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
32658 header with the same name, they are all removed.
32659
32660 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
32661 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
32662 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
32663 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
32664 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
32665 used for all recipients of the message.
32666
32667 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
32668 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
32669 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
32670 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
32671 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
32672 until the message is actually being written (see section
32673 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
32674
32675 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
32676 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
32677 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
32678 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
32679 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
32680 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
32681 modified more than once.
32682
32683 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
32684 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
32685 For example:
32686 .code
32687 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
32688 headers remove "Subject"
32689 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
32690 headers remove "Old-Subject"
32691 .endd
32692
32693
32694
32695 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
32696 .cindex "envelope sender"
32697 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
32698 .code
32699 errors_to <some address>
32700 .endd
32701 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
32702 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
32703 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
32704 might use
32705 .code
32706 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
32707 .endd
32708 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
32709 address if its delivery failed.
32710
32711
32712
32713 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
32714 .vindex "&$domain$&"
32715 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
32716 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
32717 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
32718 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
32719 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
32720 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
32721 which implements such a filter:
32722 .code
32723 central_filter:
32724 check_local_user
32725 driver = redirect
32726 domains = +local_domains
32727 file = /central/filters/$local_part
32728 no_verify
32729 allow_filter
32730 allow_freeze
32731 .endd
32732 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
32733 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
32734 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
32735 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
32736
32737 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
32738 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
32739 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
32740 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
32741 normal way.
32742 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
32743 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
32744 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
32745
32746
32747
32748
32749
32750
32751 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32752 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32753
32754 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
32755 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
32756 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
32757 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
32758 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
32759 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
32760 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
32761 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
32762
32763 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
32764 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
32765 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
32766 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
32767 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
32768
32769 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
32770 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
32771 loopback interface specially in any way.
32772
32773 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
32774 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
32775
32776
32777
32778
32779 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
32780 .cindex "message" "submission"
32781 .cindex "submission mode"
32782 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
32783 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
32784 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
32785 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
32786 .code
32787 control = submission
32788 .endd
32789 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
32790 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
32791 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
32792 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
32793 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
32794 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
32795 .code
32796 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
32797 control = submission
32798 .endd
32799 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
32800 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
32801 is used to separate options. For example:
32802 .code
32803 control = submission/sender_retain
32804 .endd
32805 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
32806 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
32807 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
32808 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
32809 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
32810 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
32811 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
32812
32813 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
32814 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
32815 example:
32816 .code
32817 control = submission/domain=some.domain
32818 .endd
32819 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
32820 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
32821 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
32822 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
32823 .code
32824 accept authenticated = *
32825 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
32826 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
32827 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
32828 .endd
32829 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
32830 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
32831 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
32832 .code
32833 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
32834 .endd
32835 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
32836 line would be:
32837 .code
32838 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
32839 .endd
32840 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
32841 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
32842 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
32843 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
32844
32845 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
32846 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
32847 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
32848 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
32849 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
32850 spoof another's address.
32851
32852 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
32853 .cindex "line endings"
32854 .cindex "carriage return"
32855 .cindex "linefeed"
32856 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
32857 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
32858 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
32859 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
32860 use CRLF or just CR.
32861
32862 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
32863 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
32864 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
32865 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
32866 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
32867 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
32868 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
32869 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
32870 follows:
32871
32872 .ilist
32873 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
32874 .next
32875 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
32876 is ignored.
32877 .next
32878 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
32879 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
32880 terminator.
32881 .next
32882 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
32883 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
32884 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
32885 people trying to play silly games.
32886 .next
32887 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
32888 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
32889 line.
32890 .endlist
32891
32892
32893
32894
32895
32896 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
32897 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
32898 .cindex "address" "qualification"
32899 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
32900 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
32901 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
32902 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
32903 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
32904
32905 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
32906 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
32907 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
32908 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
32909 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
32910
32911 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
32912 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
32913 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
32914 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
32915 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
32916 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
32917 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
32918 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
32919
32920
32921
32922
32923 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
32924 .cindex "&""From""& line"
32925 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
32926 .cindex "sender" "address"
32927 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
32928 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
32929 .cindex "envelope sender"
32930 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
32931 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
32932 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
32933 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
32934 .code
32935 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
32936 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
32937 .endd
32938 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
32939 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
32940 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
32941 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
32942 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
32943 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
32944 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
32945 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
32946 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
32947
32948 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
32949 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
32950 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
32951 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
32952 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
32953 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
32954 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
32955
32956 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
32957 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
32958 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
32959
32960 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
32961 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
32962 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
32963 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
32964
32965
32966
32967 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
32968 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
32969 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
32970 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
32971 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
32972 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
32973 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
32974
32975 .blockquote
32976 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
32977 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
32978 .endblockquote
32979
32980 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
32981 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
32982 follows:
32983
32984 .ilist
32985 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
32986 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
32987 .next
32988 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
32989 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
32990 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
32991 .next
32992 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
32993 also removed.
32994 .next
32995 For a locally-submitted message,
32996 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
32997 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
32998 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
32999 included in log lines in this case.
33000 .next
33001 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
33002 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
33003 .endlist
33004
33005
33006
33007
33008 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
33009 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
33010 includes the header line:
33011 .code
33012 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
33013 .endd
33014
33015 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
33016 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
33017 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
33018 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
33019 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
33020 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
33021
33022
33023 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
33024 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
33025 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
33026 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
33027 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
33028
33029 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
33030 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
33031 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
33032 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
33033 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
33034 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
33035 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
33036 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
33037 messages.
33038
33039
33040 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
33041 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
33042 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
33043 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
33044 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
33045 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
33046 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
33047 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
33048 messages.
33049
33050
33051 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
33052 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
33053 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
33054 .cindex "message" "submission"
33055 .cindex "submission mode"
33056 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
33057 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
33058
33059 .ilist
33060 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
33061 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
33062 .next
33063 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
33064 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
33065 .olist
33066 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
33067 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
33068 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
33069 .next
33070 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
33071 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
33072 .next
33073 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
33074 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
33075 .endlist
33076 .endlist
33077
33078 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
33079
33080 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
33081 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
33082 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
33083 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
33084 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
33085 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
33086 &%qualify_domain%&.
33087
33088 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
33089 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
33090 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
33091 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
33092
33093
33094 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
33095 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
33096 .cindex "message" "submission"
33097 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
33098 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
33099 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
33100 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
33101 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
33102 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
33103 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
33104 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
33105 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
33106 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
33107
33108
33109 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
33110 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
33111 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
33112 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
33113 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
33114
33115 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
33116 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
33117 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
33118 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
33119
33120 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
33121 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
33122 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
33123
33124
33125 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
33126 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
33127 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
33128 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
33129 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
33130 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
33131 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
33132 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
33133 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
33134 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
33135 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
33136
33137
33138
33139 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
33140 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
33141 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
33142 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
33143 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
33144 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
33145 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
33146 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
33147
33148
33149
33150 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
33151 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
33152 .cindex "message" "submission"
33153 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
33154 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
33155 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
33156 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
33157 control setting.
33158
33159 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
33160 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
33161 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
33162 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
33163 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
33164 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
33165 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
33166 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
33167 line is added to the message.
33168
33169 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
33170 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
33171 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
33172 options true at the same time.
33173
33174 .cindex "submission mode"
33175 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
33176 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
33177 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
33178 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
33179
33180 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
33181 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
33182 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
33183 created as follows:
33184
33185 .ilist
33186 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
33187 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
33188 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
33189 .next
33190 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
33191 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
33192 .next
33193 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
33194 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
33195 .endlist
33196
33197 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
33198 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
33199 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
33200 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
33201
33202 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
33203 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
33204 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
33205 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
33206
33207
33208
33209 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
33210 "SECTheadersaddrem"
33211 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
33212 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
33213 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
33214 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
33215 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
33216 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
33217 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
33218
33219 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
33220 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
33221 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
33222 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
33223 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
33224 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
33225
33226 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
33227 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
33228 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
33229
33230 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
33231 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
33232 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
33233 .code
33234 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
33235 X-added-second: another added header line
33236 .endd
33237 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
33238
33239 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
33240 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
33241 Each header-line is separately expanded.
33242
33243 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
33244 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
33245 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
33246 not part of the names. For example:
33247 .code
33248 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
33249 .endd
33250
33251 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
33252 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
33253 Each item is separately expanded.
33254 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
33255 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
33256 will act as list separators.
33257
33258 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
33259 items are expanded at routing time,
33260 and then associated with all addresses that are
33261 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
33262 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
33263 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
33264
33265 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
33266 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
33267 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
33268 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
33269
33270 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
33271 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
33272 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
33273 requirements.
33274
33275 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
33276 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
33277 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
33278 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
33279 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
33280 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
33281 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
33282
33283 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
33284 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
33285 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
33286 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
33287
33288 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
33289 the following consequences:
33290
33291 .ilist
33292 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
33293 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
33294 to it, at all times.
33295 .next
33296 Header lines that are added by a router's
33297 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
33298 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
33299 .next
33300 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
33301 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
33302 .next
33303 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
33304 a later router or by a transport.
33305 .next
33306 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
33307 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
33308 .code
33309 headers_remove = subject
33310 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
33311 .endd
33312 .endlist
33313
33314 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
33315 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
33316
33317
33318
33319
33320
33321 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
33322 .cindex "address" "constructed"
33323 .cindex "constructed address"
33324 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
33325 the form
33326 .display
33327 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
33328 .endd
33329 For example:
33330 .code
33331 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
33332 .endd
33333 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
33334 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
33335 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
33336 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
33337 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
33338 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
33339 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
33340 there is no password file entry.
33341
33342 .cindex "RFC 2047"
33343 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
33344 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
33345 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
33346 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
33347 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
33348 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
33349 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
33350 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
33351
33352
33353
33354 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
33355 .cindex "case of local parts"
33356 .cindex "local part" "case of"
33357 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
33358 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
33359 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
33360 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
33361 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
33362 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
33363 router option.
33364
33365 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
33366 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
33367 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
33368 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
33369 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
33370 .code
33371 correct_case:
33372 driver = redirect
33373 domains = +local_domains
33374 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
33375 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
33376 @$domain
33377 .endd
33378 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
33379 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
33380 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
33381 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
33382 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
33383
33384
33385
33386 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
33387 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
33388 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
33389 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
33390 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
33391 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
33392 empty components for compatibility.
33393
33394
33395
33396 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
33397 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
33398 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
33399 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
33400 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
33401 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
33402
33403 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
33404 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
33405 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
33406 example, a header such as
33407 .code
33408 To: hare@teaparty
33409 .endd
33410 might get rewritten as
33411 .code
33412 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
33413 .endd
33414 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
33415 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
33416 been routed.
33417
33418 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
33419 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
33420 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
33421 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
33422 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
33423 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
33424 .ecindex IIDmesproc
33425
33426
33427
33428 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33429 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33430
33431 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
33432 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
33433 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
33434 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
33435 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
33436 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
33437 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
33438
33439 .ilist
33440 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
33441 .next
33442 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
33443 .next
33444 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
33445 .endlist
33446
33447 For mail delivery, the following are available:
33448
33449 .ilist
33450 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
33451 .next
33452 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
33453 &"lmtp"&);
33454 .next
33455 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
33456 transport);
33457 .next
33458 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
33459 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
33460 .endlist
33461
33462 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
33463 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
33464 used to contain the envelope information.
33465
33466
33467
33468 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
33469 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
33470 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
33471 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
33472 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
33473 .cindex "EHLO"
33474 .cindex "HELO"
33475 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
33476 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
33477 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
33478 processing is the same in both cases.
33479
33480 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
33481 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
33482 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
33483 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
33484 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
33485 .cindex "transport" "filter"
33486 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
33487 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
33488 suppressed.
33489
33490 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
33491 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
33492 required for the transaction.
33493
33494 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
33495 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
33496 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
33497 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
33498 is called for verification.
33499
33500 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
33501 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
33502 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
33503
33504 .cindex "carriage return"
33505 .cindex "linefeed"
33506 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
33507 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
33508 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
33509 line terminator.
33510
33511 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
33512 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
33513 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
33514 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
33515 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
33516 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
33517 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
33518 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
33519 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
33520
33521 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
33522 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
33523 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
33524 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
33525
33526 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
33527 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
33528 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
33529 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
33530
33531 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
33532 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
33533 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
33534 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
33535 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
33536 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
33537 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
33538 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
33539 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
33540 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
33541
33542 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
33543 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
33544
33545 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
33546 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
33547 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
33548 square bracket of the IP address.
33549
33550
33551
33552
33553 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
33554 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
33555 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
33556 .cindex "host" "error"
33557 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
33558 message errors, and recipient errors.
33559
33560 .vlist
33561 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
33562 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
33563 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
33564
33565 .ilist
33566 Connection refused or timed out,
33567 .next
33568 Any error response code on connection,
33569 .next
33570 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
33571 .next
33572 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
33573 .next
33574 I/O errors at any time,
33575 .next
33576 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
33577 the &"."& at the end of the data.
33578 .endlist ilist
33579
33580 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
33581 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
33582 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
33583 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
33584 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
33585 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
33586 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
33587 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
33588
33589 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
33590 .cindex "message" "error"
33591 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
33592 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
33593 message errors are:
33594
33595 .ilist
33596 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
33597 the data,
33598 .next
33599 Timeout after MAIL,
33600 .next
33601 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
33602 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
33603 connection at any other time.
33604 .endlist ilist
33605
33606 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
33607 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
33608 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
33609 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
33610 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
33611 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
33612 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
33613 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
33614 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
33615 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
33616
33617 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
33618 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
33619 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
33620 response to MAIL.
33621
33622 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
33623 .cindex "recipient" "error"
33624 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
33625 recipient errors are:
33626
33627 .ilist
33628 Any error response to RCPT,
33629 .next
33630 Timeout after RCPT.
33631 .endlist
33632
33633 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
33634 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
33635 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
33636 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
33637 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
33638 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
33639 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
33640 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
33641 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
33642 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
33643 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
33644 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
33645 the retry clock is reset.
33646
33647 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
33648 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
33649 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
33650 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
33651 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
33652 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
33653 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
33654 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
33655 recipient's retry time.
33656 .endlist
33657
33658 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
33659 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
33660 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
33661 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
33662 until the next delivery attempt.
33663
33664 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
33665 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
33666 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
33667 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
33668 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
33669 is created.
33670
33671 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
33672 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
33673 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
33674 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
33675 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
33676 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
33677 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
33678
33679 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
33680 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
33681 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
33682 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
33683 then to be treated as a host error.
33684
33685 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
33686 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
33687 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
33688 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
33689 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
33690
33691
33692
33693
33694 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
33695 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
33696 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
33697 .cindex "inetd"
33698 .cindex "daemon"
33699 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
33700 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
33701 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
33702 .code
33703 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
33704 .endd
33705 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
33706 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
33707 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
33708 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
33709 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
33710 stream and exits with an error code.
33711
33712 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
33713 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
33714 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
33715 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
33716
33717 .cindex "carriage return"
33718 .cindex "linefeed"
33719 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
33720 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
33721 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
33722 line terminator.
33723 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
33724 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
33725 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
33726
33727 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
33728 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
33729 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
33730 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
33731 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
33732 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
33733 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
33734 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
33735
33736 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
33737 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
33738 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
33739 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
33740 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
33741 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
33742 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
33743 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
33744 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
33745
33746 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
33747 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
33748 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
33749
33750 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
33751 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
33752 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
33753 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
33754 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
33755
33756 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
33757 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
33758 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
33759 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
33760 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
33761 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
33762 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
33763
33764 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
33765 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
33766 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
33767 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
33768 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
33769
33770 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
33771 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
33772 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
33773 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
33774 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
33775 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
33776 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
33777 a delivery process.
33778
33779 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
33780 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
33781 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
33782 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
33783 however, available with &'inetd'&.
33784
33785 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
33786 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
33787 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
33788 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
33789
33790 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
33791 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
33792 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
33793
33794
33795
33796 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
33797 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
33798 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
33799 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
33800 the error response to the last command. The default value for
33801 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
33802 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
33803 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
33804
33805
33806 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
33807 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
33808 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
33809 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
33810 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
33811 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
33812 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
33813 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
33814 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
33815 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
33816 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
33817
33818
33819
33820 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
33821 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
33822 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
33823 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
33824 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
33825 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
33826 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
33827 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
33828
33829 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
33830 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
33831 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
33832 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
33833 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
33834 counted.
33835
33836 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
33837 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
33838 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
33839
33840 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
33841 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
33842 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
33843 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
33844 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
33845
33846
33847
33848
33849 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
33850 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
33851 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
33852 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
33853 If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
33854
33855 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
33856 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
33857 called with the &%-bv%& option.
33858
33859 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
33860 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
33861 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
33862 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
33863 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
33864 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
33865 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
33866 RCPT failures.
33867
33868
33869
33870 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
33871 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
33872 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
33873 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
33874 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
33875 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
33876 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
33877
33878 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
33879 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
33880 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
33881 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
33882 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
33883 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
33884 argument. For example,
33885 .code
33886 ETRN #brigadoon
33887 .endd
33888 runs the command
33889 .code
33890 exim -R brigadoon
33891 .endd
33892 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
33893 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
33894 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
33895 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
33896 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
33897
33898 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
33899 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
33900 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
33901 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
33902 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
33903 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
33904 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
33905 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
33906
33907 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
33908 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
33909 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
33910 whatever the form of its argument. For
33911 example:
33912 .code
33913 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
33914 $sender_host_address
33915 .endd
33916 .vindex "&$domain$&"
33917 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
33918 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
33919 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
33920 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
33921 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
33922 for it to change them before running the command.
33923
33924
33925
33926 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
33927 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
33928 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
33929 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
33930 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
33931 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
33932 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
33933 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
33934 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
33935 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
33936 runs for RCPT commands:
33937 .code
33938 accept hosts = :
33939 .endd
33940 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
33941
33942
33943
33944 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
33945 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
33946 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
33947 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
33948 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
33949 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
33950 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
33951 envelope along with the message.
33952
33953 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
33954 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
33955 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
33956 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
33957 can be used to specify it.
33958
33959 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
33960 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
33961 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
33962 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
33963 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
33964
33965 .vindex "&$host$&"
33966 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
33967 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
33968 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
33969 router:
33970 .code
33971 begin routers
33972 route_append:
33973 driver = manualroute
33974 transport = smtp_appendfile
33975 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
33976
33977 begin transports
33978 smtp_appendfile:
33979 driver = appendfile
33980 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
33981 batch_max = 1000
33982 use_bsmtp
33983 user = exim
33984 .endd
33985 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
33986 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
33987 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
33988
33989
33990
33991 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
33992 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
33993 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
33994 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
33995 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
33996 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
33997 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
33998 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
33999 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
34000 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
34001
34002 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
34003 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
34004
34005 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
34006 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
34007 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
34008 make some use of automatically, for example:
34009 .code
34010 554 Unexpected end of file
34011 Transaction started in line 10
34012 Error detected in line 14
34013 .endd
34014 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
34015 file, for example:
34016 .code
34017 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
34018 The error message was:
34019
34020 501 '>' missing at end of address
34021
34022 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
34023 The error was detected in line 12.
34024 The SMTP command at fault was:
34025
34026 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
34027
34028 1 previous message was successfully processed.
34029 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
34030 .endd
34031 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
34032 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
34033 accepted.
34034 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
34035 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
34036
34037
34038
34039 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34040 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34041
34042 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
34043 "Customizing messages"
34044 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
34045 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
34046 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
34047 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
34048 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
34049
34050 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
34051 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
34052 option. Exim also adds the line
34053 .code
34054 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
34055 .endd
34056 to all warning and bounce messages,
34057
34058
34059 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
34060 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
34061 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
34062 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
34063 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
34064 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
34065 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
34066
34067 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
34068 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
34069 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
34070 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
34071 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
34072 item.
34073
34074 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
34075 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
34076 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
34077 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
34078 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
34079 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
34080 option, rounded to a whole number.
34081
34082 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
34083
34084 .ilist
34085 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
34086 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
34087 .next
34088 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
34089 failing addresses with their error messages.
34090 .next
34091 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
34092 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
34093 .next
34094 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
34095 The fields exist for back-compatibility
34096 .endlist
34097
34098 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
34099 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
34100 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
34101 .code
34102 Subject: Mail delivery failed
34103 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
34104 {: returning message to sender}}
34105 ****
34106 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
34107
34108 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
34109 {that you sent }{sent by
34110
34111 <$sender_address>
34112
34113 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
34114 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
34115 ****
34116 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
34117 ****
34118 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
34119 ------
34120 ****
34121 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
34122 only the first
34123 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
34124 ****
34125 .endd
34126 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
34127 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
34128 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
34129 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
34130 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
34131 text sections:
34132
34133 .ilist
34134 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
34135 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
34136 .next
34137 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
34138 the delayed addresses.
34139 .next
34140 The third item then ends the message.
34141 .endlist
34142
34143 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
34144 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
34145 .code
34146 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
34147 $warn_message_delay
34148 ****
34149 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
34150
34151 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
34152 {that you sent }{sent by
34153
34154 <$sender_address>
34155
34156 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
34157 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
34158
34159 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
34160 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
34161 The date of the message is: $h_date
34162
34163 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
34164 ****
34165 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
34166 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
34167 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
34168 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
34169 the message will be returned to you.
34170 .endd
34171 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
34172 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
34173 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
34174 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
34175 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
34176 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
34177 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
34178 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
34179 handled them.
34180
34181
34182
34183
34184 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34185 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34186
34187 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
34188 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
34189 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
34190
34191
34192
34193 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
34194 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
34195 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
34196 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
34197 routing explicitly:
34198 .code
34199 send_to_smart_host:
34200 driver = manualroute
34201 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
34202 transport = remote_smtp
34203 .endd
34204 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
34205 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
34206 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
34207 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
34208 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
34209
34210
34211
34212
34213 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
34214 .cindex "mailing lists"
34215 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
34216 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
34217 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
34218
34219 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
34220 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
34221 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
34222 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
34223 .code
34224 lists:
34225 driver = redirect
34226 domains = lists.example
34227 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
34228 forbid_pipe
34229 forbid_file
34230 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
34231 no_more
34232 .endd
34233 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
34234 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
34235 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
34236 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
34237
34238 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
34239 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
34240 a mailing list.
34241
34242 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
34243 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
34244 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
34245 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
34246 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
34247
34248 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
34249 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
34250 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
34251 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
34252 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
34253 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
34254 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
34255 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
34256 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
34257
34258
34259
34260 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
34261 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
34262 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
34263 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
34264 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
34265 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
34266 addresses are not rigorously checked.
34267
34268 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
34269 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
34270 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
34271 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
34272 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
34273
34274
34275
34276 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
34277 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
34278 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
34279 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
34280 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
34281 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
34282 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
34283 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
34284 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
34285 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
34286
34287 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
34288 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
34289 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
34290 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
34291 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
34292 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
34293 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
34294 pre-existing messages.
34295
34296 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
34297 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
34298 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
34299 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
34300 one level of expansion anyway.
34301
34302
34303
34304 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
34305 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
34306 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
34307 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
34308 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
34309 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
34310
34311 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
34312 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
34313 .code
34314 lists_request:
34315 driver = redirect
34316 domains = lists.example
34317 local_part_suffix = -request
34318 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
34319 no_more
34320
34321 lists_post:
34322 driver = redirect
34323 domains = lists.example
34324 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
34325 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
34326 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
34327 forbid_pipe
34328 forbid_file
34329 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
34330 no_more
34331
34332 lists_closed:
34333 driver = redirect
34334 domains = lists.example
34335 allow_fail
34336 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
34337 .endd
34338 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
34339 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
34340 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
34341 mailing list.
34342
34343 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
34344 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
34345 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
34346 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
34347 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
34348 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
34349 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
34350 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
34351 &"unrouteable address"& error.
34352
34353 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
34354 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
34355 the address, giving a suitable error message.
34356
34357
34358
34359
34360 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
34361 .cindex "VERP"
34362 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
34363 .cindex "envelope sender"
34364 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
34365 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
34366 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
34367 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
34368 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
34369 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
34370
34371 .oindex &%errors_to%&
34372 .oindex &%return_path%&
34373 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
34374 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
34375 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
34376 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
34377 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
34378 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
34379 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
34380 .code
34381 verp_smtp:
34382 driver = smtp
34383 max_rcpt = 1
34384 return_path = \
34385 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
34386 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
34387 .endd
34388 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
34389 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
34390 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
34391 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
34392 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
34393 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
34394 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
34395 rewritten as
34396 .code
34397 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
34398 .endd
34399 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
34400 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
34401 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
34402 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
34403 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
34404 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
34405
34406 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
34407 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
34408 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
34409 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
34410 .code
34411 dnslookup:
34412 driver = dnslookup
34413 domains = ! +local_domains
34414 transport = \
34415 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
34416 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
34417 no_more
34418 .endd
34419 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
34420 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
34421 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
34422 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
34423 address.
34424
34425 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
34426 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
34427 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
34428 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
34429 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
34430 .code
34431 verp_dnslookup:
34432 driver = dnslookup
34433 domains = ! +local_domains
34434 transport = remote_smtp
34435 errors_to = \
34436 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
34437 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
34438 no_more
34439 .endd
34440 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
34441 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
34442 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
34443 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
34444 them.
34445
34446 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
34447 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
34448 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
34449 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
34450 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
34451 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
34452 used).
34453
34454
34455
34456
34457
34458
34459 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
34460 .cindex "virtual domains"
34461 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
34462 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
34463 meanings:
34464
34465 .ilist
34466 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
34467 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
34468 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
34469 .next
34470 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
34471 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
34472 have login accounts on that host.
34473 .endlist
34474
34475 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
34476 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
34477 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
34478 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
34479 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
34480 to a router of this form:
34481 .code
34482 virtual:
34483 driver = redirect
34484 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
34485 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
34486 no_more
34487 .endd
34488 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
34489 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
34490 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
34491 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
34492 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
34493 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
34494
34495 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
34496 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
34497 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
34498 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
34499
34500 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
34501 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
34502 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
34503 .code
34504 my_domains:
34505 driver = accept
34506 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
34507 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
34508 transport = my_mailboxes
34509 .endd
34510 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
34511 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
34512 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
34513 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
34514 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
34515 follows:
34516 .code
34517 my_mailboxes:
34518 driver = appendfile
34519 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
34520 user = mail
34521 .endd
34522 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
34523 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
34524
34525 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
34526 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
34527 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
34528 information about the domains.
34529
34530
34531
34532 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
34533 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
34534 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
34535 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
34536 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
34537 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
34538 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
34539 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
34540 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
34541 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
34542 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
34543 example, consider this router:
34544 .code
34545 userforward:
34546 driver = redirect
34547 check_local_user
34548 file = $home/.forward
34549 local_part_suffix = -*
34550 local_part_suffix_optional
34551 allow_filter
34552 .endd
34553 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
34554 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
34555 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
34556 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
34557 .code
34558 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
34559 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
34560 endif
34561 .endd
34562 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
34563 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
34564 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
34565 control over which suffixes are valid.
34566
34567 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
34568 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
34569 another MTA:
34570 .code
34571 userforward:
34572 driver = redirect
34573 check_local_user
34574 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
34575 local_part_suffix = -*
34576 local_part_suffix_optional
34577 allow_filter
34578 .endd
34579 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
34580 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
34581 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
34582 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
34583 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
34584
34585
34586
34587 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
34588 .cindex "vacation processing"
34589 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
34590 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
34591 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
34592 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
34593 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
34594
34595 .ilist
34596 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
34597 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
34598 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
34599 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
34600 .code
34601 spqr, vacation-spqr
34602 .endd
34603 .next
34604 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
34605 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
34606 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
34607 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
34608 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
34609 message.
34610 .endlist
34611
34612 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
34613 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
34614
34615
34616
34617 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
34618 .cindex "message" "copying every"
34619 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
34620 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
34621 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
34622 each day's messages.
34623
34624 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
34625 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
34626 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
34627 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
34628
34629
34630
34631 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
34632 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
34633 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
34634 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
34635 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
34636 permanently connected.
34637
34638 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
34639 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
34640 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
34641
34642
34643 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
34644 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
34645 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
34646 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
34647 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
34648 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
34649 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
34650 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
34651
34652 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
34653 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
34654 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
34655 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
34656 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
34657 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
34658 if required.
34659
34660 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
34661 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
34662 intermittent host. For example:
34663 .code
34664 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
34665 .endd
34666 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
34667 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
34668 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
34669 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
34670 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
34671 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
34672 immediately.
34673
34674 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
34675 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
34676 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
34677 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
34678 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
34679 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
34680 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
34681
34682
34683
34684 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
34685 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
34686 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
34687 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
34688 delivered immediately.
34689
34690 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
34691 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
34692 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
34693 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
34694 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
34695 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
34696 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
34697 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
34698 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
34699 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
34700 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
34701 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
34702 single SMTP connection.
34703
34704
34705
34706 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34707 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34708
34709 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
34710 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
34711 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
34712 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
34713 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
34714 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
34715 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
34716 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
34717 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
34718 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
34719 messages this way.
34720
34721 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
34722 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
34723 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
34724 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
34725 email is not desirable.
34726
34727 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
34728 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
34729 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
34730 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
34731 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
34732 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
34733 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
34734
34735 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
34736 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
34737 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
34738 before sending a message to the smart host.
34739
34740 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
34741 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
34742 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
34743
34744 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
34745 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
34746 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
34747 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
34748 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
34749 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
34750 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
34751
34752 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
34753 following ways:
34754
34755 .ilist
34756 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
34757 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
34758 .next
34759 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
34760 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
34761 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
34762 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
34763 successful, a zero return code is given.
34764 .next
34765 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
34766 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
34767 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
34768 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
34769 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
34770 are.
34771 .next
34772 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
34773 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
34774 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
34775 .next
34776 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
34777 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
34778 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
34779 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
34780 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
34781 .next
34782 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
34783 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
34784 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
34785 .next
34786 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
34787 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
34788 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
34789 are ever generated.
34790 .next
34791 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
34792 .next
34793 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
34794 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
34795 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
34796 .endlist
34797
34798 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
34799 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
34800 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
34801 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
34802 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
34803 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
34804
34805
34806
34807
34808 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34809 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34810
34811 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
34812 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
34813 .cindex "log" "types of"
34814 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
34815 and the panic log:
34816
34817 .ilist
34818 .cindex "main log"
34819 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
34820 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
34821 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
34822 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
34823 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
34824 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
34825 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
34826 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
34827 .next
34828 .cindex "reject log"
34829 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
34830 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
34831 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
34832 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
34833 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
34834 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
34835 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
34836 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
34837 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
34838 false.
34839 .next
34840 .cindex "panic log"
34841 .cindex "system log"
34842 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
34843 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
34844 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
34845 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
34846 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
34847 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
34848 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
34849 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
34850 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
34851 .endlist
34852
34853 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
34854 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
34855 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
34856 .code
34857 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
34858 by QUIT
34859 .endd
34860 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
34861 ways of changing this:
34862
34863 .ilist
34864 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
34865 you set
34866 .code
34867 timezone = UTC
34868 .endd
34869 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
34870 .next
34871 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
34872 example:
34873 .code
34874 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
34875 .endd
34876 .endlist
34877
34878 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
34879 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
34880 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
34881 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
34882 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
34883 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
34884
34885
34886
34887
34888 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
34889 .cindex "log" "destination"
34890 .cindex "log" "to file"
34891 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
34892 .cindex "syslog"
34893 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
34894 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
34895 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
34896 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
34897 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
34898 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
34899 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
34900
34901 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
34902 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
34903 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
34904 references to the host name:
34905 .code
34906 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
34907 .endd
34908 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
34909 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
34910 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
34911 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
34912 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
34913 log at all.
34914
34915 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
34916 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
34917 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
34918 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
34919 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
34920 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
34921 implying the use of a default path.
34922
34923 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
34924 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
34925 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
34926 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
34927 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
34928 equivalent to the setting:
34929 .code
34930 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
34931 .endd
34932 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time,
34933 or if you unset the option at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
34934 that is where the logs are written.
34935
34936 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
34937 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
34938
34939 Here are some examples of possible settings:
34940 .display
34941 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
34942 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
34943 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
34944 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
34945 .endd
34946 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
34947 error is logged.
34948
34949
34950
34951 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
34952 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
34953 .cindex "cycling logs"
34954 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
34955 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
34956 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
34957 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
34958 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
34959 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
34960 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
34961
34962 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
34963 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
34964 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
34965 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
34966 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
34967 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
34968 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
34969 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
34970 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
34971 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
34972 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
34973 renamed.
34974
34975
34976
34977 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
34978 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
34979 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
34980 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
34981 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
34982 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
34983 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
34984 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
34985 .code
34986 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
34987 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
34988 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
34989 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
34990 .endd
34991 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
34992 examples of names generated by the above examples:
34993 .code
34994 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
34995 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
34996 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
34997 /var/log/exim/main.200212
34998 .endd
34999 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
35000 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
35001 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
35002 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
35003
35004 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
35005 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
35006 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
35007 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
35008 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
35009 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
35010 log names:
35011 .code
35012 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
35013 /var/log/exim-panic.log
35014 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
35015 /var/log/exim/panic
35016 .endd
35017
35018
35019 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
35020 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
35021 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
35022 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
35023 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
35024 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
35025 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
35026 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
35027 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
35028 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
35029 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
35030 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
35031 the time and host name to each line.
35032 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
35033
35034 .ilist
35035 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
35036 .next
35037 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
35038 .next
35039 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
35040 .endlist
35041
35042 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
35043 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
35044 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
35045 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
35046
35047 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
35048 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
35049 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
35050 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
35051 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
35052 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
35053 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
35054 RFC 3164, you should set
35055 .code
35056 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
35057 .endd
35058 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
35059 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
35060
35061 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
35062 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
35063 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
35064 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
35065 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
35066 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
35067 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
35068 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
35069 name, and pid as added by syslog:
35070 .code
35071 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
35072 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
35073 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
35074 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
35075 [5/5] mple>)
35076 .endd
35077 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
35078 (LOG_NOTICE):
35079 .code
35080 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
35081 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
35082 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
35083 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
35084 [5\18] .example>)
35085 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
35086 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
35087 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
35088 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
35089 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
35090 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
35091 [12\18] F From: <>
35092 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
35093 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
35094 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
35095 [16\18] le>
35096 [17\18] B Bcc:
35097 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
35098 .endd
35099 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
35100 without modification.
35101
35102 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
35103 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
35104 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
35105 where it is.
35106
35107
35108
35109 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
35110 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
35111 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
35112 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
35113 timestamp. The flags are:
35114 .display
35115 &`<=`& message arrival
35116 &`=>`& normal message delivery
35117 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
35118 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
35119 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
35120 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
35121 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
35122 .endd
35123
35124
35125 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
35126 .cindex "log" "reception line"
35127 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
35128 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
35129 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
35130 .code
35131 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
35132 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
35133 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
35134 .endd
35135 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
35136 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
35137 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
35138 .code
35139 R=<message id>
35140 .endd
35141 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
35142
35143 .cindex "HELO"
35144 .cindex "EHLO"
35145 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
35146 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
35147 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
35148 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
35149 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
35150 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
35151 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
35152 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
35153 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
35154 name in parentheses.
35155
35156 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
35157 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
35158 the log containing text like these examples:
35159 .code
35160 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
35161 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
35162 .endd
35163 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
35164 on.
35165
35166 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
35167 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
35168 of Exim.
35169
35170 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
35171 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
35172 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
35173 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
35174 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
35175 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
35176 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
35177 suite that was used.
35178
35179 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
35180 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
35181 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
35182 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
35183 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
35184 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
35185 authenticator name.
35186
35187 .cindex "size" "of message"
35188 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
35189 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
35190 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
35191 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
35192 other).
35193
35194 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
35195 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
35196
35197
35198
35199 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
35200 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
35201 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
35202 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
35203 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
35204 to fit it on the page:
35205 .code
35206 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
35207 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
35208 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
35209 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
35210 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
35211 .endd
35212 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
35213 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
35214 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
35215 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
35216 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
35217
35218 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
35219 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
35220 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
35221 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
35222
35223 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
35224 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
35225 .display
35226 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
35227 .endd
35228 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
35229 parentheses afterwards.
35230
35231 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
35232 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
35233 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
35234 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
35235 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
35236 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
35237
35238 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
35239 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
35240 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
35241 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
35242 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
35243
35244 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
35245 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
35246
35247 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
35248 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
35249
35250
35251 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
35252 .cindex "discarded messages"
35253 .cindex "message" "discarded"
35254 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
35255 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
35256 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
35257 .code
35258 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
35259 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
35260 .endd
35261 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
35262 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
35263 .code
35264 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
35265 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
35266 .endd
35267
35268
35269 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
35270 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
35271 .code
35272 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
35273 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
35274 .endd
35275 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
35276 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
35277 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
35278 .code
35279 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
35280 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
35281 .endd
35282 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
35283 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
35284 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
35285
35286
35287
35288 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
35289 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
35290 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
35291 following form is logged:
35292 .code
35293 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
35294 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
35295 .endd
35296 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
35297 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
35298 .code
35299 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
35300 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
35301 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
35302 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
35303 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
35304 .endd
35305 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
35306 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
35307 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
35308 flagged with &`**`&.
35309
35310
35311
35312 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
35313 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
35314 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
35315 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
35316 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
35317
35318
35319
35320 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
35321 A line of the form
35322 .code
35323 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
35324 .endd
35325 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
35326 at the end of its processing.
35327
35328
35329
35330
35331 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
35332 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
35333 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
35334 the following table:
35335 .display
35336 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
35337 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
35338 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
35339 &`CV `& certificate verification status
35340 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
35341 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
35342 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
35343 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
35344 &`H `& host name and IP address
35345 &`I `& local interface used
35346 &`id `& message id for incoming message
35347 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
35348 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
35349 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
35350 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
35351 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
35352 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
35353 &`S `& size of message
35354 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
35355 &`ST `& shadow transport name
35356 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
35357 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
35358 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
35359 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
35360 .endd
35361
35362
35363 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
35364 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
35365 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
35366
35367 .ilist
35368 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
35369 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
35370 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
35371 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
35372 during the first delivery attempt.
35373 .next
35374 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
35375 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
35376 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
35377 .next
35378 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
35379 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
35380 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
35381 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
35382 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
35383 doing.
35384 .next
35385 .cindex "error" "ignored"
35386 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
35387 message:
35388 .olist
35389 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
35390 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
35391 .next
35392 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
35393 failed. The delivery was discarded.
35394 .next
35395 A delivery set up by a router configured with
35396 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
35397 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
35398 .code
35399 errors_to = <>
35400 .endd
35401 failed. The delivery was discarded.
35402 .endlist olist
35403 .endlist ilist
35404
35405
35406
35407
35408
35409 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
35410 .cindex "log" "selectors"
35411 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
35412 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
35413 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
35414 example:
35415 .code
35416 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
35417 .endd
35418 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
35419 selection marked by asterisks:
35420 .display
35421 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
35422 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
35423 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
35424 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
35425 &` arguments `& command line arguments
35426 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
35427 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
35428 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
35429 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
35430 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
35431 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
35432 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
35433 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
35434 &` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
35435 &` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
35436 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
35437 .new
35438 &` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
35439 .wen
35440 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
35441 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
35442 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
35443 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
35444 &` pid `& Exim process id
35445 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
35446 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
35447 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
35448 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
35449 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
35450 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
35451 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
35452 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
35453 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
35454 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
35455 &` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
35456 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
35457 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
35458 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
35459 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
35460 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
35461 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
35462 &`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
35463 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
35464 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
35465 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
35466 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
35467
35468 &` all `& all of the above
35469 .endd
35470 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
35471 section &<<SECID99>>&
35472
35473 More details on each of these items follows:
35474
35475 .ilist
35476 .cindex "8BITMIME"
35477 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
35478 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
35479 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
35480 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
35481 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
35482 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
35483 .next
35484 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
35485 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
35486 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
35487 this log selector is set.
35488 .next
35489 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
35490 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
35491 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
35492 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
35493 such users cannot access the log).
35494 .next
35495 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
35496 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
35497 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
35498 parentheses between them.
35499 .next
35500 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
35501 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
35502 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
35503 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
35504 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
35505 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
35506 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
35507 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
35508 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
35509 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
35510 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
35511 between the caller and Exim.
35512 .next
35513 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
35514 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
35515 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
35516 .next
35517 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
35518 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
35519 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
35520 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
35521 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
35522 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
35523 .next
35524 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
35525 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
35526 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
35527 .next
35528 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
35529 .cindex "size" "of message"
35530 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
35531 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
35532 .next
35533 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
35534 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
35535 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
35536 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
35537 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
35538 .next
35539 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
35540 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
35541 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
35542 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
35543 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
35544 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
35545 .next
35546 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
35547 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
35548 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
35549 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
35550 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
35551 .next
35552 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
35553 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
35554 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
35555 client's ident port times out.
35556 .next
35557 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
35558 .cindex "log" "local interface"
35559 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
35560 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
35561 .cindex "interface" "logging"
35562 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
35563 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
35564 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
35565 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, to
35566 rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
35567 .new
35568 The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
35569 .wen
35570 .next
35571 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
35572 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
35573 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
35574 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
35575 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
35576 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
35577 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
35578 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
35579 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
35580 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
35581 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
35582 .next
35583 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
35584 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
35585 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
35586 .next
35587 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
35588 .cindex "log" "local interface"
35589 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
35590 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
35591 .cindex "interface" "logging"
35592 .new
35593 &%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
35594 interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
35595 followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
35596 off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
35597 .wen
35598 .next
35599 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
35600 .cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
35601 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging ougtoing remote port"
35602 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
35603 containing => tags) following the IP address.
35604 .new
35605 The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
35606 &%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
35607 .wen
35608 This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
35609 configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
35610 local port is a random ephemeral port.
35611 .next
35612 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
35613 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
35614 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
35615 immediately after the time and date.
35616 .next
35617 .cindex "log" "queue run"
35618 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
35619 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
35620 .next
35621 .cindex "log" "queue time"
35622 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
35623 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
35624 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
35625 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
35626 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
35627 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
35628 message has been successfully received.
35629 .next
35630 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
35631 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
35632 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
35633 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
35634 .next
35635 .cindex "log" "recipients"
35636 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
35637 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
35638 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
35639 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
35640 has taken place.
35641 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
35642 in the list.
35643 .next
35644 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
35645 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
35646 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
35647 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
35648 .next
35649 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
35650 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
35651 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
35652 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
35653 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
35654 .next
35655 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
35656 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
35657 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
35658 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
35659 attempt.
35660 .next
35661 .cindex "log" "return path"
35662 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
35663 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
35664 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
35665 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
35666 .next
35667 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
35668 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
35669 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
35670 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
35671 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
35672 .next
35673 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
35674 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
35675 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
35676 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
35677 detail is lost.
35678 .next
35679 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
35680 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
35681 it is too big.
35682 .next
35683 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
35684 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
35685 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
35686 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
35687 it.
35688 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
35689 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
35690 .next
35691 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
35692 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
35693 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
35694 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
35695 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
35696 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
35697 response.
35698 .next
35699 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
35700 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
35701 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
35702 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
35703 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
35704 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
35705 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
35706 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
35707 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
35708 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
35709
35710 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
35711 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
35712 reset if the daemon is restarted.
35713 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
35714 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
35715 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
35716 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
35717 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
35718 .next
35719 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
35720 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
35721 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
35722 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
35723 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
35724 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
35725 .next
35726 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
35727 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
35728 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
35729 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
35730 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
35731 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
35732 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
35733 already have their own log lines.
35734
35735 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
35736 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
35737 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
35738 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
35739 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
35740 the same logging options.
35741
35742 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
35743 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
35744 .code
35745 C=EHLO,QUIT
35746 .endd
35747 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
35748 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
35749 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
35750 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
35751 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
35752 .next
35753 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
35754 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
35755 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
35756 was accepted or used.
35757 .next
35758 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
35759 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
35760 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
35761 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
35762 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
35763 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
35764 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
35765 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
35766 .next
35767 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
35768 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
35769 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
35770 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
35771 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
35772 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
35773 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
35774 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
35775 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
35776 .next
35777 .cindex "log" "subject"
35778 .cindex "subject, logging"
35779 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
35780 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
35781 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
35782 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
35783 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
35784 .next
35785 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
35786 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
35787 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
35788 verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
35789 .next
35790 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
35791 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
35792 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
35793 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
35794 .next
35795 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
35796 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
35797 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
35798 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
35799 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
35800 .next
35801 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
35802 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
35803 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
35804 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
35805 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
35806 .next
35807 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
35808 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
35809 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
35810 .endlist
35811
35812
35813 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
35814 .cindex "message" "log file for"
35815 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
35816 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
35817 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
35818 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
35819 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
35820 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
35821 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
35822 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
35823 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
35824 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
35825 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
35826
35827 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
35828 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
35829 &%message_logs%& option false.
35830 .ecindex IIDloggen
35831
35832
35833
35834
35835 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35836 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35837
35838 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
35839 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
35840 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
35841 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
35842 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
35843
35844 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
35845 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
35846 "list what Exim processes are doing"
35847 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
35848 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
35849 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
35850 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
35851 various criteria"
35852 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
35853 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
35854 "extract statistics from the log"
35855 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
35856 "check address acceptance from given IP"
35857 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
35858 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
35859 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
35860 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
35861 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
35862 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
35863 .endtable
35864
35865 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
35866 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
35867 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
35868
35869
35870
35871
35872 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
35873 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
35874 .cindex "process, querying"
35875 .cindex "SIGUSR1"
35876 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
35877 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
35878 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
35879 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
35880 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
35881 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
35882 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
35883 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
35884
35885 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
35886 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
35887 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
35888
35889
35890 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
35891 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
35892 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
35893 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
35894 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
35895 options:
35896 .display
35897 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
35898 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
35899 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
35900 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
35901 .endd
35902 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
35903 .code
35904 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
35905 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
35906 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
35907 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
35908 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
35909 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
35910 .endd
35911 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
35912 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
35913
35914
35915
35916 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
35917 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
35918 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
35919 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
35920 .code
35921 exim -bpu
35922 .endd
35923 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
35924 .code
35925 exim -bp
35926 .endd
35927 The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
35928 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
35929
35930 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
35931 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
35932
35933 .vlist
35934 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
35935 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
35936 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
35937 .code
35938 exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
35939 .endd
35940 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
35941 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
35942 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
35943
35944 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
35945 Match against the size field.
35946
35947 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
35948 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
35949
35950 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
35951 Match messages that are older than the given time.
35952
35953 .vitem &*-z*&
35954 Match only frozen messages.
35955
35956 .vitem &*-x*&
35957 Match only non-frozen messages.
35958 .endlist
35959
35960 The following options control the format of the output:
35961
35962 .vlist
35963 .vitem &*-c*&
35964 Display only the count of matching messages.
35965
35966 .vitem &*-l*&
35967 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
35968 the default.
35969
35970 .vitem &*-i*&
35971 Display message ids only.
35972
35973 .vitem &*-b*&
35974 Brief format &-- one line per message.
35975
35976 .vitem &*-R*&
35977 Display messages in reverse order.
35978
35979 .vitem &*-a*&
35980 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
35981 .endlist
35982
35983 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
35984
35985
35986
35987 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
35988 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
35989 .cindex "queue" "summary"
35990 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
35991 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
35992 running a command such as
35993 .code
35994 exim -bp | exiqsumm
35995 .endd
35996 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
35997 it, as in the following example:
35998 .code
35999 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
36000 .endd
36001 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
36002 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
36003 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
36004 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
36005
36006 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
36007 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
36008 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
36009 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
36010 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
36011 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
36012 sender.
36013
36014 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
36015 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
36016 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
36017 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
36018 level"& addresses).
36019
36020
36021
36022
36023 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
36024 "SECTextspeinf"
36025 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
36026 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
36027 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
36028 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
36029 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
36030 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
36031 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
36032 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
36033 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
36034 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
36035 .display
36036 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
36037 .endd
36038 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
36039
36040 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
36041 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
36042 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
36043
36044 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
36045 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
36046 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
36047 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
36048 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
36049
36050 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
36051 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
36052 regular expression.
36053
36054 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
36055 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
36056
36057 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
36058 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
36059 normally.
36060
36061 Example of &%-M%&:
36062 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
36063 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
36064 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
36065 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
36066 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
36067 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
36068 search term.
36069
36070 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
36071 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
36072 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
36073 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
36074 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
36075
36076
36077 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
36078 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
36079 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
36080 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
36081 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, visit the web page at
36082 &url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run &'exipick'& with
36083 the &%--help%& option.
36084
36085
36086 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
36087 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
36088 .cindex "cycling logs"
36089 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
36090 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
36091 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
36092 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
36093 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
36094 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
36095 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
36096 .ilist
36097 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
36098 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
36099 .next
36100 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
36101 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
36102 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
36103 configuration.
36104 .endlist
36105
36106 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
36107 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
36108 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
36109 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
36110 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
36111 logs are handled similarly.
36112
36113 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
36114 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
36115 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
36116 any existing log files.
36117
36118 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
36119 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
36120 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
36121 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
36122 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
36123 .code
36124 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
36125 .endd
36126 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
36127 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
36128
36129
36130
36131 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
36132 .cindex "statistics"
36133 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
36134 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
36135 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
36136 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
36137 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
36138
36139 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
36140 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
36141 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
36142 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
36143 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
36144 .code
36145 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
36146 .endd
36147 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
36148 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
36149 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
36150 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
36151 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
36152 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
36153 also produced per user.
36154
36155 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
36156 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
36157 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
36158 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
36159 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
36160
36161 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
36162 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
36163 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
36164 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
36165 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
36166 an entirely separate message.
36167
36168 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
36169 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
36170 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
36171 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
36172 least one address that failed.
36173
36174 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
36175 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
36176 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
36177 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
36178 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
36179 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
36180 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
36181
36182 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
36183 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
36184 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
36185
36186 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
36187 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
36188 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
36189 .code
36190 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
36191 .endd
36192
36193 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
36194 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
36195 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
36196 .cindex "checking access"
36197 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
36198 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
36199 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
36200 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
36201 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
36202 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
36203
36204 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
36205 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
36206 .code
36207 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
36208 .endd
36209 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
36210 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
36211 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
36212 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
36213 .code
36214 Rejected:
36215 550 Relay not permitted
36216 .endd
36217 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
36218 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
36219 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
36220 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
36221 you can use:
36222 .code
36223 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
36224 -f himself@there.example
36225 .endd
36226 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
36227 mandatory arguments.
36228
36229 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
36230 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
36231 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
36232
36233
36234
36235 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
36236 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
36237 .cindex "building DBM files"
36238 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
36239 .cindex "lower casing"
36240 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
36241 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
36242 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
36243 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
36244 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
36245 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
36246
36247 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
36248 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
36249 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
36250 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
36251 files.
36252
36253 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
36254 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
36255 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
36256 well.
36257
36258 .cindex "USE_DB"
36259 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
36260 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
36261 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
36262 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
36263 .code
36264 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
36265 .endd
36266 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
36267 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
36268
36269 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
36270 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
36271 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
36272 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
36273 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
36274 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
36275
36276 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
36277 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
36278 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
36279 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
36280 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
36281 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
36282 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
36283 return code is 2.
36284
36285
36286
36287
36288 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
36289 .cindex "retry" "times"
36290 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
36291 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
36292 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
36293 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
36294 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
36295 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
36296 output. For example:
36297 .code
36298 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
36299 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
36300 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
36301 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
36302 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
36303 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
36304 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
36305 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
36306 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
36307 past final cutoff time
36308 .endd
36309 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
36310 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
36311 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
36312 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
36313 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
36314 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
36315 run very often.
36316
36317 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
36318 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
36319 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
36320 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
36321 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
36322 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
36323
36324
36325
36326 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
36327 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
36328 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
36329 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
36330 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
36331 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
36332 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
36333
36334 .ilist
36335 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
36336 .next
36337 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
36338 for remote hosts
36339 .next
36340 &'callout'&: the callout cache
36341 .next
36342 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
36343 .next
36344 &'misc'&: other hints data
36345 .endlist
36346
36347 The &'misc'& database is used for
36348
36349 .ilist
36350 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
36351 .next
36352 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
36353 &(smtp)& transport)
36354 .next
36355 Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
36356 in a transport)
36357 .endlist
36358
36359
36360
36361 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
36362 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
36363 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
36364 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
36365 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
36366 .code
36367 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
36368 .endd
36369 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
36370 .code
36371 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
36372 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
36373 .endd
36374 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
36375 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
36376 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
36377 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
36378 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
36379 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
36380 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
36381 and a textual description of the error.
36382
36383 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
36384 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
36385 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
36386 exceeded.
36387
36388 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
36389 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
36390 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
36391 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
36392 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
36393 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
36394 cross-references.
36395
36396
36397
36398 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
36399 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
36400 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
36401 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
36402 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
36403 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
36404 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
36405 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
36406 updated sufficiently often.
36407
36408 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
36409 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
36410 the retry database:
36411 .code
36412 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
36413 .endd
36414 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
36415 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
36416 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
36417 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
36418 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
36419 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
36420 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
36421 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
36422 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
36423 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
36424 whenever it removes information from the database.
36425
36426 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
36427 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
36428 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
36429 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
36430 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
36431
36432 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
36433 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
36434 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
36435 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
36436 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
36437 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
36438 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
36439 tidied.
36440
36441 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
36442 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
36443
36444
36445
36446
36447 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
36448 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
36449 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
36450 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
36451 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
36452 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
36453 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
36454 displayed.
36455
36456 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
36457 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
36458 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
36459 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
36460 by new data, for example:
36461 .code
36462 > 4 951102:1000
36463 .endd
36464 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
36465 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
36466 used as optional separators.
36467
36468
36469
36470
36471 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
36472 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
36473 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
36474 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
36475 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
36476 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
36477 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
36478 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
36479 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
36480 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
36481 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
36482 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
36483 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
36484
36485 .vlist
36486 .vitem &%-fcntl%&
36487 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
36488
36489 .vitem &%-flock%&
36490 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
36491 supports it.
36492
36493 .vitem &%-interval%&
36494 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
36495 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
36496
36497 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
36498 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
36499
36500 .vitem &%-mbx%&
36501 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
36502
36503 .vitem &%-q%&
36504 Suppress verification output.
36505
36506 .vitem &%-retries%&
36507 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
36508 the lock (default 10).
36509
36510 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
36511 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
36512 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
36513 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
36514 subsequently sees.
36515
36516 .vitem &%-timeout%&
36517 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
36518 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
36519 default), a non-blocking call is used.
36520
36521 .vitem &%-v%&
36522 Generate verbose output.
36523 .endlist
36524
36525 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
36526 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
36527 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
36528 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
36529 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
36530 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
36531 more than 30 minutes old.
36532
36533 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
36534 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
36535 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
36536 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
36537 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
36538 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
36539
36540 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
36541 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
36542 suppresses all output except error messages.
36543
36544 A command such as
36545 .code
36546 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
36547 .endd
36548 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
36549 .display
36550 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
36551 <&'some commands'&>
36552 &`End`&
36553 .endd
36554 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
36555 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
36556 such as
36557 .code
36558 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
36559 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
36560 .endd
36561 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
36562 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
36563 .ecindex IIDutils
36564
36565
36566 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36567 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36568
36569 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
36570 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
36571 .cindex "X-windows"
36572 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
36573 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
36574 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
36575 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
36576 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
36577 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
36578 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
36579 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
36580
36581
36582
36583 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
36584 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
36585 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
36586 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
36587 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
36588 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
36589 parameters are for.
36590
36591 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
36592 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
36593 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
36594 .code
36595 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
36596 .endd
36597 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
36598 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
36599 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
36600 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
36601 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
36602
36603 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
36604 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
36605 .code
36606 Eximon*background: gray94
36607 .endd
36608 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
36609 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
36610 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
36611 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
36612 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
36613 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
36614 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
36615 .code
36616 xrdb -merge <<End
36617 Eximon*highlight: gray
36618 End
36619 .endd
36620 .cindex "admin user"
36621 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
36622 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
36623
36624 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
36625 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
36626 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
36627 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
36628 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
36629
36630 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
36631 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
36632 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
36633 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
36634 different parts of the display.
36635
36636
36637
36638
36639 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
36640 .cindex "stripchart"
36641 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
36642 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
36643 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
36644 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
36645 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
36646 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
36647 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
36648 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
36649 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
36650
36651 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
36652 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
36653 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
36654 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
36655
36656 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
36657 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
36658 to a single partition.
36659
36660 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
36661 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
36662 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
36663 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
36664 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
36665 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
36666 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
36667
36668
36669
36670
36671 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
36672 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
36673 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
36674 .cindex "window size"
36675 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
36676 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
36677 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
36678 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
36679 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
36680 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
36681
36682 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
36683 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
36684 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
36685 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
36686
36687 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
36688 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
36689 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
36690 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
36691 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
36692 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36693
36694 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
36695 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
36696 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36697
36698
36699
36700 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
36701 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
36702 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
36703 the main log is maintained.
36704 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
36705 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
36706 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
36707 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
36708 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
36709
36710 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
36711 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
36712 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
36713 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
36714 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
36715 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
36716 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
36717 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
36718 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
36719 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
36720 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36721
36722 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
36723 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
36724 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
36725 It cannot go further back up the log.
36726
36727 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
36728 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
36729 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
36730 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
36731 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
36732 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
36733
36734 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
36735 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
36736 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
36737 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
36738 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
36739 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
36740
36741 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
36742 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
36743 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
36744 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
36745 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
36746 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
36747 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
36748 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
36749 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
36750 window.
36751
36752
36753
36754 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
36755 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
36756 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
36757 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
36758 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
36759 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
36760 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
36761 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
36762 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
36763 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
36764
36765 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
36766 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
36767 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
36768 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
36769 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
36770 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
36771 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
36772
36773 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
36774 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
36775 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
36776 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
36777 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
36778 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
36779 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
36780
36781 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
36782 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
36783 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
36784 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
36785
36786 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
36787 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
36788 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
36789 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
36790 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
36791 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
36792 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
36793 not shown.
36794
36795 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
36796 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
36797
36798 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
36799 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
36800 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
36801 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
36802 display is updated.
36803
36804
36805
36806 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
36807 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
36808 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
36809 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
36810 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
36811 any selected text.
36812
36813 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
36814 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
36815 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
36816 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
36817 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
36818 .code
36819 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
36820 .endd
36821 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
36822 follows:
36823
36824 .ilist
36825 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
36826 in a new text window.
36827 .next
36828 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
36829 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
36830 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
36831 .next
36832 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
36833 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
36834 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
36835 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
36836 .next
36837 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
36838 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
36839 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
36840 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
36841 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
36842 .next
36843 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
36844 that the message be frozen.
36845 .next
36846 .cindex "thawing messages"
36847 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
36848 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
36849 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
36850 that the message be thawed.
36851 .next
36852 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
36853 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
36854 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
36855 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
36856 .next
36857 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
36858 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
36859 message.
36860 .next
36861 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
36862 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
36863 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
36864 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
36865 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
36866 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
36867 which case no action is taken.
36868 .next
36869 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
36870 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
36871 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
36872 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
36873 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
36874 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
36875 case no action is taken.
36876 .next
36877 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
36878 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
36879 .next
36880 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
36881 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
36882 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
36883 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
36884 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
36885 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
36886 the address is qualified with that domain.
36887 .endlist
36888
36889 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
36890 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
36891 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
36892 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
36893 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
36894 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
36895 if no output is generated.
36896
36897 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
36898 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
36899 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
36900 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
36901
36902 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
36903 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
36904 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
36905 .ecindex IIDeximon
36906
36907
36908
36909
36910
36911 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36912 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36913
36914 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
36915 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
36916 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
36917 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
36918
36919 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
36920 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
36921 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
36922 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
36923 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
36924 its security as compared with other MTAs.
36925
36926 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
36927 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
36928 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
36929 as soon as possible.
36930
36931
36932 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
36933 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
36934 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
36935 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
36936 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
36937 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
36938
36939 .ilist
36940 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
36941 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
36942 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
36943 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
36944 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
36945 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
36946
36947 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
36948 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
36949 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
36950 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
36951 .next
36952
36953 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
36954 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
36955 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
36956 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
36957 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
36958 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
36959 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
36960 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
36961 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
36962 separate commands.
36963
36964 .next
36965 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
36966 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
36967 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
36968 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
36969 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
36970 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
36971 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
36972 .next
36973 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
36974 is disabled.
36975 .next
36976 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
36977 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
36978 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
36979 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
36980 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
36981 .endlist
36982
36983
36984
36985 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
36986 .cindex "setuid"
36987 .cindex "root privilege"
36988 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
36989 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
36990 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
36991 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
36992 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
36993 is required for two things:
36994
36995 .ilist
36996 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
36997 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
36998 not required.
36999 .next
37000 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
37001 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
37002 configuration.
37003 .endlist
37004
37005 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
37006 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
37007 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
37008 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
37009 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
37010 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
37011 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
37012 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
37013
37014 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
37015 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
37016 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
37017
37018 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
37019 uid and gid in the following cases:
37020
37021 .ilist
37022 .oindex "&%-C%&"
37023 .oindex "&%-D%&"
37024 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
37025 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
37026 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
37027 the calling process.
37028 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
37029 option may not be used at all.
37030 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
37031 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
37032 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
37033 .next
37034 .oindex "&%-be%&"
37035 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
37036 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
37037 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
37038 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
37039 calling process.
37040 .next
37041 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
37042 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
37043 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
37044 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
37045 testing address verification
37046 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
37047 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
37048 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
37049 option).
37050 .next
37051 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
37052 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
37053 .endlist
37054
37055 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
37056
37057 .ilist
37058 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
37059 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
37060 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
37061 will be used during message reception.
37062 .next
37063 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
37064 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
37065 .next
37066 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
37067 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
37068 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
37069 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
37070 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
37071 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
37072 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
37073 generating bounce and warning messages.
37074
37075 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
37076 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
37077 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
37078 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
37079 .next
37080 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
37081 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
37082 .endlist
37083
37084
37085
37086
37087 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
37088 .cindex "privilege, running without"
37089 .cindex "unprivileged running"
37090 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
37091 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
37092 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
37093 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
37094 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
37095 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
37096 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
37097 to any other uid.
37098
37099 .cindex SIGHUP
37100 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
37101 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
37102 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
37103 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
37104
37105 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
37106 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
37107 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
37108 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
37109 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
37110
37111 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
37112 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
37113 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
37114 effect.
37115
37116 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
37117 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
37118 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
37119
37120 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
37121 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
37122 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
37123 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
37124 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
37125 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
37126 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
37127 address this problem at this time.
37128
37129 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
37130 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
37131 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
37132 be used in the most straightforward way.
37133
37134 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
37135 number of restrictions on what you can do:
37136
37137 .ilist
37138 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
37139 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
37140 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
37141 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
37142 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
37143 .next
37144 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
37145 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
37146 .next
37147 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
37148 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
37149 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
37150 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
37151 .next
37152 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
37153 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
37154
37155 .olist
37156 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
37157 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
37158 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
37159 .next
37160 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
37161 owned by the Exim user.
37162 .next
37163 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
37164 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
37165 mailboxes need to be created manually.
37166 .endlist olist
37167 .endlist ilist
37168
37169
37170 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
37171 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
37172 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
37173 gives more security at essentially no cost.
37174
37175 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
37176 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
37177
37178
37179
37180
37181 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
37182 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
37183 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
37184
37185
37186
37187 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
37188 .cindex "security" "local commands"
37189 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
37190 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
37191 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
37192 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
37193 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
37194
37195 .ilist
37196 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
37197 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
37198 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
37199 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
37200 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
37201 .next
37202 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
37203 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
37204 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
37205 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
37206 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
37207 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
37208 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
37209 .next
37210 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
37211 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
37212 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
37213 .next
37214 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
37215 taint checking might apply to their usage.
37216 .next
37217 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
37218 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
37219 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
37220 .next
37221 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
37222 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
37223 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
37224 of opaque strings.
37225 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
37226 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
37227 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
37228 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
37229 .endlist
37230
37231
37232
37233
37234 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
37235 .cindex "security" "data sources"
37236 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
37237 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
37238 .cindex "PCRE" "security"
37239 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
37240 are some issues to be aware of:
37241
37242 .ilist
37243 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
37244 .next
37245 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
37246 .next
37247 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
37248 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
37249 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
37250 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
37251 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
37252 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
37253 data.
37254 .next
37255 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
37256 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
37257 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
37258 .next
37259 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
37260 expected to yield one result.
37261 .endlist
37262
37263
37264
37265
37266 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
37267 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
37268 .cindex "IP source routing"
37269 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
37270 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
37271 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
37272 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
37273
37274
37275
37276 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
37277 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
37278 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
37279
37280
37281
37282
37283 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
37284 .cindex "trusted users"
37285 .cindex "admin user"
37286 .cindex "privileged user"
37287 .cindex "user" "trusted"
37288 .cindex "user" "admin"
37289 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
37290 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
37291 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
37292 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
37293 permit a remote host to be specified.
37294
37295 .oindex "&%-f%&"
37296 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
37297 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
37298 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
37299 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
37300 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
37301 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
37302
37303 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
37304 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
37305 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
37306 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
37307 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
37308
37309 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
37310 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
37311 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
37312 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
37313 includes the contents of files on the spool.
37314
37315 .oindex "&%-M%&"
37316 .oindex "&%-q%&"
37317 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
37318 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
37319 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
37320 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
37321 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
37322 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
37323
37324 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
37325 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
37326 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
37327 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
37328 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
37329 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
37330 files.
37331
37332
37333
37334 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
37335 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
37336 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
37337 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
37338 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
37339 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
37340
37341
37342
37343 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
37344 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
37345 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
37346 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
37347 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
37348 this.
37349
37350
37351
37352 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
37353 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
37354 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
37355 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
37356 converted output.
37357
37358
37359
37360 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
37361 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
37362 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
37363 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
37364 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
37365
37366
37367
37368 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
37369 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
37370 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
37371 loading it.
37372
37373
37374 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
37375 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
37376 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
37377 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
37378 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
37379 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
37380 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
37381
37382 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
37383 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
37384 string.
37385
37386
37387
37388 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
37389 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
37390 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
37391 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
37392
37393
37394
37395 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
37396 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
37397 enough to hold the result.
37398 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
37399
37400
37401
37402
37403 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37404 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37405
37406 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
37407 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
37408 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
37409 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
37410 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
37411 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
37412 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
37413 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
37414 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
37415 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
37416 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
37417 themselves are recoverable.
37418
37419 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
37420 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
37421 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
37422
37423 .ilist
37424 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
37425 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
37426 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
37427 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
37428 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
37429 .next
37430 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
37431 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
37432 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect. At
37433 present, this value is not used by Exim, but there is no guarantee that this
37434 will always be the case.
37435 .next
37436 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
37437 .next
37438 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
37439 signature.
37440 .endlist
37441 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
37442
37443 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
37444 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
37445 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
37446 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
37447 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
37448 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
37449 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
37450 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
37451 attempt.
37452
37453 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
37454 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
37455 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
37456 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
37457 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
37458 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
37459 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
37460 normally the Exim user.
37461
37462 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
37463 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
37464 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
37465 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
37466 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
37467 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
37468 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
37469 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
37470
37471 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
37472 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
37473 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
37474 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
37475
37476 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
37477 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
37478
37479 .vlist
37480 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37481 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
37482 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
37483 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
37484 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
37485 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
37486 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
37487 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
37488 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
37489 newlines.
37490
37491 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37492 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
37493 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
37494 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
37495 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
37496 character. It may contain internal newlines.
37497
37498 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37499 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
37500 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
37501 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
37502 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
37503 character. It may contain internal newlines.
37504
37505 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
37506 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
37507 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
37508
37509 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
37510 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
37511 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
37512 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
37513 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
37514
37515 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
37516 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
37517 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
37518 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
37519 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
37520
37521 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
37522 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
37523 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
37524
37525 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
37526 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
37527 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
37528
37529 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
37530 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is always
37531 present.
37532
37533 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
37534 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
37535 present if the number is greater than zero.
37536
37537 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
37538 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
37539 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
37540
37541 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
37542 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
37543 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
37544
37545 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
37546 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
37547 command.
37548
37549 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
37550 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
37551 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
37552 messages.
37553
37554 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
37555 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
37556 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
37557 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
37558
37559 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
37560 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
37561 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
37562
37563 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
37564 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
37565 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
37566 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
37567 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
37568 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
37569
37570 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
37571 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
37572 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
37573 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
37574 supplied by the remote host, if any.
37575
37576 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
37577 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
37578 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
37579 generated messages.
37580
37581 .vitem &%-local%&
37582 The message is from a local sender.
37583
37584 .vitem &%-localerror%&
37585 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
37586
37587 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
37588 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
37589 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
37590 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
37591
37592 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
37593 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
37594 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
37595
37596 .vitem &%-N%&
37597 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
37598 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
37599 &%-N%& is assumed.
37600
37601 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
37602 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
37603 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
37604
37605 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
37606 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
37607 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
37608
37609 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
37610 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
37611 of &$spam_score_int$&.
37612
37613 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
37614 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
37615 certificate was verified by the server.
37616
37617 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
37618 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
37619 name of the cipher suite that was used.
37620
37621 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
37622 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
37623 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
37624 certificate.
37625 .endlist
37626
37627 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
37628 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
37629 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
37630 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
37631 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
37632 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
37633 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
37634 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
37635 addresses are complete.
37636
37637 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
37638 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
37639 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
37640 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
37641 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
37642 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
37643 .code
37644 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
37645 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
37646 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37647 .endd
37648 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
37649 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
37650 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
37651 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
37652 example:
37653 .code
37654 4
37655 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37656 darcy@austen.fict.example
37657 rdo@foundation
37658 alice@wonderland.fict.example
37659 .endd
37660 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
37661 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
37662 line is of the following form:
37663 .display
37664 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
37665 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
37666 .endd
37667 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
37668 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
37669 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
37670 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
37671 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
37672 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
37673 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
37674 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
37675
37676
37677 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
37678 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
37679 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
37680 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
37681 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
37682 following:
37683
37684 .table2 50pt
37685 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
37686 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
37687 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
37688 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
37689 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
37690 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
37691 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
37692 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
37693 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
37694 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
37695 .endtable
37696
37697 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
37698 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
37699 typical set of headers:
37700 .code
37701 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
37702 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
37703 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
37704 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
37705 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
37706 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
37707 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
37708 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37709 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
37710 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37711 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
37712 .endd
37713 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
37714 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
37715 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
37716 .ecindex IIDforspo1
37717 .ecindex IIDforspo2
37718 .ecindex IIDforspo3
37719
37720 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37721 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37722
37723 .chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" "CHAPdkim" &&&
37724 "DKIM Support"
37725 .cindex "DKIM"
37726
37727 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
37728 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
37729 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
37730 DKIM is documented in RFC 4871.
37731
37732 Since version 4.70, DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default. It can be
37733 disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in Local/Makefile.
37734
37735 Exim's DKIM implementation allows to
37736 .olist
37737 Sign outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
37738 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
37739 (including transport filters)
37740 except cutthrough delivery.
37741 .next
37742 Verify signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
37743 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
37744 different signature contexts.
37745 .endlist
37746
37747 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
37748 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
37749 Exim's standard controls.
37750
37751 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
37752 on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
37753 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
37754 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
37755 .code
37756 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
37757 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
37758 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
37759 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
37760 .endd
37761 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
37762 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
37763 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
37764 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
37765 senders).
37766
37767
37768 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECID513"
37769 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
37770
37771 Signing is implemented by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
37772 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
37773
37774 .option dkim_domain smtp string&!! unset
37775 MANDATORY:
37776 The domain you want to sign with. The result of this expanded
37777 option is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable.
37778
37779 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
37780 MANDATORY:
37781 This sets the key selector string. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion
37782 variable to look up a matching selector. The result is put in the expansion
37783 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which should be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
37784 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
37785
37786 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
37787 MANDATORY:
37788 This sets the private key to use. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
37789 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
37790 The result can either
37791 .ilist
37792 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
37793 .next
37794 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
37795 the private key.
37796 .next
37797 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
37798 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
37799 is set.
37800 .endlist
37801
37802 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
37803 OPTIONAL:
37804 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
37805 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
37806 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
37807 only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
37808
37809 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
37810 OPTIONAL:
37811 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
37812 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
37813 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
37814 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
37815 variables here.
37816
37817 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
37818 OPTIONAL:
37819 When set, this option must expand to (or be specified as) a colon-separated
37820 list of header names. Headers with these names will be included in the message
37821 signature. When unspecified, the header names recommended in RFC4871 will be
37822 used.
37823
37824
37825 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
37826 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
37827
37828 Verification of DKIM signatures in incoming email is implemented via the
37829 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
37830 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
37831 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
37832 If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
37833 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message it is
37834 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
37835
37836 To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
37837 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
37838 runtime of the ACL.
37839
37840 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
37841 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
37842 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
37843 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
37844
37845 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
37846 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
37847 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
37848 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
37849 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
37850 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
37851 it defaults as:
37852 .code
37853 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
37854 .endd
37855 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
37856 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
37857 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
37858 .code
37859 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
37860 .endd
37861 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
37862 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
37863 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
37864 .code
37865 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
37866 .endd
37867
37868 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
37869 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
37870
37871
37872 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
37873 available (from most to least important):
37874
37875
37876 .vlist
37877 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
37878 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
37879 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
37880 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
37881 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
37882 A string describing the general status of the signature. One of
37883 .ilist
37884 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
37885 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37886 .next
37887 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
37888 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
37889 .next
37890 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
37891 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
37892 .next
37893 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
37894 .endlist
37895 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
37896 A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
37897 "fail" or "invalid". One of
37898 .ilist
37899 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
37900 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
37901 .next
37902 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
37903 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
37904 .next
37905 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
37906 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
37907 means that the message body was modified in transit.
37908 .next
37909 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
37910 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
37911 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
37912 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
37913 .endlist
37914 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
37915 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
37916 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
37917 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37918 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
37919 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
37920 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
37921 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37922 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
37923 The key record selector string.
37924 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
37925 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
37926 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
37927 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
37928 .vitem &%dkim_canon_headers%&
37929 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
37930 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
37931 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
37932 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
37933 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
37934 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
37935 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
37936 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
37937 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
37938 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
37939 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
37940 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
37941 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
37942 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
37943 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
37944 integer size comparisons against this value.
37945 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
37946 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
37947 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
37948 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
37949 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
37950 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
37951 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
37952 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
37953 in the key record.
37954 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
37955 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
37956 in the key record.
37957 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
37958 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
37959 .endlist
37960
37961 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
37962
37963 .vlist
37964 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
37965 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
37966 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
37967 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
37968 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
37969
37970 .code
37971 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no signature at all
37972 warn log_message = GMail sender without DKIM signature
37973 sender_domains = gmail.com
37974 dkim_signers = gmail.com
37975 dkim_status = none
37976 .endd
37977
37978 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
37979 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
37980 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
37981 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
37982
37983 .code
37984 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
37985 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
37986 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
37987 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
37988 .endd
37989
37990 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
37991 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
37992 for more information of what they mean.
37993 .endlist
37994
37995 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37996 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37997
37998 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
37999 "Adding drivers or lookups"
38000 .cindex "adding drivers"
38001 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
38002 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
38003 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
38004 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
38005
38006 .olist
38007 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
38008 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
38009 .next
38010 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
38011 .display
38012 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
38013 .endd
38014 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
38015 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
38016 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
38017 .next
38018 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
38019 .code
38020 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
38021 .endd
38022 .next
38023 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
38024 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
38025 .next
38026 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
38027 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
38028 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
38029 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
38030 simple form that most lookups have.
38031 .next
38032 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
38033 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
38034 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
38035 .next
38036 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
38037 &_src_&.
38038 .next
38039 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
38040 as for other drivers and lookups.
38041 .endlist
38042
38043 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
38044 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
38045 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
38046 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
38047 searched using a binary chop procedure.
38048
38049 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
38050 the interface that is expected.
38051
38052
38053
38054
38055 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38056 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38057
38058 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38059 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
38060 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
38061 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
38062 . processors.
38063 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38064
38065 .literal xml
38066 <?sdop
38067 format="newpage"
38068 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
38069 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
38070 ?>
38071 .literal off
38072
38073 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
38074 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
38075 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
38076
38077
38078 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38079 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////